Dixon Aficio 1515 Bedienungsanleitung

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
289
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
330
331
332
333
334
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
352
353
354
355
356
357
358
359
360
361
362
363
364
365
366
367
368
369
370
371
372
373
374
375
376
377
378
379
380
381
382
383
384
385
386
387
388
389
390
391
392
393
394
395
396
397
398
399
400
401
402
403
404
405
406
407
408
409
410
411
412
413
414
415
416
417
418
419
420
421
422
423
424
425
426
427
428
429
430
431
432
433
434
435
436
437
438
439
440
441
442
443
444
445
446
447
448
449
450
451
452
453
454
455
456
457
458
459
460
461
462
463
464
465
466
467
468
469
470
471
472
473
474
475
476
477
478
479
480
481
482
483
484
485
486
487
488
489
490
491
492
493
494
495
496
497
498
499
500
501
502
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521
522
523
524
525
526
527
528
529
530
531
532
533
534
535
536
537
538
539
540
541
542
543
544
545
546
547
548
549
550
551
552
553
554
555
556
557
558
559
560
561
562
563
564
565
566
567
568
569
570
571
572
573
574
575
576
577
578
579
580
581
582
583
584
585
586
587
588
589
590
591
592
593
594
595
596
597
598
599
600
601
602
603
604
605
606
607
608
609
610
611
612
613
614
615
616
617
618
619
620
621
622
623
624
625
626
627
628
629
630
631
632
633
634
635
636
637
638
639
640
641
642
643
644
645
646
647
648
649
650
651
652
653
654
655
656
657
658
659
660
661
662
663
664
665
666
667
668
669
670
671
672
673
674
675
676
677
678
679
680
681
682
683
684
685
686
687
688
689
690
691
692
693
694
695
696
697
698
699
700
701
702
703
704
705
706
707
708
709
710
711
712
713
714
715
716
717
718
719
720
721
722
723
724
725
726
727
728
729
730
731
732
733
734
735
736
737
738
739
740
741
742
743
744
745
746
747
748
749
750
751
752
753
754
755
756
757
758
759
760
761
762
763
764
765
766
767
768
769
770
771
772
773
774
775
776
777
778
779
780
781
782
783
784
785
786
787
788
789
790
791
792
793
794
795
796
797
798
799
800
801
802
803
804
805
806
807
808
809
810
811
812
813
814
815
816
817
818
819
820
821
822
823
824
825
826
827
828
829
830
831
832
833
834
835
836
837
838
839
840
841
842
843
844
845
846
847
848
849
850
851
852
853
854
855
856
857
858
859
860
861
862
863
864
865
866
867
868
869
870
871
872
873
874
875
876
877
878
879
880
881
882
883
884
885
886
887
888
889
890
891
892
893
894
895
896
897
898
899
900
901
902
903
904
905
906
907
908
909
910
911
912
913
914
915
916
917
918
919
920
921
922
923
924
925
926
927
928
929
930
931
932
933
934
935
936
937
938
939
940
941
942
943
944
945
946
947
948
949
950
951
952
953
954
955
956
957
958
959
960
961
962
963
964
965
966
967
968
969
970
971
972
973
974
975
976
977
978
979
980
981
982
983
984
985
986
987
988
989
990
991
992
993
994
995
996
997
998
999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171

Zur Seite of

Richtige Gebrauchsanleitung

Die Vorschriften verpflichten den Verkäufer zur Übertragung der Gebrauchsanleitung Dixon Aficio 1515 an den Erwerber, zusammen mit der Ware. Eine fehlende Anleitung oder falsche Informationen, die dem Verbraucher übertragen werden, bilden eine Grundlage für eine Reklamation aufgrund Unstimmigkeit des Geräts mit dem Vertrag. Rechtsmäßig lässt man das Anfügen einer Gebrauchsanleitung in anderer Form als Papierform zu, was letztens sehr oft genutzt wird, indem man eine grafische oder elektronische Anleitung von Dixon Aficio 1515, sowie Anleitungsvideos für Nutzer beifügt. Die Bedingung ist, dass ihre Form leserlich und verständlich ist.

Was ist eine Gebrauchsanleitung?

Das Wort kommt vom lateinischen „instructio”, d.h. ordnen. Demnach kann man in der Anleitung Dixon Aficio 1515 die Beschreibung der Etappen der Vorgehensweisen finden. Das Ziel der Anleitung ist die Belehrung, Vereinfachung des Starts, der Nutzung des Geräts oder auch der Ausführung bestimmter Tätigkeiten. Die Anleitung ist eine Sammlung von Informationen über ein Gegenstand/eine Dienstleistung, ein Hinweis.

Leider widmen nicht viele Nutzer ihre Zeit der Gebrauchsanleitung Dixon Aficio 1515. Eine gute Gebrauchsanleitung erlaubt nicht nur eine Reihe zusätzlicher Funktionen des gekauften Geräts kennenzulernen, sondern hilft dabei viele Fehler zu vermeiden.

Was sollte also eine ideale Gebrauchsanleitung beinhalten?

Die Gebrauchsanleitung Dixon Aficio 1515 sollte vor allem folgendes enthalten:
- Informationen über technische Daten des Geräts Dixon Aficio 1515
- Den Namen des Produzenten und das Produktionsjahr des Geräts Dixon Aficio 1515
- Grundsätze der Bedienung, Regulierung und Wartung des Geräts Dixon Aficio 1515
- Sicherheitszeichen und Zertifikate, die die Übereinstimmung mit entsprechenden Normen bestätigen

Warum lesen wir keine Gebrauchsanleitungen?

Der Grund dafür ist die fehlende Zeit und die Sicherheit, was die bestimmten Funktionen der gekauften Geräte angeht. Leider ist das Anschließen und Starten von Dixon Aficio 1515 zu wenig. Eine Anleitung beinhaltet eine Reihe von Hinweisen bezüglich bestimmter Funktionen, Sicherheitsgrundsätze, Wartungsarten (sogar das, welche Mittel man benutzen sollte), eventueller Fehler von Dixon Aficio 1515 und Lösungsarten für Probleme, die während der Nutzung auftreten könnten. Immerhin kann man in der Gebrauchsanleitung die Kontaktnummer zum Service Dixon finden, wenn die vorgeschlagenen Lösungen nicht wirksam sind. Aktuell erfreuen sich Anleitungen in Form von interessanten Animationen oder Videoanleitungen an Popularität, die den Nutzer besser ansprechen als eine Broschüre. Diese Art von Anleitung gibt garantiert, dass der Nutzer sich das ganze Video anschaut, ohne die spezifizierten und komplizierten technischen Beschreibungen von Dixon Aficio 1515 zu überspringen, wie es bei der Papierform passiert.

Warum sollte man Gebrauchsanleitungen lesen?

In der Gebrauchsanleitung finden wir vor allem die Antwort über den Bau sowie die Möglichkeiten des Geräts Dixon Aficio 1515, über die Nutzung bestimmter Accessoires und eine Reihe von Informationen, die erlauben, jegliche Funktionen und Bequemlichkeiten zu nutzen.

Nach dem gelungenen Kauf des Geräts, sollte man einige Zeit für das Kennenlernen jedes Teils der Anleitung von Dixon Aficio 1515 widmen. Aktuell sind sie genau vorbereitet oder übersetzt, damit sie nicht nur verständlich für die Nutzer sind, aber auch ihre grundliegende Hilfs-Informations-Funktion erfüllen.

Inhaltsverzeichnis der Gebrauchsanleitungen

  • Seite 1

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 108 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.320000 mm Operat ing Instr uctions General Settings Guide Read th is manual caref ully bef ore you use th is prod uct and keep i t handy for fut ure refe rence. F[...]

  • Seite 2

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 108 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.320000 mm In accor dance wi th IEC 6 0417, thi s machine u ses the f ollowi ng symbols for th e main pow er switc h: a a a a means POWER O N. c c c c means STAND [...]

  • Seite 3

    i Manuals f or This M achine The following manuals describe the oper ational procedures of this ma chine. For particular functions, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine ty pe. ❒ Adobe Acr obat Reader is nec essary to view t he manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Two CD-ROMs are provided: • CD-ROM 1 “O[...]

  • Seite 4

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBind er V2 Lite Desk Top Binde r V2 L ite is a ut ilit y incl uded on th e CD- ROM l abe led “ Scanner Driv er & Docu men t Mana geme nt Ut ilit ies ” . • DeskTopBin der V2 Lite Setup Guide ( PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes the installation of, and the operat ing environment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite [...]

  • Seite 5

    iii What You Can Do with This Machine The follow ing introduces the func tions of this machi ne, and the releva nt manu- als containing detailed information about them. Note ❒ Some functions m any not be available depend ing on your machine t ype. Copier, Facs imile, Printer, and Scanner Fu nctions This machine pr ovides copi er, fac- simile, pri[...]

  • Seite 6

    iv Fax Transmissi on and Reception through the Internet • You can send fax document s through e-m ail by specifying the recipient's e-mail address (Trans- mittin g Int ernet Fa x). You can re ceive se nt docu ments via Internet Fax, or f rom comput- ers (Receiving In ternet Fax ). See Facsimile Reference<Basic Fea- tures> . Using the S[...]

  • Seite 7

    v Administrati ng the Machine (Security Funct ions) The security functions protect docu - ments from being cop ied without per miss ion o r unau thor ized acces s via the netwo rk. See p.85 “ Securit y ” . Note ❒ This functi on is only availa ble when the printer/s canner and fax units are inst alled. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Secu rity Fu nction s •[...]

  • Seite 8

    vi TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machin e ...... ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . i What You Can Do with This Ma chine ......... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ...... .... iii Copier, Facsimile, Pri nter, and Scanner Functions .. .......... .......... ....... ..[...]

  • Seite 9

    vii User Cod e (MFP ) ............. ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... . 45 Registering a New User Code........... .......... ....... .......... .......... ...... .......... ....... .......... . 45 Changing a User Code........ .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... .......... .[...]

  • Seite 10

    viii 7. Security Security ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... . 85 Primary Securit y Functions ........ ....... .......... ....... .......... .......... ...... .......... ....... .......... . 85 Extended Security Functio n .......... .......... ....... ....[...]

  • Seite 11

    1 Copyrights and Trademarks Trademar ks Micr osof t ® , Window s ® and Windows NT ® are registered trademarks of Micro- soft Corpor ation in the U nited States and /or other co untries. PostScript ® and A cro bat ® are a r egistered trademark of Ado be Systems Incorp o- rated. Bluetooth ™ is a trademark of the Bluetooth SI G, Inc. (Special I[...]

  • Seite 12

    2 Information about Inst alled Software expat • The softwar e including con troller, etc. (hereinafter “ software ” ) inst alle d on this product us es the expat Version 1.95.2 (hereinafter “ expat ” ) under the con- dition s mentio ned belo w. • The prod uct manufactur er provides warr anty and support to the softwar e of the produ ct [...]

  • Seite 13

    3 NetBSD 1. Cop yright N otice of NetB SD For all users to use thi s product: This product contains NetBS D operating system: For th e mos t part , th e sof tware const itut ing the N etBSD o per ating syst em is n ot in the p ublic domain; its aut hors r etain t heir c opyright . The following text shows the cop yright notice used for many of the [...]

  • Seite 14

    4 2. Authors Name List All product nam es mentioned herein are tradem arks of their respective owners. The followin g notices are requ ired to satisfy the licen se terms of the software that we have mentioned in this doc ument: • This prod uct includes software d eveloped by the Uni versity of California, Berkel ey and i ts co ntributors. • Thi[...]

  • Seite 15

    5 Sabl otro n Sablotron ( Version 0.82) Co pyright (c) 2000 Ginger Alli ance Ltd. A ll Rights Re- serve a) The applic ation sof tware inst alled on this product includes the Sablotro n soft- ware Version 0 .82 (hereinafter, “ Sablotron 0.82 ” ), with modifications m ade by the product manu facturer. The original code of the Sablo tron 0.82 is p[...]

  • Seite 16

    6 SASL CMU libsasl Tim Marti n Rob Earhart Rob Siemborski Copyright (c) 2001 Carnegie Mell on University. Al l rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica- tion, are permitt ed provided that the following conditions are met: A R e d i s t r i b u t i o n s o f s o u rc e c o d e m u s t r e t a i n t[...]

  • Seite 17

    7 MD4 Co pyrig ht (C) 1 990- 2, RSA Data S ecurity , Inc. Al l righ ts rese rved . Lice nse to copy and use t his softw are is g ranted pr ovided that it is id entifie d as the “ RSA Data Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest Alg orithm ” in all material mention ing or referencing this software or this function. License is al so granted to make a n[...]

  • Seite 18

    8 How to Read This Manual Symb ols The f ollowing se t of sy mbols is u sed in thi s manual . R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic [...]

  • Seite 19

    9 ENER GY ST AR Pr ogra m • Low Powe r mode This produ ct autom atical ly low ers its po wer con sumpt ion 1 min ute af ter fin- ishing th e last co py or pr int job. Fax recept ion and p rinting i s still po ssible in Low Power mode, but to make copies, you have to p ress the operation swi tch first. For details abo ut how to change the inte rva[...]

  • Seite 20

    10 •D u p l e x P r i o r i t y To conserve paper, the Duplex function (1-Sided → 2-Si ded) can b e selected pref erential ly wh en you turn on th e ope ratio n swit ch or the m ain p ower switch, press the { { { { Clear Mod es } } } } key, or the mach ine resets itsel f automati cally. To change Duplex Priority mode, see Co py Referen ce . Spe[...]

  • Seite 21

    11 1. Getting Started Guide to Comp onents 1. Exposur e glass cover Lower this over originals. 2. Auto Document Feeder See p.13 “ Oth er Item s ” . 3. Exposur e glass Place originals fa ce down here. 4. Internal tray Cop ied, printe d paper, or fa x messa ges are delivered here. 5. Ventilation holes Prevent overheati ng. Do not obstruct these b[...]

  • Seite 22

    Getting Sta rted 12 1 8. On indicator Lights when the operation switch is turned on, and goes off when the switc h is turned off. 9. Operation switch Press to tu rn the pow er on (the On indi- cator lights). To turn the pow er off, press again (the On i ndicat or goes off) . 10. Co ntrol pane l See p.15 “ Contro l Panel ” . 11. Front cover Open[...]

  • Seite 23

    Other It ems 13 1 Other Items • Extern al 1. Auto Document Feeder Fee ds in orig ina ls au toma tic ally . 2. Paper tray unit (Tray 2) Holds 500 sheets. • Internal A Fax unit Allow s you to use the facsimile functi on. B Printe r/Scanner u nit Allows you to use the printer and scanner functions. C Parallel po rt IEEE 1284 inter face board Allow[...]

  • Seite 24

    Getting Sta rted 14 1 Note ❒ You canno t install two or mor e of the op tions below : Para llel port I EEE 1284 interface board, IEEE 1394 i nterface board, IEEE 802.11b wireless LAN bo ard, B luetooth unit. StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 14 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 25

    Control Panel 15 1 Control Panel This illust ration shows the co ntrol panel of the mach ine with fa x, printer , and scanner installed. 1. Fax funct ion keys Referenc e Facsim ile Refere nce <Basic Featur es> and Facsi mile Reference <Advanc ed Features> 2. { { { { Facs imil e } } } } key Press to activate the facsimile functio n. 3. S[...]

  • Seite 26

    Getting Sta rted 16 1 14. Main power ind icator and On indicator The m ain power ind icator lights when the main powe r swit ch is t urn ed on . The On indi cator lights w hen the o peration sw itch is on . Important ❒ Do not tur n off the main powe r switch while th e On indi cator i s lit or blinking. Doing so may damage the m emory. 15. Oper a[...]

  • Seite 27

    Control Panel 17 1 Display The display pa nel shows machine stat us, error messages, and function menus. Important ❒ A for ce or i mpact of more than 30 N ( about 3 kgf) will d amage t he disp lay. The copy di splay is set as the default screen when the machin e is turned on. When you sel ect or specify an item on the display, it is highlighted l[...]

  • Seite 28

    Getting Sta rted 18 1 Common key o perations The follow ing keys are co mmon to all screens: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Key list [ Cancel ] Deletes a selected function or e ntered values, and then the pr evious di spla y re tur ns. [ Exit ] The previous di splay returns. [ Stop ] Stops a job in prog ress. [ Yes ] Acknowledges a selected fu nction or an entere[...]

  • Seite 29

    19 2. Combined Function Operations Changing Modes Note ❒ You cannot sw itch modes in any of th e following situations: • When scanning a fax m essage for transmissi on • During immediate transmissio n • When accessin g User Tools • Dur ing On h ook di alin g for f ax tra nsmis sion • Whil e sc ann ing a n ori gin al ❒ The copying scr [...]

  • Seite 30

    Combined Funct ion Operations 20 2 - - - - System Re set The machine returns automatically to its initial condition when the j ob is fin- ished, after a certain period of time has elapsed. This functi on is called “ System Reset ” . Note ❒ You can c hange the System Reset time . See p.31 “ System Auto Reset Timer ” . StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.b[...]

  • Seite 31

    Multi-Acce ss 21 2 Multi- Access You can carry out another job using a different function while the current job is being p erformed. Performing multiple functions simultaneously like this is called “ Mult i-ac cess ing ” . This allows you to handle jobs efficiently, reg ardless of how the machine is being used. F or example: • You can ma ke c[...]

  • Seite 32

    Combined Funct ion Operations 22 2 b … means that th ese function s can be u sed toge ther. $ … means that you can interr upt the current job with Function keys to p roceed to a subsequent job. 1 … means th at another job w ill automatic ally start after the current job is fin- ished. × … means that yo u must manually s tart another job af[...]

  • Seite 33

    23 3. User Tools (System Settings) User T ools Me nu (Sys tem Sett ings) Referenc e For detail s about Interface S ettings and File Trans fer, see “ User T ools Menu (System S ettings) ” , Net work Gu ide . For details about para llel interfac e, see “ System Settings (Paralle l Connec- tion) ” , Pri nte r R efe renc e 2 . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ G[...]

  • Seite 34

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 24 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Timer Settings (See p.31 “ Tim er Setti ngs ” .) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Interface Settings • For details abou t network settings , see Net wor k Guid e . • For details about parallel inter face, see P rinter Referenc e 2 . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ File Transfer See Networ k Guid e . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Key O[...]

  • Seite 35

    User Tool s Menu (System Set tings) 25 3 Progra m/Chan ge User Code Pr ogram — Chang e — Dele te — Address Book:Print List Destination List — Group Destination List — Quick Dial Label — AOF (Always On ) On Default (MFP) Default (Copier onl y) StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 25 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 36

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 26 3 Accessi ng User T ools ( System Setti ngs) This sectio n is for key operator s in charge of this m achi ne. User Tools allow you to change or set defau lt s. Note ❒ Operations for system settings dif- fer from normal operations. Al- ways quit User Tools when you have finished. See p.27 “ Quitting User Tools [...]

  • Seite 37

    Accessi ng User Tools ( System Set tings) 27 3 Quitting User Tools A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. ABU205S StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 27 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 38

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 28 3 Settings You Can C hange with User Tools Referenc e To access User Tools, see p.26 “ Accessing User Tools (System Settings) ” . General Feat ures ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Panel To ne The beeper (key tone) sound s when a key i s pressed. Note ❒ Default: On ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy Coun t Display The co py count er can b[...]

  • Seite 39

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 29 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Measurement Unit You can switch the measurement betw een “ mm ” and “ inch ” . Note ❒ Defaul t: Metri c ver sion: mm ❒ Inch ver sion: inch Tray Paper Sett ings ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Tray Paper Size:T ray 1 – 2 Select the size of the p aper loa ded in the pape r tray . • The pa[...]

  • Seite 40

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 30 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper Type:Tray 1 – 2 Set the display so you can see what typ e of paper is loaded in each paper tray. The prin t function u ses this i nformati on to auto matically select th e paper tray. • The paper types you can set are as follows: • recy cled pape r, spec ial pape r, colo ur paper, let[...]

  • Seite 41

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 31 3 Timer Settings ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Auto Off Timer After a spec ified period has passed, fo llowing job comp letion, the machine automat ical ly turns off, in or der to con serve ene rgy. This functi on is called “ Auto Off ” . The machine status after the Auto Off operation is referred to as “ Off mo[...]

  • Seite 42

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 32 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copier Auto Reset Timer Speci fy the ti me to elap se befo re copi er mode resets . Note ❒ If [ Of f ] is selected , the machine does not aut omatically switch t o the user code entry scree n. ❒ Default: On , 60 sec. ❒ The time can be set from 10 to 999 seconds using the number keys. ❖ ?[...]

  • Seite 43

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 33 3 Key Operator Tools The key o perator must set the following items (for settings or m ore information, contact the key operator): We recommen d that the key operator program a key operat or code when mak- ing settings. See p.33 “ Ke y Oper ator Code ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ User Code Manage ment Allows y[...]

  • Seite 44

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 34 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Extende d Security Specify whether or not to us e the security function. Note ❒ Default : Off ❒ You have to set a 6-digit key operator code to enable Extended Security. See p.33 “ Key O per ator Code ” . Referen ce For details about security, see p.85 “ Secu rity ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ D[...]

  • Seite 45

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 35 3 D Sele ct [ Dis play/Print Count er ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E Press [ Prin t ] . F Press the { { { { Start } } } } key. G Press the { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Counter per User Code Allow s you to v[...]

  • Seite 46

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 36 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Address Book Management You can a dd, cha nge, or delete u ser inform ation in the Addres s Book, and fac- simile/scanner function s destinations. For de tails abou t these oper ations, se e p.45 “ User Code (MFP) ” , p.52 “ Fax Destination ” , an d p.57 “ E-ma il De stina tion ” . ?[...]

  • Seite 47

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 37 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Program/Change/D elete Group You can regist er multip le users in a grou p. This a llows y ou to e asily cont rol reg istered users in ea ch grou p. For details about operations, see p.62 “ Registeri ng Destinations to a Group ” . • [ Program/Cha nge ] This regi sters n ew groups,[...]

  • Seite 48

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 38 3 User C ode (F or mac hines with co pier function only) Registe r user codes to re strict copier functions to certain users, an d check on thei r use of copier fu nctions. Register ing a New User Code A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {[...]

  • Seite 49

    User Code (For mac hines with c opier func tion only) 39 3 Changing a User Cod e Note ❒ Even if you change a user code, the counter value will not be clear ed. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } [...]

  • Seite 50

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 40 3 F F F F Sele ct [ Per User Code ] or [ All User Codes ] us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and th en pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Whe n select ing [ All User Code s ] , a confirmation message appears. Press [ Yes ] , and then proceed to step I . G G G G Enter the regis tered user code[...]

  • Seite 51

    User Code (For mac hines with c opier func tion only) 41 3 Printing the Counter for Each User Code You can print out the count er for each user code. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . [...]

  • Seite 52

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 42 3 Address Boo k Registering user inform ation, su ch as fax numbers and e-mail addresses, in the Ad dress Book a llows yo u to ma n- age t hem to geth er. Important ❒ Address Book d ata is stored in memory. It can be lost if there is s om e k in d of m e mo r y fa i lu r e. T he manufacturer sh all not be respo [...]

  • Seite 53

    Address Bo ok 43 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Items to register • User Name Refe rence p.43 “ Registe ring the desti- nation name ” p.44 “ Registeri ng Sender In- form atio n ” • Fax Settings Refe rence p.43 “ When using the fax func ti on ” • E-mail Setti ngs Refe rence p.43 “ When using the fax func ti on ” p.44 “ When u sing t he sc[...]

  • Seite 54

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 44 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When usi ng the scan ner function • E-mail Register e-mail addresses i n the Address Book. To send sca n files by e -mail, select the desti- nation from the D estination List, so you can specify the e- mail address. Refe rence p.57 “ E-ma il De stina tion ” Register ing Sender Information ?[...]

  • Seite 55

    User Code (MFP) 45 3 User C ode (MFP ) Register user co des to restric t the fol- lowing functions to c ertain users, and check th eir use of each function : • Copier • Facsim ile • Scanner • Printer Note ❒ The number of copies scanned in using the scanner functi on is count ed for ea ch use r code . Thi s al- lows you to check each u ser[...]

  • Seite 56

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 46 3 E E E E Sele ct [ Program/Change ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . F F F F Enter the registration number you want to program using the number keys or the Qu ick Dial key s, an d then pre ss t he { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Enter the user (de[...]

  • Seite 57

    User Code (MFP) 47 3 E E E E Sele ct [ Program/Change ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . F F F F Pre ss [ Search ] . Note ❒ You can a lso enter the reg istra- tion number of the user (desti- nation) using the number keys or the Quick Dial keys. After en- tering the number, press t[...]

  • Seite 58

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 48 3 Deleting a User Code A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then p ress the { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C Sele ct [ Key Operator Tools ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } [...]

  • Seite 59

    User Code (MFP) 49 3 M M M M Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. Displaying the Counter for Each User Code You can check the counter made un- der each function' s user co de. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } [...]

  • Seite 60

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 50 3 Note ❒ Repea t this ste p when you want to print more tha n one counte r. C Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D Press th e { { { { Sta rt } } } } key. The co unter list prints out. To print the counter for each user code A Select [ Per User Cod e ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t[...]

  • Seite 61

    User Code (MFP) 51 3 Note ❒ Repea t this ste p when you want to clear more than on e counte r. C Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. A confirmat ion message ap- pear s. D Press [ Yes ] . The “ Cou nter has been cleare d. ” message appears, and then the Codes: Cou nters display ret urns. To clear the counter for each user code A Select [ Per Us[...]

  • Seite 62

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 52 3 Fax De stinatio n Register fax destinations, so you do not need to enter them each time, and can send d ocuments scanned in using the fax function. • It is easy to select the fax destina- tion if you regist er a “ User (Destina- tion ) Name ” for the fax destination. • You can register fax destinations a[...]

  • Seite 63

    Fax Destinati on 53 3 E E E E Sele ct [ Program/Change ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . F F F F Enter the registration number you want to program using the number keys or the Qu ick Dial key s, an d then pre ss t he { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Enter the user (destinati on) nam[...]

  • Seite 64

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 54 3 C Select [ On ] or [ Off ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. To use the T one function This funct ion al lows t he mac hine to send tonal signals when it is connected to a pulse dialing l ine (for example: to use a special ser v- ice on a tone dia[...]

  • Seite 65

    Fax Destinati on 55 3 G G G G Sele ct [ Display De stination List ] us- ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Select the f ax destination use r you wa nt to c hange usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. I I I I Pre ss th e[...]

  • Seite 66

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 56 3 F F F F Pre ss [ Search ] . Note ❒ You can a lso enter the reg istra- tion number of the user (desti- nation) using the number keys or the Quick Dial keys. After en- tering the number, press the { { { { OK } } } } key, and then proceed to step I . ❒ You can also search the regis- tered destination by name, r[...]

  • Seite 67

    E-mail Dest ination 57 3 E-mail Dest inatio n Register e-mail d estinations, so you do not need to enter e-mail ad dresses ever y ti me, and c an s end s can fil es b y e-ma il, or s end fa x do cume nts by In- ternet Fa x. You can a lso r eceive a Transmis sion Result Re port by e- mail when you use the User Transmi ssion functio n to send a n Int[...]

  • Seite 68

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 58 3 F F F F Enter the registration number you want to program using the number keys or the Qu ick Dial key s, an d then pre ss t he { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Enter the user (destinati on) name using the number keys and the Quick Dial k eys, and then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You can use th e [...]

  • Seite 69

    E-mail Dest ination 59 3 M M M M Enter t he sender 's passwor d us- ing the numb er keys, and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You can enter up to eight d igits. N N N N Pre ss th e { { { { Cancel } } } } key. O O O O Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Programmed ” m essage ap- pears, and then the “ Address Book ?[...]

  • Seite 70

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 60 3 J J J J Pre ss [ Dest. ] . K K K K Sele ct [ E- mail Settings ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. L L L L Enter the new e-ma il address u s- ing the number keys and the Quick Dial k eys, and then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. M M M M To use th[...]

  • Seite 71

    E-mail Dest ination 61 3 Note ❒ Sele ct [ Program/Cha nge ] if you want to delete only the e-mail address. ❒ Sele ct [ Delete ] if you want to de- lete al l use r inform atio n. F F F F Pre ss [ Search ] . Note ❒ You can a lso enter the reg istra- tion number of the user (desti- nation) using the number keys or the Quick Dial keys. After en- [...]

  • Seite 72

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 62 3 Registe ring Destinations to a Group Register destinations to a group to easil y contr ol reg ister ed fax and e- mail addr ess for e ach gr oup . To group d estinations, the groups must be registered beforehand. Note ❒ You can register up to 10 groups. Register ing a New Group A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User[...]

  • Seite 73

    Register ing Dest inations to a Group 63 3 H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Programmed ” m essage ap- pears, and then the “ Group ” dis- play r eturns. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. Register ing a Destination to a Group A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele [...]

  • Seite 74

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 64 3 K K K K Sele ct [ Program G roup ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . L L L L Select the group name to which you want to register using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then check it using { { { {V V V V} } } } . M M M M Pre ss[...]

  • Seite 75

    Register ing Dest inations to a Group 65 3 J J J J Pre ss [ Dest. ] . K K K K Sele ct [ Program G roup ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . L L L L Select th e group name from which yo u want to remove the user (destination) using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and [...]

  • Seite 76

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 66 3 Refe rence For details about entering text, see p.83 “ Entering Text ” . C Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D Select th e group you want to display using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. Searching to select a registered group from Destination List[...]

  • Seite 77

    Register ing Dest inations to a Group 67 3 Changing a Group Name A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . C C C C Sele ct [ Key Operator Tools ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T[...]

  • Seite 78

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 68 3 Searching to select a registered group by registration number A Select [ S earch by Regi stration No. ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter the re gistration numb er of the gr oup you want to change using the number keys, and then press the [...]

  • Seite 79

    Register ing Dest inations to a Group 69 3 B Enter th e characters of the des- tination you want to delete us- ing the num ber keys and the Quick Dia l keys, and then press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Refe rence For details about entering text, see p.83 “ Entering Text ” . C Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D Select th e group you want to de[...]

  • Seite 80

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 70 3 Using the Se arch Function to Sele ct a Dest inat ion You ca n use the search functi on to se- lect a registered destination by name, registered number, user code, fax number or e-mail add ress. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U[...]

  • Seite 81

    Using t he Searc h Functi on to Se lect a Destinat ion 71 3 D Select the us er (destination) you want to change or delete using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Searching to select a registered destination by registration number A Select [ S earch by Regi stration No. ] using { { { {U U U[...]

  • Seite 82

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 72 3 Searching to select a registered destination by fax number A Select [ Search by Fax No. ] us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter the fax number of the user (destin ation) yo u want to change or delete using the number keys, and then press the { [...]

  • Seite 83

    73 4. Troubleshooting If Your Mac hine Does Not Operate As You Want The following chart gives explanations of common pr oblems and messages. If other messages appear, follow the instruc tions displayed. Note ❒ For further “ Troub leshootin g ” , refer to the oth er manuals for this machin e. See p.i “ Man uals for T his M achin e ” . Prob[...]

  • Seite 84

    Troublesh ooting 74 4 Cannot print in d uplex mode. You cannot u se paper in the bypass tray for du plex prin ting. For duplex pr inting, select Tray 1-2 in copier mode or with the printer driver. [ Off ] is selected for [ Duplex ] in Paper Type: Tr ay 1-2. Select [ On ] for [ Duplex ] in Pape r Type: Tray 1-2. See p.30 “ Paper Type:Tray 1 – 2 [...]

  • Seite 85

    x Clearing Mis feeds 75 4 x x x x Clearing Misfee ds R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ When cl earing misfeeds, do not turn off th e power sw itch. If you do, your copy settings are cleared. ❒ To prevent misfeeds, do not leave any torn scraps of paper inside the ma- chi ne. ❒ If paper mi sfeeds occur repeated ly, contact you r service representative. N[...]

  • Seite 86

    Troublesh ooting 76 4 displa yed displa yed displa yed ABU040S StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 76 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 87

    Changing the Paper Size 77 4 Changing the Pape r Size Prep arat ion Be sure to sel ect the pape r size w it h U s e r T o o l s . I f y o u d o n o t , m i s - feeds mi ght occur. Se e p.29 “ Tray Pape r Siz e:Tray 1 – 2 ” . Referenc e For detail s about pap er sizes and types , see p.94 “ Copy Paper ” . Changing the Paper Size of the Pap[...]

  • Seite 88

    Troublesh ooting 78 4 F F F F Square t he paper and l oad it in the tray . Importa nt ❒ Be sure to l oa d th e p ap er u nd er the roller. ❒ Do not stack paper over the lim- it m ark. G G G G While pressing the relea se lever, adjust the side fences to the new pape r si ze. Importa nt ❒ When setting small quantities of copy paper, be careful [...]

  • Seite 89

    Changing the Paper Size 79 4 When loading 8 1 / 4 " × 14" L or 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L size paper A Pull the back fence off from the tray. B Place i t in the corne r pocket on the left. D D D D While pressing the relea se lever, adjust the side fences . E E E E Push the met al pla te down, and then square the paper and load it in th[...]

  • Seite 90

    Troublesh ooting 80 4 Sele cting the Paper Size with User Tools A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . C C C C Sele ct [ Tray Paper Setting s ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T [...]

  • Seite 91

    81 5. Other Function Other Function Displaying the Tot al Counter You can d isplay th e total c ounte r val- ue used for all function s. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Counter ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C To print the coun[...]

  • Seite 92

    Other Func tion 82 5 StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 82 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 93

    83 6. Entering Text Ente rin g Tex t This sect ion de scribes how to ente r characters. When you enter a charac- ter, it appears at the cursor p osition. If there is a character already at the cur- sor position, the newly en tered char- acter appears befo re it. Availabl e Characters • Alphabetic characters ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU- VWXYZabcdefghijk[...]

  • Seite 94

    Entering Te xt 84 6 Entering letters A A A A Pres s th e { { { { Shift } } } } key to switch be- tween uppercas e and lo wercase. B B B B Pre ss a Quic k Dia l keys . A letter i s entered and the c ursor moves along one sp ace. Note ❒ To enter a character repeat edly, repea t step B . ❒ To insert a charact er, press { { { {W W W W} } } } or { {[...]

  • Seite 95

    85 7. Security Secur ity Confidential information is always at risk of being copied w ithout permission or subject t o unauthor ized access through the ne twork. To p rotect doc uments from such int rusion , no t onl y can passw ords be s et, b ut a lso th e Ext ende d Sec urity function ca n be used to str engthen security. For those w ho requir e[...]

  • Seite 96

    Security 86 7 A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syste m Set tings ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and th en pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C Sele ct [ Key Operator Tool s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key.[...]

  • Seite 97

    Operatin g Enviro nment and Notes 87 7 Operating Environment and Notes Security for this machine is assured o n the premis es that the machine is u sed un- der the foll owing conditi ons: Oper ati ng En viro nm ent • The condit ion of the mac hine is norm al. (For example, it i s not dama ged, modif ied, or lacking c ompon ents.) • When the mac[...]

  • Seite 98

    Security 88 7 StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 88 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 99

    89 8. Specifications Main Unit ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Confi gura tion: Desktop ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Photosensitivity type: OPC drum ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Original s canning: One-dimensional solid scanning system through CCD ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy proc ess: Dry elec trostatic transfer system ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Development: Dry two -component magnetic b rush de velopment s[...]

  • Seite 100

    Specificat ions 90 8 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy paper s ize: • Tray: A4 L , B5 JI S L , A5 K , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L , 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " K , 16K L • Bypass: A4 L , A5 KL , B5 JIS L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L , 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " KL , 7 1 / 4 " × 10 1 / 2 " L , 8" ?[...]

  • Seite 101

    Main U nit 91 8 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy paper capacity: • Tray 1: 25 0 sheets (80 g/m 2 , 20 lb) • Bypass: 100 sheets (80 g/m 2 , 20 lb) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Power co nsumptio n: *1 Main uni t with the ADF, fax unit, printer/sc anner unit, and paper tray u nit. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Dimensi ons (W × × × × D × × × × H up to exposure glass): Main un it[...]

  • Seite 102

    Specificat ions 92 8 Other Items Auto Document Feeder (ADF) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Mode : • ADF mode ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Origin al size: • A4 L – A5 KL • 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L – 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " KL ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Orig inal wei ght: • One-sided ori ginals: 52 – 105 g/m 2 (14 – 28 lb) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Number of o riginals [...]

  • Seite 103

    Other It ems 93 8 Paper Tr ay Unit (Tray 2) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper w eight: 60 – 90 g/m 2 (16 – 24 lb.) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper size: A4 L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14 " L , 8 1 / 2 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 14" L ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Maximum power co nsumption: 15 W (powe[...]

  • Seite 104

    Specificat ions 94 8 Copy Paper Recommended Paper Sizes and Ty pes The fol lowin g limi tati ons app ly to each tr ay: *1 Paper weight: 80 g/m 2 , 20 lb *2 When you set custom size paper in the bypass tray, Yo u can specify the size. See Copy Reference . *3 16K( Shi-L ui-K ai) = 195 × 267 mm , 7.7" × 10.6" *4 Set one sheet at a time for[...]

  • Seite 105

    Copy Paper 95 8 Important ❒ If you use damp or curled p aper, a misfeed might occur. In such a case, try turning over the paper stack in the paper tray. If there is no improvement, change to copy pap er with l ess cur l. Note ❒ When using t he bypass tray, we recom mend you set the c opy paper direct ion to L . ❒ When prin ting on envel opes,[...]

  • Seite 106

    Specificat ions 96 8 Note ❒ Do not use any of the following kinds of paper o r a misfeed mi ght occur. • Bent, fo lded, or c reased paper • Torn pa per • Slippe ry paper • Perforated pap er • Rough paper • Thin pa per tha t has low stiffn ess • Paper with a dusty surf ace ❒ If you make copie s on rough grain paper, the co py image[...]

  • Seite 107

    97 INDEX A Accessing User To ols (System Se ttings) , 26 Address B ook , 42 Print List , 37 Address B ook Manage ment , 36 ADF , 13 , 92 AOF (A lways O n) , 37 Auto Document F eeder , 13 , 92 Auto off timer , 31 Auto reset timer , 31 copier , 32 facsimile , 32 sca nner , 32 B Bypass tray , 12 C Changin g a group name , 67 Changing a registered e-ma[...]

  • Seite 108

    98 K Key Count er Manage ment , 33 Key Operator Code , 33 Key Operator Tools , 33 Key Repeat , 28 L Lower ri ght cove r , 12 M Main po wer in dicator , 11 Main po wer switch , 11 Main unit , 89 Measure ment U nit , 29 Multi-acce ss , 21 O On indicator , 12 Operating environment , 87 Operatio n switch , 12 Other items , 13 , 92 P Panel Tone , 28 Pap[...]

  • Seite 109

    99 MEMO StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 99 Monda y, December 22, 2003 2:1 5 PM[...]

  • Seite 110

    100 AE AE B129-6708 MEMO StellaC2_AEzen_F_FM.boo k Page 100 Monday, December 22, 2003 2:15 PM[...]

  • Seite 111

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 108 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.320000 mm In accor dance wi th IEC 6 0417, thi s machine u ses the f ollowi ng symbols for th e main pow er switc h: a a a a means POWER O N. c c c c means STAND [...]

  • Seite 112

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 108 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.320000 mm Operat ing Instr uctions General Settings Guide Read th is manual caref ully bef ore you use th is prod uct and keep i t handy for fut ure refe rence. F[...]

  • Seite 113

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=64 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.200000 mm 1515/1515PS/1515F/1 515MF Operatin g Instructions Copy Reference RICO H COMP ANY, LT D. 15-5, Mi nami Aoyam a 1-chome, Minato- ku, Tokyo 107 -8544, Japan Phone: +8[...]

  • Seite 114

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=64 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.200000 mm Declar ation of Confor mity “ The Product complies with the re quirement s of the EMC Di rective 89/ 336/EEC and its amendi ng di- recti ves and th e Low Volt ag[...]

  • Seite 115

    i Manuals f or This M achine The following manuals describe the oper ational procedures of this ma chine. For particular functions, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine ty pe. ❒ Adobe Acr obat Reader is nec essary to view t he manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are provided: • CD-ROM 1 &q[...]

  • Seite 116

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBind er V2 Lite DeskTopB inder V2 Lit e is a ut ility included o n the CD-ROM label ed "Scann er Driv er & Docu men t Mana geme nt Ut ilit ies". • DeskTopBin der V2 Lite Setup Guide ( PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes installation of, and the operating environment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in deta[...]

  • Seite 117

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machin e ...... ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . i Notice ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ... 1 How to Read Thi s Manual . ........ ..... ........ ....[...]

  • Seite 118

    iv 3. Troubleshootin g If Your Machi ne Does Not Opera te As You Want... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ...... ... 33 When a Message Is Dis played............. .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... ........ 3 3 If You Cannot Ma ke Clear Copi es....... ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ....... ...... [...]

  • Seite 119

    1 Notice Importa nt Do not m ake copies of any item for w hich copying is proh ibited by law. Copying the following items is norma lly prohi bited by local law: Bank billes, revenue stamp s, bonds, stock certificates, bank drafts, checks, pass- port s, d riv er' s li cens es. Notice To Wireless LAN Interface (optional ) Users Notice to Us ers [...]

  • Seite 120

    2 How to Read This Manual Symb ols The f ollowing se t of sy mbols is u sed in thi s manual . R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic [...]

  • Seite 121

    3 Safety Information When using th is machine, the fol lowing safety precautions shoul d always be fol- lowed. Safety Duri ng Operation In th is manu al, the f ollowing i mportant symbo ls are used : R WARNIN G: R WARNING: Indicates a potentially h azardous situation w hich, if instru ctions are not followed, could result in death or serious injury[...]

  • Seite 122

    4 R CAUT ION: • Protect the machine from dampness or wet wea ther, such as rain and snow. • Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the machine, you should take care that the po wer cord will not be damag ed under the machin e. • When you disconnect the power plug from the wall outlet, always pull [...]

  • Seite 123

    5 Positions of R R R R WARNING and R R R R CAUTION Labels This ma chine h as la bels for R WARN ING and R CAUTION at the positions shown below. For safety, please follo w the instructions and handl e the machine as indi cated. The ins ide of this machine gets very hot. Do not to uch the ins ide. Doin g so could result in a burn. A B The an ti-cond [...]

  • Seite 124

    6 Note ❒ The anti-condensati on heater is optional. For details, contact your service rep- resentat ive. StellaC2_GBcopy_F1_pre_FM.bo ok Page 6 Tuesday, Decemb er 16, 2003 4:39 PM[...]

  • Seite 125

    7 Control Panel ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copi er only ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax, printer and/or scann er installed 1. { { { { Copy } } } } key Press to activate t he copier func tion. 2. Indicators Display errors and ma chine status. • h : Error indicator See “ Control Panel ” , Genera l Setting s Guide . • D : Add Toner indicato r See p.38 “ D Adding T[...]

  • Seite 126

    8 10. On i n dic ator Lights when the operation switch is on. Referenc e p.10 “ Turning On the Power ” 11. Oper ation swi tch Press to turn the power on. The On indi- cator lights. To tu rn the power off, press agai n. Note ❒ This key is inactivate during scanning or while setting defaults. 12. { { { { Duplex } } } } key Makes two-sided copie[...]

  • Seite 127

    9 Reading the Display and Using Keys The display is not to uch sensitive. Use the following keys to select the keys and items displayed on the screen. 1. Selecti on keys Correspond to items at the bottom line on the di spl ay. Exa mple: w hen t he com bine fu ncti on is set • When the instruction “ press [ 100% ] ” appears in this manua l, pr[...]

  • Seite 128

    10 Turning On t he Powe r This machi ne has two power swit ch- es. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Operation swit ch (right side of the contr ol pan el) Press to activate the machine. When th e machi ne has fini shed warming up, you can operate the mach ine. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Main power switch (l eft side of the ma- chine) Turning off this switch makes the main powe[...]

  • Seite 129

    11 Turni ng Off the Po wer A A A A Make sure the exp osure glas s cov- er, or ADF (Auto Docu ment Feed- er) is in the right position. B B B B Press the operation switch. The On indi cato r goes of f. Note ❒ Even if you press the operation switch, th e indicator does not go out, but blinks in the follow- ing ca se: • During comm unication with e[...]

  • Seite 130

    12 Saving Energy • Low Power/ Auto Off The machine automatically enters Low Power mode automatically after a jo b is finis hed, and the se- lected time elapsed . After a spec ified period has passed, follow ing job completion, the mach ine auto matic ally turns off, in order to conserve energy. This fun ctio n is c alled “ Auto Off ” . Note ?[...]

  • Seite 131

    13 1. Placing Originals Origina ls Sizes a nd Weights of Recommended Originals ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Metric version ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Inch version Note ❒ Abo ut 3 0 ori gin als c an b e pl aced in th e AD F. Non-compatible ori ginals for the ADF Placing the following types of originals in the ADF can caus e paper misfeeds or re- sult in damage to the ori[...]

  • Seite 132

    Placing Origi nals 14 1 Note ❒ The ori ginal mi ght becom e dirty if it is writte n with a pencil o r a simil ar tool. Sizes Sele ctable as Regul ar Size Originals Yo u can s elec t the f ollow ing origin al si zes on the displ ay: A4 L , B5 JIS (Jap an Industria l Standard) L , A5 KL , 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L *1 , 8 1 / 2 " × 13"[...]

  • Seite 133

    Placin g Originals 15 1 Placing Or iginals Note ❒ Take care to plac e origi nals only af - ter any corr ection fluid and ink has completel y dried. N ot taking this prec aution cou ld cause ma rks on the exposure glass that will be cop- ied on to pape r. Referenc e For or igina l si zes y ou can set, se e p.13 “ Or iginals ” . Original O rien[...]

  • Seite 134

    Placing Origi nals 16 1 Placing Ori ginals in the ADF Note ❒ Do not st ack orig inals ove r the li m- it mark on the side fence of the ADF. ❒ The last page should be on the bot- tom. ❒ Do not place anything on the ADF cover, doing so coul d cau se a mal- function. A A A A Set the document guide to the original size. B B B B Align the edges of[...]

  • Seite 135

    Placin g Originals 17 1 D D D D Select the paper size using the scroll key s, and t hen press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Accept ed ” message a ppears. When the regul ar size origin als settings are registered , appears at the top of the c opy dis- play. Note ❒ To cancel the registered original size, press th e { { { { Clear Modes } } [...]

  • Seite 136

    Placing Origi nals 18 1 D D D D Enter the horizontal size of the original using the number key s, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ If you make a m istake, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key, and then enter the value again. E E E E Enter the vertical size of the origi- nal using the number ke ys, and then press the { { { { O[...]

  • Seite 137

    19 2. Copying Basi c Procedure A A A A If th e machine has use r cod es se t, enter a user code (up to eight dig- its) using the number keys, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } or { { { { # } } } } key. The ma chine is ready to copy. Referen ce For user co des, see “ Key Oper a- tor Tools ” , Gene ral Settings Guide . B B B B Make s ure &quo[...]

  • Seite 138

    Copying 20 2 Copying from the By pass Tray Use th e bypass tray to copy ont o OHP transpa rencies, th ick pap er, enve - lopes and copy paper that cannot be loaded in the paper trays. Important ❒ Paper of 357 mm in length, or larg- er, is li kely to jam, creas e, or not feed in pr operly. Limitatio n ❒ You cannot use the duplex func- tion when [...]

  • Seite 139

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 21 2 C C C C Insert the p aper with the side you want to copy facing down, and then adjust the paper guide with the paper si ze. 1. Horizontal size 2. Vertical size 3. Extender 4. Paper guid es Note ❒ If the guides are not flush against the copy paper, images might be skew ed or paper mi s- feeds might occur. ❒ Do [...]

  • Seite 140

    Copying 22 2 When copying onto regular size pa per A A A A Make sur e the b ypa ss tr ay i s se- lected. Note ❒ If any other paper tray is sele ct- ed, using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } to sele ct the bypass tray. B B B B Pre ss th e { { { { # } } } } key . C C C C Sele ct [ Pap er Size ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {[...]

  • Seite 141

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 23 2 F F F F Enter the vertical size of the origi- nal using the number ke ys, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Accept ed ” message a ppears. When copying onto special pap er A A A A Make sur e the b ypa ss tr ay i s se- lected. Note ❒ If any other paper tray is sele ct- ed, using { { { {U U U U} [...]

  • Seite 142

    Copying 24 2 E E E E Select the envelope si ze from [ C6 env L L L L ] [ C5 env L L L L ] [ DL env L L L L ] , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Accept ed ” message a ppears. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { # } } } } key . G G G G Sele ct [ Paper T ype ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { [...]

  • Seite 143

    Copier Fu nctions 25 2 Copier Functi ons Adjustin g Image Densi ty You can adj ust copy image de nsity to match your or igina ls. If you require darker or lighter cop- ies, adjust image density accordingly. A A A A Pre ss t he { { { { Lighter } } } } or { { { { Darker } } } } key to adjust the density. The image density changes in five increments a[...]

  • Seite 144

    Copying 26 2 Selecting Copy Paper Choose the tr ay containing the paper you want to copy onto: a pape r tray or the bypass tray. A A A A Select t he paper tra y or bypass tray using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } . The selected tray and the paper size appear. Referen ce p.20 “ Copyi ng from th e Bypass Tray ” Preset Reduce/ Enla[...]

  • Seite 145

    Copier Fu nctions 27 2 C C C C Select a ratio using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Accept ed ” message a ppears. D D D D Place your originals, and th en pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Zoom You can chan ge the re product ion ra- tio in in crement s of 1%. Note ❒ You can[...]

  • Seite 146

    Copying 28 2 Sor t You can scan origin als into mem ory and automatically sort copies. Copies are assembled as sequentially ordere d s ets. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Sort } } } } key. Note ❒ When can celing the Sor t func- tion, pres s the { { { { Sor t } } } } key, and make sure the { { { { Sort } } } } key indi ca- tor is o ff. B B B B Enter [...]

  • Seite 147

    Copier Fu nctions 29 2 Duplex ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ 1 Sided → → → → 2 Sided Copies 2 one-sided pa ges onto 1 two-si ded page . Original o rientation and completed copies The r esulting copy image wi ll diffe r according to the orientation in which you place th e originals (vertical K or horizontal L ). *1 The table shows the orientat ion of im- a[...]

  • Seite 148

    Copying 30 2 B Select t he copy orie ntation us - ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Accepted ” message ap- pear s. B B B B Place your originals. When placing originals on the exposure glass A Place the original, and th en press th e { { { { Sta rt } } } } key. Note ❒ Start [...]

  • Seite 149

    Copier Fu nctions 31 2 To select the orientation Note ❒ You can se lect th e origin al ori- entation when [ Alwa ys Spec ify ] is selected in [ Orient ation ] under [ Copier Features ] (User Tools). See p.44 “ Orie nta tion ” . A Select the orientation usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } }[...]

  • Seite 150

    Copying 32 2 To select the orientation Note ❒ You can se lect th e origin al ori- entation when [ Alwa ys Spec ify ] is selected in [ Orient ation ] under [ Copier Features ] (User Tools). See p.44 “ Orie nta tion ” . A Select the original orientation using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } }[...]

  • Seite 151

    33 3. Troubleshooting If Your Mac hine Does Not Operate As You Want When a Message Is Dis played The following chart cont ains explanations for common messages. If other mes- sages appear, follow the instr uctions as they are displayed. Note ❒ For messages not listed here, see General Set tings Guide . Messa ge Causes Soluti ons Cannot du p. cop [...]

  • Seite 152

    Troublesh ooting 34 3 If You Cannot Make C lear Copies Prob lem Ca uses Sol utio ns Copies appear dirty . Image density is too dark. Adjust the image density. S ee p.25 “ Adjusting Image Density ” . The reverse side of an orig- inal image is copied. Image density is too dark. Adjust the image density. See p.25 “ Adjusting Image Density ” . [...]

  • Seite 153

    If You Cannot Ma ke Copies As You Wan t 35 3 If You Cannot Make Copies As You Want This section e xplains causes and remedies whe n copy results are not as expec t- ed. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Basic ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Combine ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Duplex Prob lem Ca uses Sol utio ns You can not combi ne sever- al fu nct io ns. Selecte d functions ca nnot be used to[...]

  • Seite 154

    Troublesh ooting 36 3 When Memor y Is Ful l Messa ges Cause s Solution s Memory i s ful l. [Prin t] sc anned orig., [C lear ] to cance l/cle ar memory. [ Clear ][ Pr int ] Note ❒ Copying will stop and this messag e will be displayed whe n the memory is ful l. The scanned original exceeds th e number of pages that can b e stored in memor y. Press [...]

  • Seite 155

    B Loading Paper 37 3 B B B B Loading Paper Referenc e For paper types and sizes, see Gen- eral Settings Guide . Loading Paper Note ❒ You can change the paper size, see General Settings Guid e . ❒ This illust ration show s Tray 1. A A A A Pull the paper tray out slowly un- til it stops. B B B B Push the met al pla te down, and then square the pa[...]

  • Seite 156

    Troublesh ooting 38 3 D D D D Adding Toner When D appea rs, it is time to add ton er. Handling Toner R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ Faults may occur if you use toner other t han the reco mmended type. ❒ When addin g toner, do not turn off the operation swit ch. If you do, settings will be lost . ❒ Always add toner when t he machine i nstr[...]

  • Seite 157

    Removing Tone r 39 3 Removing Toner • 1: Open the fron t cover of the machine. • 2: Lift the green le ver. • 3: Push the green lever, and then gently pull out the h older. • 4: Press the toner bottle back to raise its top, and then gently pu ll it out. ABU033S ABU034S Stel laC2_GB copy_F 1_pre _FM.book Page 39 Tues day, Dec ember 16, 20 03 [...]

  • Seite 158

    Troublesh ooting 40 3 Inserting Toner • 1: Hold the new bottle hori zontally and shake it from side to side five or six times. 2: Remove the black cap. Note ❒ Do not remove the black cap before shak ing . ❒ Do not remove the inner cap. • 3: Put the toner bottle on the holder, and then pull its top forwar d. • 4: Push in the green lever un[...]

  • Seite 159

    41 4. User Tools (Copier Features) Accessi ng User T ools (Copi er Features) This sectio n is for key operator s in charge of this machine. Key operators can change o r make default settings. Note ❒ B e s u r e t o q u i t U s e r T o o l s a n d r e - turn to the init ial copy display when all settings ar e complete. This se ction de scribe s sy[...]

  • Seite 160

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 42 4 D D D D Change settings by following in- struction s on the dis play, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ Programmed ” m essage ap- pears. Note ❒ To discontinue the op eration and retu rn to the initial d isplay, press the { { { { User Tools /Counter } } } } key. Quitting User Tools A A A A Pre[...]

  • Seite 161

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 43 4 Settings You Can C hange with User Tools Auto Tray Switch ing If you load paper of the same size and in the s ame orientation in two trays, the machine autom atically shifts to the other tray when the first t ray runs out of paper. This function is called "Auto Tray Switching". This setting s[...]

  • Seite 162

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 44 4 Orie ntatio n • You ca n select the origin al orie nta- tion when makin g Combine cop- ies. Note ❒ Default: Do not Specify ❒ When you s ele ct [ A lways Speci fy ] , you must select the orientation of origin als. Max. Number of Sets The maximum copy quantity can be set b etween 1 and 99 using num ber keys .[...]

  • Seite 163

    Settings Yo u Can Change w ith User Tools 45 4 Preset R/E Priorit y You can set the ratio with priority when [ R/ E ] is selected. Note ❒ Default: • Metr ic vers ion: 71% • Inch ver sion: 65% Dup lex Mar gin You can specify left margin on the bac k side of co pies , and top marg in on th e fron t sid e. Se lect [ Top Margin ] or [ Left Mar gi[...]

  • Seite 164

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 46 4 Stel laC2_GB copy_F 1_pre _FM.book Page 46 Tues day, Dec ember 16, 20 03 4:3 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 165

    47 5. Remarks Do's and Don'ts R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ Do not tu rn the power off while the On indicator is lit or blinking. Doi ng so ma y dama ge th e memo- ry. ❒ Before unplugging th e power co rd or turning off the m ain power switch, make sure remaining memory space is at 100%, as shown on the di splay. See p .11 “ Turning O ff [...]

  • Seite 166

    Remarks 48 5 Where to P ut Your Machine Machi ne En viron ment Choose your m achi ne's locati on ca re- fully. Environmental conditions greatly affect its p erformance. Optimum environm ental conditions R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: • Temperature: 10- 32 ° C (50-89.6 ° F) (humidity to be 54% at 32 ° C, 89.6 ° F) • Humi dity: 15 -80% (tem per[...]

  • Seite 167

    Where to Put Your Machine 49 5 Moving R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ Be careful when m oving the ma- chine. Take the following prec au- tions: • Turn off the main powe r. Se e p.11 “ Tur ning Off the Ma in Power ” . • Unplu g the po wer co rd from the wall outlet . When you pull out the plug fro m the socket, grip the plug to av oid [...]

  • Seite 168

    Remarks 50 5 Access to the Machine Plac e the ma chine nea r th e power source, pr oviding the clearance ar eas shown. 1. Rear : 1 cm (0.4") or mo re 2. Right: 1 cm (0.4" ) or mor e 3. Front: 75 cm (29.6") or more 4. Left: 1 cm (0.4") or more Note ❒ For the requ ired space when op- tions are insta lled, contact yo ur service r[...]

  • Seite 169

    Mainta ining Your Machin e 51 5 Maintaining Yo ur Machine If the exposure glass, ex posure glass co v er , o r A DF be l t is d ir ty , c op y c la ri - ty may be reduced. Clean these parts if they are d irty. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Cleani ng the machine Wipe the machine with a soft, damp cloth. Then wipe it wi th a dry cloth to remo ve the water. Importa[...]

  • Seite 170

    Remarks 52 5 Stel laC2_GB copy_F 1_pre _FM.book Page 52 Tues day, Dec ember 16, 20 03 4:3 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 171

    53 6. Specifications Combination C hart The combination ch art below shows which functions can be used together. When you read the chart, see the following table: The f ollowi ng shows th e combin ation s of functi ons. ❍ These functions can be used together . $ Thes e fu ncti ons canno t be used tog ether . Th e seco nd fu nct ion s elec ted wi [...]

  • Seite 172

    Specificat ions 54 6 Supplemen tary Information ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Bypass Tray Copy • The following paper sizes can be selected as standard sizes: A4 L , A5 KL , B5 JI S L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L , 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " KL , 7 1 / 4 " × 10 1 / 2 " L , 8" × 13" L , 8 1 / 2 " [...]

  • Seite 173

    Supplemen tary Info rmation 55 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Inch version ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Zoom • The repr oduction ratios you can s pecify ar e 50 – 200%. • You can s elect a rat io regard less of the siz e of an or iginal or copy paper . With so me ratios , parts of the im age might not be copi ed or ma rgins w ill appear o n copies. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Dup[...]

  • Seite 174

    Specificat ions 56 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Combine • When usi ng this function, the machine selects the rep roduction ra tio auto- matical ly. This reprodu ction rati o depe nds on origi nal siz es, if spec ified, or copy pa per size s. • If the c alcul ated rat io is u nder the minimu m ratio, it is automa tically ad- justed to wit hin availab le ra[...]

  • Seite 175

    57 INDEX 1 sided 2 pag es → combine 1 side , 30 1 sided 4 pag es → combine 2 side , 31 1 sided → 2 si ded , 29 A Accessing U ser Tools , 41 Adding toner , 38 ADF , 16 Adju stin g im age d ensi ty , 25 Auto off , 12 Auto tr ay switchin g , 43 B Basic procedu re , 19 Bypass tray , 20 Bypas s tray c opy , 54 C Cancel key , 8 Changing default set[...]

  • Seite 176

    58 P Pap er loading , 37 Pho to , 25 Placing cus tom size originals , 17 Plac ing o rigin als , 15 in ADF , 16 on exposure g lass , 15 Placing regular size ori ginals , 16 Pow er , 10 Pow er co nne ctio n , 49 Preset reduc e/enlarge , 26 , 54 Preset R/E priority , 45 Q Quitting User Tools , 42 R Reading disp lay , 9 Reduce , 26 , 54 Regular size or[...]

  • Seite 177

    59 MEMO Stel laC2_GB copy_F 1_pre _FM.book Page 59 Tues day, Dec ember 16, 20 03 4:3 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 178

    60 GB GB B129-66 00 MEMO Stel laC2_GB copy_F 1_pre _FM.book Page 60 Tues day, Dec ember 16, 20 03 4:3 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 179

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=64 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.200000 mm Declar ation of Confor mity “ The Product complies with the re quirement s of the EMC Di rective 89/ 336/EEC and its amendi ng di- recti ves and th e Low Volt ag[...]

  • Seite 180

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=64 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.200000 mm 1515/1515PS/1515F/1 515MF Operatin g Instructions Copy Reference RICO H COMP ANY, LT D. 15-5, Mi nami Aoyam a 1-chome, Minato- ku, Tokyo 107 -8544, Japan Phone: +8[...]

  • Seite 181

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=48 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thickness / 2 = 0 mm Operating In structions Printer Reference 1 Operat ing Instr uctions Printer Reference 1 For s afe and co rrect u se of this mach ine, pl ease be sure t o read th e Safet y[...]

  • Seite 182

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=48 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thickness / 2 = 0 mm Declar ation of Conformi ty “The Pro duct complie s with the require ments of the EM C Directi ve 89/336/ EEC and its ame nding di- rectiv es and the Low Volt age Dir ect[...]

  • Seite 183

    i Manuals f or This M achine The following manuals describe the oper ational procedures of this ma chine. For particular functions, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine ty pe. ❒ Adobe Acr obat Reader is nec essary to view t he manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are provided: • CD-ROM 1“[...]

  • Seite 184

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBind er V2 Lite Desk Top Binde r V2 L ite is a ut ilit y incl uded on th e CD- ROM l abe led “ Scanner Driv er & Docu men t Mana geme nt Ut ilit ies ” . • DeskTopBin der V2 Lite Setup Guide ( PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes installation of, and the operating environment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in de[...]

  • Seite 185

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machin e ...... ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . i How to Read Thi s Manual . ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ... 1 1. Getting S tarted Control Pane l......... ..... ........ ..... ........ [...]

  • Seite 186

    iv Stel laC2-GB- Pref1 -F3_FM_ ZF.book Page i v Fri day, No vember 2 1, 200 3 8:42 PM[...]

  • Seite 187

    1 How to Read This Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbo l indicates a potentially h azardous situation wh ich, if instructions are not follow ed, c ould resu lt in deat h or seriou s in jury . R CAUTIO N: This symbo l indicates a potentially h azardous situation wh ich, if instructions are no t fol[...]

  • Seite 188

    2 Names of Major Compone nts and Softwar e The followi ng software products are r eferred to using a general name : • DeskTopBinder V2 Lite and DeskTopBinder V2 professional → DeskTop- Binde r V2 Lit e/prof essi onal • Sca nRou ter V2 Li te an d Sc anRo ute r V2 prof essio nal ( opti onal ) → Sca nRou ter V2 Lite/professional Stel laC2-GB- [...]

  • Seite 189

    3 1. Getting Started Control Panel 1. { { { { Printer } } } } key Press to activate the printer func tion. 2. Indicators Displays errors and ma chine status. h : Error indicator. S ee Ne twork G uide and Gen eral Settings Guide . B : Load Paper indicator. See Copy Refer- ence . D : Add Toner indicator. See Copy R efer- ence . 3. Disp lay Displays o[...]

  • Seite 190

    Getting Sta rted 4 1 Reading t he Display and Using Keys This section explains how to r ead the display and using the selection ke y for the initia l display . Note ❒ The copy displ ay is set as the d efault sc reen whe n the machi ne is turned on. You can change the set tings in [ System Se ttings ] . See General Settings Guide . 1. Selecti on k[...]

  • Seite 191

    5 2. Preparin g to Print This section gi ves instructions for connecting the machine and computer, config- uring the m achine, and installing so ftware. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When operating the mach ine with a USB connection , parallel connection, or IEEE 1394 (SCSI print) conne ction • Connect the mac hine and computer using a US B cable, a parallel c[...]

  • Seite 192

    Preparing to Print 6 2 Preparing the Machine Conn ecti ng t he Machi ne Referenc e For infor mation abou t connection using Ethern et and wirele ss LAN, see "Confirming the Connection", Networ k Guid e . For informa tion about connection using Bluet ooth TM , see the manual that co mes with t he optional Blue- tooth interface u nit. Requi[...]

  • Seite 193

    Prepari ng the Machine 7 2 Connecting the Machine to the hos t using the parall el cable/IEEE 1394 (SCSI print) c able Connect the machin e to the host com- puter using t he optional IEEE 1284 in- terface board or optional IEEE 1394 inte rface boa rd. T his machi ne doe s not c ome with a pa rallel cable to co n- nect the mach ine to the host compu[...]

  • Seite 194

    Preparing to Print 8 2 Setting Pape r on the Bypass Tra y This sect ion giv es instru ctions for set- ting pa per on t he bypass tray. Us e the bypa ss tray to print ont o OHP tra ns- parencie s, labels , thick pap er, and en- velopes that cann ot be loaded in the paper t ray. Referenc e For details about setting p aper in the pap er tray, see Gen [...]

  • Seite 195

    Prepari ng the Machine 9 2 C C C C Gentl y insert pape r face down into the bypass tray. 1. Extender 2. Paper guid es Note ❒ Do not stack paper over the lim- it mark, othe rwise a skewed im- age or misf eed s migh t oc cur. ❒ Open out the ext ender to sup - port paper size s larger than A4 L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L . ❒ Fan the pape r t[...]

  • Seite 196

    Preparing to Print 10 2 D Select [ Bypass P aper Siz e ] , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. E Select t he pape r size usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ When print ing onto thick p a- per or OH P transpar encies, selec t the pape r type . For d e- tails, see p.11 ?[...]

  • Seite 197

    Prepari ng the Machine 11 2 G G G G Enter the horizontal size of the pape r usin g the numbe r keys , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. Setting thick paper or OHP transparencies Note ❒ Paper settings ca n also be set using the printer driver. The following procedures are not ne[...]

  • Seite 198

    Preparing to Print 12 2 Setting envelopes A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Syst em Set ting s ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key . C C C C Sele ct [ Tray Paper Setting s ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , an d then p[...]

  • Seite 199

    Install ing the Sof tware 13 2 Installing the Softwar e This manual assumes you ar e familiar with general Windows procedures and practices. If you a re not, see th e operating instructions that come w ith Windows for details. The proc edure for installing the p rint- er driver depends on th e connection with the co mputer. Wi th a parallel or Ethe[...]

  • Seite 200

    Preparing to Print 14 2 The f ollow ing ta ble sh ows the print er driver s and sof tware that can be in- stalled using Auto Run: *1 Available operating systems are: Win- dows 95/98 /Me, Windows 2000 /XP, Windows Serv er 2003, and Windows NT 4.0. Auto Run i s unav ailable with Macint osh. Quick Inst all Auto Run will star t the inst aller au to- ma[...]

  • Seite 201

    Install ing the Sof tware 15 2 Important ❒ If your system is Windows NT 4.0, we recommend that you upgra de the W indows NT 4 .0 operat ing s y s te m t o S e r v i c e P a c k 4 o r l a t e r before installing the PCL 6/5e or RPCS ™ printer drivers. Contact your Window s retailer for more in- formation about lat est versions. Note ❒ When the[...]

  • Seite 202

    Preparing to Print 16 2 • Win dows XP Profe ssional and Windows Server 2003 On the [ Start ] menu, click [ Printers and Faxe s ] . Th e [ Print- ers and Faxes ] window ap- pears. Ri ght-click the mach ine ic on, an d the n click [ Rename ] . • Windows XP Home E dition On th e [ Start ] men u, click [ Control Pa nel ] . Clic k [ Printers and Oth[...]

  • Seite 203

    Install ing the Sof tware 17 2 • Windows NT 4.0 PCL 6: DRIVERSPCL6 NT4(Language)DIS K1 PCL 5e: DRIVERSPCL5E NT4(Language)DIS K1 RPCS ™ : DRIVERSRPCS NT4(Language)DIS K1 A A A A Quit all applications running. B B B B Insert the CD-ROM into the CD- ROM drive. Auto Run wil l star t the in stall er. C C C C Select a langua ge for[...]

  • Seite 204

    Preparing to Print 18 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ NetB EU I A Click [ NetBEUI ] , and then click [ Se arch ] . A li st of mac hine s that c an be used with Net BEUI ap- pears. B Select the machine yo u want to use, and then c lick [ OK ] . Note ❒ NetBEU I cannot be used under Windows XP or Windows Server 2003. ❒ Machin es th at respond to a broadcast fr [...]

  • Seite 205

    Install ing the Sof tware 19 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ User Code User codes are ei ght digit codes that allow you to keep track of printing done under each code. To use thi s feature, the net work administrator sh ould assign user codes a nd inform users of them before they install the print er driver . Use the followin g meth ods to enter a user co de for[...]

  • Seite 206

    Preparing to Print 20 2 Note ❒ If you cannot set the items on the [ Reco very/Parallel Printi ng ] tab, follow th e procedure be- low. A Click [ Cancel ] to c lose the [ Port Setti ngs ] dia log box . B Start Smar tDeviceMonitor for Clie nt, and th en right- click the SmartDevice- Monitor fo r Client i con on the tas kbar. C Click [ E xten ded Fe[...]

  • Seite 207

    Install ing the Sof tware 21 2 RPCS ™ prin ter dri ver A A A A On the [ Star t ] menu, point to [ Set - tings ] , and then click [ Pr inters ] . The [ Prin ters ] window appears. Note ❒ If using Windows XP Profes- sional or Windows Server 2003, click the [ Print ers and Faxes ] win- dow on the [ Star t ] men u. ❒ I f u si ng W i n d o w s X P[...]

  • Seite 208

    Preparing to Print 22 2 Note ❒ The prin ter driver with t he se- lec ted la ngu age wi ll b e in - stalled. ❒ The pri nter drive r will be in - stalled in English if you select the following languages: Cesti- na, Magya r, Polski , Portug ues, Suomi, an d Russi an. D D D D Click [ PostScri pt 3 Printer Driver ] . Add P rinter Wiza rd starts. E E[...]

  • Seite 209

    Install ing the Sof tware 23 2 A A A A Quit all applications that are ru n- ning . B B B B Insert the CD-ROM into the CD- ROM drive. Auto Run wil l star t the in stall er. C C C C Select a langua ge for the interface language, an d then click [ OK ] . The following l anguages are avail- able: Cestina ( Czech), Dansk (Dan- ish), Deut sch (Germ an), [...]

  • Seite 210

    Preparing to Print 24 2 A A A A On the [ Star t ] menu, point to [ Set - tings ] , and then click [ Pr inters ] . The [ Prin ters ] window appears. Note ❒ In Window s XP Professional or Windows Server 2003, clic k the [ Printers and Fa xes ] window on the [ Start ] men u. ❒ In Win dows XP Ho me Edit ion, access the [ Printers an d Faxes ] windo[...]

  • Seite 211

    Install ing the Sof tware 25 2 Note ❒ The prin ter driver with t he se- lec ted la ngu age wi ll b e in - stalled. ❒ The pri nter drive r will be in - stalled in English if you select the following languages: Cesti- na, Magya r, Polski , Portug ues, Suomi, an d Russi an. D D D D Click [ PostScri pt 3 Printer Driver ] . Add P rinter Wiza rd star[...]

  • Seite 212

    Preparing to Print 26 2 • When bidirec tional t ransmission is running, machin e status and infor- mation can be viewed by opening the prin ter driver screen. To s upport bid irectiona l transm is- sion, the follow ing conditions ar e re- quired : ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When connecting with USB 2.0 • The port on the USB 2.0 in ter- face and the USB po[...]

  • Seite 213

    Install ing the Sof tware 27 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When conn ecting with a paral lel cable • The comp uter must sup port bi- direct ional transm ission. • The mac hine must be set to bidi - rectio nal transmissi on. • The machin e parallel port and com put er pa ral lel por t a re c on- nected using a parallel interface cable that supports bidire[...]

  • Seite 214

    Preparing to Print 28 2 C C C C In the [ Se lect a P ostScript Printer : ] list, click th e name of the mac hine you wa nt to use . D D D D Click [ Setup ] . E E E E Click [ Select PPD ... ] . F F F F Click the prin ter description file you want to use, and then click [ Select ] . G G G G Click [ OK ] . The PP D file is set up , and th e [ Ado- be [...]

  • Seite 215

    Install ing the Sof tware 29 2 Installing screen fonts A A A A Start the Macintosh. B B B B Insert the CD-ROM into the CD- ROM drive. C C C C Double-click the CD-ROM icon. D D D D Do uble -c lic k the [ Mac OS 8 and 9 ] folder. E E E E Do uble -c lick th e [ Fonts ] folder. F F F F Copy th e fonts you wa nt to instal l into the [ Syste m ] fold er [...]

  • Seite 216

    Preparing to Print 30 2 Instal ling the Printer Dri ver Using USB This sect ion gi ves basic instruct ions for i nstal ling prin ter d river s us ing USB. The p rinter drivers can be in- stalled from th e CD-ROM that comes with this mac hine. Prep arat ion Make sure t hat all other applica- tions are cl osed and the c omputer is not prin ting befor[...]

  • Seite 217

    Install ing the Sof tware 31 2 Windows 2000/XP and Wi ndows Server 2003 - Installing the printer driver using USB Limitatio n ❒ Insta lling a pr inter dr iver requires the Administrators permission. Whe n yo u in sta ll a pri nte r dr iver , log on using an accou nt that has Administrator permission. When the USB inter face cable is used for the [...]

  • Seite 218

    Preparing to Print 32 2 H H H H Close the Desktop P rinter Utility. Instal ling the Printer Dri ver Using IEEE 1394 Printing usi ng a SCSI pr int device with the option al IEEE 1394 inter face board i s possible u nder Windows 2000/XP or Windows Server 2003. Prep arat ion Make sure t hat all other applica- tions are cl osed and the c omputer is not[...]

  • Seite 219

    Install ing the Sof tware 33 2 E E E E Hold down the left { { { { SHI FT } } } } key and in sert t he CD-R OM into the CD-ROM drive. Keep the left { { { { SHIFT } } } } key held down unt il the computer has fin- ished accessing the CD-ROM. If the Auto Run program starts, click [ Cancel ] , an d then cl ick [ Exit ] . F F F F Click [ Browse ] . G G [...]

  • Seite 220

    Preparing to Print 34 2 • Window s Me A In the [ Add New Hardwar e Wiz- ard ] dialo g box, confirm that [ Windows ha s found the fol low- ing new Hardware: IEEE SBP-2 Device ] is d ispla yed, a nd click [ Recom mende d search fo r a bet- ter driver [ Recommended] ] , and then click [ Next ] . B When “ Windows was unabl e to locate the sof tware[...]

  • Seite 221

    Install ing the Sof tware 35 2 D When “ Driver Files Searc h Res ults ” appears, click [ Disa- ble the device. The Add /Remove Hardware Wizard i n the Control Pane l ca n be used to c omple te the driver installations. ] , and then click [ Finish ] . Instal ling SmartDev iceMonit or for Clie nt/Admin Limitatio n ❒ If your o perating system is[...]

  • Seite 222

    Preparing to Print 36 2 C C C C Select a langua ge for the interface language, an d then click [ OK ] . The following l anguages are avail- able: Cestina ( Czech), Dansk (Dan- ish), Deut sch (Germ an), English (English), Espanol (Sp anish), Fran- cais (Fre nch), Ita liano (Ita lian), Magy ar (Hu ngarian) , Nederlan ds (Dutc h), No rsk (Nor wegian )[...]

  • Seite 223

    Softwar e and Utilities Included on t he CD-ROM 37 2 Software and Utilit ies Included on the CD- ROM There ar e two CD-R OMs t hat come with this mac hine. • Printer Drivers and Ut ilities • Operating Instructions for Print- er/Scanner The C D-R OM la bel ed “ Printer Driv- ers and Util ities ” is m ainly used for machine printer functions.[...]

  • Seite 224

    Preparing to Print 38 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ PCL printer dri vers Two kin ds of PCL prin ter d rivers : PCL 6 and PCL 5e, are i ncluded on the CD- ROM th at com es with this machine . These drive rs allow the computer to communicat e with the machin e via a printer lan- guage. We recom mend PCL 6 as your f irst ch oice. Note ❒ Some appl ication s may [...]

  • Seite 225

    Softwar e and Utilities Included on t he CD-ROM 39 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ USB Print ing Sup port This ut ility is for t he USB 2 .0 int er- face. Install this to use USB on compute rs ru nning Wi ndow s 98 SE/Me. For information a bout in- stalla tion, see p.30 “ Installing the Printer Driver Using USB ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Acrobat Reader This ut ilit[...]

  • Seite 226

    40 INDEX 1394 Util ity , 38 A Acrobat R eader , 39 ATM Macintosh, installing , 28 B Bidire ctional tran smission , 25 Bypass tray , 8 C CD-ROM , 37 Connection Eth ernet bo ard c onnec ti on , 6 IEEE 1394 interface board connection , 6 Parallel inte rface connect ion , 6 USB con nection , 6 Control P anel , 3 Control p anel , 4 Custom si ze pape r ,[...]

  • Seite 227

    41 S Screen fonts Macintosh, installing , 29 SCSI p rint , 32 Sma rtDev iceMo nit or fo r Admi n , 35 , 38 Sma rtDev iceMo nit or for Clie nt , 35 , 38 Software Quick Install , 14 T Thick Pa per printi ng, bypas s tray , 11 U USB connection printer dr iver, instal ling , 30 USB P rinting Suppo rt , 39 W Windows 2000/XP and Windows Server 2003 PCL 5[...]

  • Seite 228

    42 MEMO Stel laC2-GB- Pref1 -F3_FM_ ZF.book Page 4 2 Fri day, Nov ember 21, 2003 8:42 PM[...]

  • Seite 229

    43 MEMO Stel laC2-GB- Pref1 -F3_FM_ ZF.book Page 4 3 Fri day, Nov ember 21, 2003 8:42 PM[...]

  • Seite 230

    44 GB GB B683-86 17 MEMO Stel laC2-GB- Pref1 -F3_FM_ ZF.book Page 4 4 Fri day, Nov ember 21, 2003 8:42 PM[...]

  • Seite 231

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=48 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thickness / 2 = 0 mm Declar ation of Conformi ty “The Pro duct complie s with the require ments of the EM C Directi ve 89/336/ EEC and its ame nding di- rectiv es and the Low Volt age Dir ect[...]

  • Seite 232

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=48 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thickness / 2 = 0 mm Operating In structions Printer Reference 1 Operat ing Instr uctions Printer Reference 1 For s afe and co rrect u se of this mach ine, pl ease be sure t o read th e Safet y[...]

  • Seite 233

    Operating I nstructions Printer Reference 2 For safe and correct use of this machine, please be sure to read the Safety Information in the "Copy Referen ce" before you use it. Sett ing Up the P rinter Driv er an d Cance ling a Prin t Job Troubl eshoo ting Prin ter F eature s Append ix[...]

  • Seite 234

    Introduction This manu al descri bes detail ed instruc tions o n the operatio n and no tes about the use of this m achine. To get m aximum versat ility fro m this mach ine all operators are requested to read this m anual c arefull y and follo w the in structi ons. Plea se keep t his m anual in a handy p lace n ear the ma chine . Important Contents [...]

  • Seite 235

    i Manuals for This Machine The following manuals describe the operational procedures of this machine. For particular function s, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine type. ❒ Adobe Acrobat Reader is n ecessary to view the manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are pr ovided: • CD-ROM 1“Opera[...]

  • Seite 236

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBinde r V2 Lite DeskTopBinder V2 Lite is a u tility included on the CD-ROM labeled “ Scanner Driver & Document Manag ement Utilities ” . • DeskTopBinder V2 Lite Setup Guide (PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes i nstallation of, and the operating env ironment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in d etail. This guid[...]

  • Seite 237

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machine ...... ....... ....... ....... .......... ....... ....... ........ ....... ....... ....... ...... i How to Read Thi s Manual ...... ....... ......... ......... ....... ........... .......... ......... ....... ......... . 1 1. Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job Accessing Print er Pr[...]

  • Seite 238

    iv[...]

  • Seite 239

    1 How to Read This Manual Symbols In this manual, the following sy mbols are used: R WARNING: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed, could result in death or serious inj ury. R CAUTION: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed,[...]

  • Seite 240

    2 Major Components and Sof tware Major options of this machine are referred to as follows in this manual: • IEEE 1394 In terface Board Type B → IEEE 1394 in terface board • IEEE 802.11b Interfac e Unit Type D → IEEE 802.1 1b interface unit • IEEE 1284 In terface Board Type A → IEEE 1284 inte rface board • BlueTooth Unit Type 2238 → [...]

  • Seite 241

    3 1. Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job Accessing Printer Properties Windows 95/98/ Me - Accessing Pri nter Propert ies Changing default settings A A A A On the [ Sta rt ] menu, point to [ Set- tings ] , and then click [ Pr int ers ] . The [ Pr inters ] window appears . B B B B Click the icon of the machine whose default you wa[...]

  • Seite 242

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 4 1 Windows 2000/XP and Windows Server 2003 - Accessing Pri nter Propert ies Changing default settings - Printer properties Limita tion ❒ Chan ging mac hine se tti ngs re quir es Manage Prin ters permissi on. Mem- bers of Adminis trators and Power Users groups h ave Manage Printers p e r m i[...]

  • Seite 243

    Accessing Printer Properties 5 1 D D D D Make the settings you requ ire, and then click [ OK ] . Note ❒ Settings you make her e are used as default for all applic ations. Making se ttings from an application To make settings for a specific appli- cation, o pen the [ Prin t ] dialog box from that app licat ion. The follow ing exam ple desc ribes h[...]

  • Seite 244

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 6 1 Changing the default set tings - Default document propertie s Limita tion ❒ Chan ging mac hine se tti ngs re quir es Full Control access permission. Members of the Ad ministrators, Ser ver Op era tors , Pri nt Ope rat ors, and Power User s grou ps ha ve Full Control permission by default[...]

  • Seite 245

    Accessing Printer Properties 7 1 Macintosh - Setting Up for Printi ng Making paper s ettings from an application A A A A Open the file you w ant to print. B B B B On the [ File ] menu, click [ Page Set - up ] . The [ AdobePS Page Setup ] dialog box appears. C C C C Make sure the machine you want to use is shown in the [ Pri nter : ] box. Note ❒ I[...]

  • Seite 246

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 8 1 Canceling a Print Job Windows - Can celing a Prin t Job A A A A Double-click the printer icon on the Windows taskbar. A window appears, showing all print jobs curre ntly que ued for printing. Check the current status of th e job you wan t to ca ncel. B B B B Select the name of the job you [...]

  • Seite 247

    Canceling a Print Job 9 1 Macintosh - Cancel ing a Print Job Mac OS A A A A Double-click the printer icon on the desktop. A window appears, showing all print jobs curre ntly que ued for printing. Check the current status of th e job you wan t to ca ncel. B B B B Select the name of the job you want to canc el. C C C C Click the pause icon, and then [...]

  • Seite 248

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 10 1 G G G G Press [ Curre nt ] . • [ Current ] : cancel s the print job currently being process ed. • [ Resume ] : resumes printing jobs. A confirmation message appears. H H H H Press [ Yes ] to cancel the print job. Note ❒ Press [ No ] to return to the previ- ous di spla y. Important ?[...]

  • Seite 249

    11 2. Troubleshooting Error & Status Messages on the Display This section describe s the principal me ssages that appear on the displ ay. If a message not described here a ppears, act acco rding to the message. Reference Before turning the main power off, see ‘ Tur ning On the Powe r ’ , Co py Refer- ence . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Status m essage s[...]

  • Seite 250

    Troubleshooting 12 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Alert me ssages Messages/Second m essages Causes Solutions Add ton er Out of toner. Follow instructions inside and replace toner. Toner is running out. I t is time to su pply toner. Chang e Tr ay # to t he foll ow- ing setings: xxx yyy The settin gs of the se lecte d pa- per tray a re different fr om those speci[...]

  • Seite 251

    Error & Status Messages on the Display 13 2 Ethernet Board Err or An error ha s occurred in the Ethernet interface. Turn off the ma in power switc h, and b ack on again . If the me ssage appe ars aga in, contact your sa les or se rvice representative. Exceeded max. p rint size. Press FormFeed/JobReset The page images to be printed exceed the ma[...]

  • Seite 252

    Troubleshooting 14 2 Paper Tray is in us e. The specified paper tray is in use by another function, such as the copier function. Wait until the othe r function has finished using the speci- fied pap er tray. D Toner is almost em pty Add ton er The toner has almos t run out. Replace the toner cartridge soon to prevent poor print quality. Tray # E rr[...]

  • Seite 253

    The Machine Does Not Print 15 2 The Machine Do es Not Print Possible Ca use Solutions Is the power on? Check the cable is securely plugged into the power outlet and the machine. Turn on the main power switch. Is the machine online? If not, press { { { { f f f f Online } } } } on the control panel. Does the Printer key stay red? If so, check the err[...]

  • Seite 254

    Troubleshooting 16 2 When using wireless LAN, is the LED on the wireless LAN card lit or blinking? Confirm the orange LED is lit, and the green LED is lit or blinks during transm ission. Is the wireless LAN being used in ad hoc mode? Turn the main pow er off and back on. See “ Turni ng On th e Pow- er ” , Copy Reference . Otherwise, configure [[...]

  • Seite 255

    The Machine Does Not Print 17 2 Problem Soluti ons Is the Data In indicator blinking or lit after starting the p rin t job ? If not, data is not being sent t o the machine. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When the machine is c onnected to the comput er using the interf ace cable Check the machine port set tings are correct. For parallel p ort connection, port LP T[...]

  • Seite 256

    Troubleshooting 18 2 Is the Data In indicator blinking or lit after starting the p rin t job ? ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Network connection Contact your network adminis trator. Problem Soluti ons[...]

  • Seite 257

    Other Printing Problems 19 2 Other Printing Problems Problem Causes and Sol utions The print on the entire pa ge is fad- ed. If [ T oner Sav ing ] is selected on the [ Print Qualit y ] tab in the p rinter driver, the entire page will be faded when printed. Note ❒ In PostScript 3, click [ Advanced... ] on the [ Paper/Qu ality ] tab, and th en se -[...]

  • Seite 258

    Troubleshooting 20 2 When using Win- dows 95/98/Me, Windows 2000/ XP, or Win- dows NT 4 .0, e i- ther combined printing or book- let print does not come out as ex - pecte d. Make sure the application's paper size and orientation settings match those of the printer driver. If a d ifferent paper s ize an d orienta tion ar e set, select the sa me[...]

  • Seite 259

    Other Printing Problems 21 2 It tak es a lo ng time to com ple te a print jo b. Photographs and other data intens ive pages ta ke a long time for the ma- chine to process, so simp ly wait when printing such data. Changing the following settings with the print er driver may help speed up printing : • PCL 6/5e Select the lowest value for [ Resoluti[...]

  • Seite 260

    Troubleshooting 22 2 Note ❒ If the problem cannot be solved, contac t your sales or servi ce representative. It takes too much time to res ume printing . The da ta i s so larg e or c omp lex that it ta kes t ime t o pr oces s. I f the Data In indicator is blinking, data is being processed. S imply wait until printing resume s. The machine was in [...]

  • Seite 261

    23 3. Printer Features Reference For more information about copier features and system settings, s ee Copy Ref- erence and Gener al Settings Guide . Printer Features Menu There are seven menu i tems in the Printer Features menu: • Paper Inpu t • List/T est Pri nt • Mainte nance • Sys tem • Host Int erface • PCL Menu • PS Menu You can [...]

  • Seite 262

    Printer Features 24 3 System See p.31 “ Sys tem ” . Print Error Report Auto C ontinu e Memory Overflow Memory Usa ge Duplex Copies Edge Smoothing Toner Saving Pri nter Lan gua ge Sub P aper S ize Page Size Letterhead S etting Edge-Edge Print Default Printer Lang. Host Interf ace See p.33 “ Host I nter face ” . I/O B uffe r I/O T imeo ut PCL[...]

  • Seite 263

    Adjusting Printer Features 25 3 Adjusting Printer Features Printer Features allows basic adjustment of operations when using the mac hine as a printe r. Although fact ory default settings are suitable for most printing jobs, Printer Fea- tures gives you acc ess to a number of settings that control basic printer opera- tions. Printer Features settin[...]

  • Seite 264

    Printer Features 26 3 Printer Features Parameters Paper In put ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Bypass Paper Size The size of the paper set in the by- pass tray. Reference For more information about pa- per sizes that can be set in the bypass tray, see General Settings Gui de . For information about setting paper in the byp ass tray, see Printer Refer ence 1 . Note[...]

  • Seite 265

    Printer Features P arameters 27 3 Interpreting the c onfiguration page System R eferenc e ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Un it N umber Displays the serial numbe r assigned to the board by its manuf acturer. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Total Memory Displays the total amount of memory (SDRA M) installed on the printer. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Firmware Vers ion • Printer Displays the[...]

  • Seite 266

    Printer Features 28 3 PCL Menu Displays the settings made under PCL M enu. Reference p.33 “ PCL Menu ” PS Menu Displays the settings made under PS M enu. Reference p.35 “ PS Menu ” Host Int erface Displays the settings mad e under the Host Interface men u. When DHCP is active on the network, the actual IP address, subnet mask and gateway ad[...]

  • Seite 267

    Printer Features P arameters 29 3 Maintenanc e ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Menu Protect This pro ced ure lets y ou protect menu setting s from acci dental change. It makes it impossi ble to change menu setting s with normal procedures un less you perform the required key operations. In a net- work enviro nment, only adminis - trat ors ca n make change s to me [...]

  • Seite 268

    Printer Features 30 3 Canceling Menu Protec t A A A A Press the { { { { User Tools/Counter } } } } key. B B B B Select [ Printer Feat ures ] us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C Select [ Maintenance ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pres s the { { [...]

  • Seite 269

    Printer Features P arameters 31 3 System ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Print Error Report Select this to have an error re port printed when a printer or memory error occurs. • On • Off Note ❒ Def au lt : Off ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Auto Continue You can select this to enab le Auto Con tinue. When it is On, pr inting continues a fter a sys tem error oc- curs. • O[...]

  • Seite 270

    Printer Features 32 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printer Language Normally, the machine should b e set to Au to. If the printer language cannot be detected in Auto, the langu age specifie d by Default Printer Lang. is selected. • Auto • PCL • PS Note ❒ Def au lt : Auto ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Sub Paper Size You can enable the Auto Substitute Paper Size (A4 ?[...]

  • Seite 271

    Printer Features P arameters 33 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Edge-Edge Print Select this to maximize the printa- ble area by minim izing the white space along the edges, to approxi- mately 0.04 inches (1 mm). • Off • On Note ❒ Def au lt : Off ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Default P rinter Lang. You can set the default p rinter lan- guage i f the mac hin e cannot fin [...]

  • Seite 272

    Printer Features 34 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Font Number You can set the ID of the def ault font you w ant to use. • 0 to 50 by 1 Note ❒ Def au lt : 0 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Point Size You can set th e point size you want to use for the selected font. • 4.00 to 999.75 by 0.25 Note ❒ Default: 12.00 ❒ This setting is effe ctive only with variable-space f[...]

  • Seite 273

    Printer Features P arameters 35 3 PS Menu ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Data Format You can sele ct a data fo rmat. • Binar y • TBCP Limitatio n ❒ This sett ing is no t effect ive wh en operating the machine with a paral lel, USB, or EtherTalk con- nect ion. ❒ When operating the machine with a parallel or USB conne c- t i o n , i f b i n a r y d a t a i [...]

  • Seite 274

    Printer Features 36 3[...]

  • Seite 275

    37 4. Appendix Collate If you sele ct the collate function on t he printer driver, the machine will store print data in m emory and auto matically collate the printouts . The collate function can be turned on or off from the prin ter driver. Limita tion ❒ You cann ot use the bypas s tray with this func tion. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Collate Outputs c an b[...]

  • Seite 276

    Appendix 38 4 User Defined Pages Using this functi on, you can s pecify the pag e numbers for each input t ray. Reference For printing methods, see the printer driver He lp. Limita tion ❒ This function is available with the PCL printer driver only. ❒ If [ User Defi ned Pages ] in [ Pape r Selection: ] is selec ted on the [ Pap er ] tab , [ Layo[...]

  • Seite 277

    System Settings (Parallel Connection) 39 4 System Settings (Parallel Connection) Interface Settings/Paral lel Interface ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Parallel Tim ing Specifies the timing for the para llel interface. Norma lly, you do not need to chan ge this setting . • ACK ins ide • ACK ou tsid e • STB d own Note ❒ Def au lt : ACK outsi de ❖ ❖ ❖ [...]

  • Seite 278

    Appendix 40 4 Specifications This se ction cont ains the machine's electrical and hardware sp ecificat ions, in- cluding information about its options. *1 To use NetBE UI, use the Sma rtDeviceMonit or port. Component Specific ations Reso lutio n PCL 6 : 600 dp i PCL 5e: 300 dpi , 600 dp i RPCS ™ : 300 dpi , 600 dpi PostSc ript 3 : 300 dpi , [...]

  • Seite 279

    Specifications 41 4 Options Limita tion ❒ Only one optional interface can be ins talled in the machine at a time. Th ere- fore, the optional IEEE 1394 interface board, the optional IEEE 802.11b inter- face unit (wireless LAN board), the optional IEEE 1284 interface board and the optional Blue tooth interface unit cann ot be installed conc urrentl[...]

  • Seite 280

    Appendix 42 4 IEEE 802. 11b Interfac e Unit T ype D ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Transm ission sp ec.: Based on IEEE 802.11b (wireless L AN) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Protocol: TCP/ IP, NetBEU I, IPX/SPX, AppleTalk Note ❒ SmartDeviceMonitor an d Web browser are supported . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Data tran sfer spe ed: Auto select from below speed 1Mbps, 2Mbps, 5.5Mbps, 11Mbps[...]

  • Seite 281

    43 INDEX B BlueTooth Unit Type 2238 , 42 C Canc eling a job Macin tosh , 9 Windo ws , 8 Config uration pag e , 26 Cont rol panel Printer Feat ures, adjusting , 23 D Data In indicato r , 17 , 21 , 22 Displ ay error messa ges , 11 E Error messages , 11 F Fonts , 40 H Host Int erfa ce , 33 I IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A , 42 IEEE 1394 Interface Bo[...]

  • Seite 282

    44 GB GB B683-8630[...]

  • Seite 283

    Copyri ght © 2003[...]

  • Seite 284

    Operating I nstructions Printer Reference 2 GB GB B683-8630[...]

  • Seite 285

    Operating I nstructions Scanner Reference For safe and correct use of this machine, please be sure to read the Safety Information in the "Copy Referen ce" before you use it. Networ k Scanner Prepa rations f or Use as a Net work Sc anner Settin g Origin als Sendin g Scan F iles by E- mail Using the Network D eliver y Scanner Functi on Usin[...]

  • Seite 286

    Introduction This manu al descri bes detail ed instruc tions o n the operatio n and no tes about the use of this m achine. To get m aximum versat ility fro m this mach ine all operators are requested to read this m anual c arefull y and follo w the in structi ons. Plea se keep t his m anual in a handy p lace n ear the ma chine . Warning: Use of con[...]

  • Seite 287

    i Manuals for This Machine The following manuals describe the operational procedures of this machine. For particular function s, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ The manuals provided are s pecific to machine type. ❒ Adobe Acrobat Reader is n ecessary to view the manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are pr ovided: • CD-ROM 1 &q[...]

  • Seite 288

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBinde r V2 Lite DeskTopBinder V2 Lite is a utility included on the CD-ROM la beled "Scanner Driver & Document Management Utilities". • DeskTopBinder V2 Lite Setup Guide (PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes t he install ation of Des kTopBinde r V2 Lite, an d the operat ing en- vironme nt for D eskTopB [...]

  • Seite 289

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machine ...... ....... ....... ....... .......... ....... ....... ........ ....... ....... ....... ...... i How to Read Thi s Manual ...... ....... ......... ......... ....... ........... .......... ......... ....... ......... . 1 Symbols .. ...... .......... ......... ......... ....... ......... ......... ...[...]

  • Seite 290

    iv 5. Using the Network Delivery Sca nner Function Preparation for Delivering .... ......... ......... ....... ......... .......... ......... ....... ......... ......... . 47 Network Delivery Scanne r Scree n ...... ......... ......... .......... ......... ......... ....... ......... ....... 48 Delivering Scan Files .......... ....... ......... ...[...]

  • Seite 291

    1 How to Read This Manual Symbols In this manual, the following sy mbols are used: Important If this instruc tion is not followed, paper might be misfed, originals might be damaged, or files might be lost. Be sure to read this. Preparation This symbol indicates the prior knowledge or preparations requ ired before op- erating. Note This symb ol indi[...]

  • Seite 292

    2[...]

  • Seite 293

    3 1. Network Scanner Outline The machine c an be used as a network scanne r. As a network scanner, the machi ne can send s can files by e-mail, operate as a net- work delivery sca nner, and operate as a network TWAIN scanner. E-mail Scan files that are attached to a n e-mail can be sent using the e-mail system through a LA N or the Internet. Refere[...]

  • Seite 294

    Network Scanner 4 1 Network De livery Scanner The machine is used as a delivery scanner with ScanRouter V2 Lite/Profession- al. Scan files are stored i n the delivery server and delivered to the folders of c li- ent computers on the same network. Reference p.47 “ Using the Netw ork Deli very Sc anner Func tion ” Note ❒ When the optional ScanR[...]

  • Seite 295

    Outline 5 1 Network T WAIN Scan ner The scan ning func tion of this m achine ca n be used from a client computer via a network (Ethernet, IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394) [optional], or IEEE 802.11b (Wire- less LAN) [optional]). Reference p.61 “ Using the Netw ork T WAIN Scanne r Func tion ” 1. This machine The scanning function of the machine can be u[...]

  • Seite 296

    Network Scanner 6 1 Control Panel This illustration sh ows the control panel when options ar e installed. 1. { { { { Searc h D estin atio n } } } } key Press to sea rch for th e destination fr om the Destination L ist. 2. { { { { Check Des tination } } } } key Press to check the de stinations curre ntly selected. 3. { { { { Job Information } } } } [...]

  • Seite 297

    Control Panel 7 1 14. Qui ck Dial ke ys Press to select the registered destin ation with a sing le tou ch, or to enter lette rs and symbols. Reference For mo re info rmation , see General Settings Guide . Note ❒ You can regist er up to 16 de stinati ons using the Quick Dial keys. 15. { { { { Lighter } } } } and { { { { Darke r } } } } keys Press [...]

  • Seite 298

    Network Scanner 8 1[...]

  • Seite 299

    9 2. Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner To use the machin e as a network scan ner, you must make settings requ ired for use as a scan ner as well as basi c settings for use in a network. Reference Firs t, se e General Settin gs Guide for details about how to m ake basic settings , and then m ake scanner setti ngs. For more information about [...]

  • Seite 300

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 10 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Send Settings For explanations of settings, s ee p.14 “ Send Settings ” . Setting procedure A A A A Press the { { { { User Tools/Counter } } } } key. B B B B Select [ Scanner Featur es ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key[...]

  • Seite 301

    Initial Scanner Setup 11 2 D D D D Select a setting using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. Example: TWAIN Standby Time setting E E E E Change the settings. • Se lec t an item us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. • Enter numb[...]

  • Seite 302

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 12 2 Scan Se ttings This section explains how to set the defaults for scan settings . The scan settings consist of the fol- lowing. F or the list about settin gs and defaults, see p .9 “ Scanner Features ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Default S can Settings Resolution and scan size can be set. • Resolution Selec[...]

  • Seite 303

    Initial Scanner Setup 13 2 Selecti ng a cust om size When sel ect ing [ Custom Size ] as the scan size, fol low th e procedu re be- low. A A A A Select [ Cust om Size ] on t he S ca n Size screen using the scroll keys, and th en pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. B B B B Enter the width of the original us- ing the number keys. Enter the va lue in H[...]

  • Seite 304

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 14 2 Send Se ttings This section explains how to set the defaults fo r sendi ng settings and how the machine switches to the network TWAIN scan ner func tion. The send settings consist of the fol- lowing. F or the list about settin gs and defaults, see p .9 “ Scanner Features ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ TWAIN S[...]

  • Seite 305

    Initial Scanner Setup 15 2 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Divide & Send E-mail This function is ef fective only whe n [ On ] is selecte d for [ Max. E- mail Size ] . When an e-mail with an attached file exceeds the size spec ified in [ Max. E- mail Size ] , select whether or not to divid e the file and send us - ing more than one e-mail. Selec t ei- ther [ On[...]

  • Seite 306

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 16 2 Installing Software The m achi ne com es with three C D-RO Ms con taini ng vari ous so ftwar e. The CD-ROM labeled “ Scanner Driver & Document Management Utilities ” con- tains the necessary softw are to use the machin e as a network sc anner. The CD- ROM labeled “ Printer Driver & Utili [...]

  • Seite 307

    Installing Software 17 2 The install ing sequence using Auto Ru n is as follows. For information about the software that can be installed by Auto Run, see p.20 “ Software Supplied o n CD-ROM ” . Installation Sequence The installer starts up. The installation complete message is displayed. Select the software. Insert the CD-ROM. Restart your PC.[...]

  • Seite 308

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 18 2 Software for Usi ng a Network TWAIN Scan ner To use the ma chine as a networ k TWAI N scanner, it is esse ntial to install the TWAIN dr iver. I f y o u d o n o t h a v e a p p l i c a t i o n s t h a t w o r k w i t h T W A I N , i t i s n e c e s s a r y t o a l s o install DeskTopBinder V2 Lite. For [...]

  • Seite 309

    Installing Software 19 2 Software f or Using the Network Del ivery Scanne r Function To use the machine as a network delivery sc anner, it is essential to instal l Scan- Router V2 Lite on the delivery server. To check an in-tray or retr ieve files, it is necessary to install DeskTopBinder V2 Lite on the cli ent computer. Use Auto Run for installati[...]

  • Seite 310

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 20 2 Reference For information about the subsequent installation procedure, see Setup Guide that c an be d ispla yed from the S etup screen o f De skTopB inde r V2 Li te. Software Supp lied on CD-ROM List of file s TWAIN Driver This driver is requ ired to scan an original on th e machine. To use the machine[...]

  • Seite 311

    Installing Software 21 2 • Memor y Operating syste m minimum operat ion memory + 8 MB (64 MB or mor e recomm ended) • Hard dis k spa ce 100 MB or more • Displa y resolutio n 800 × 600 pi xels, 256 colours or h igher • Network p rotocol TCP/IP DeskTopBinder V2 Lite DeskTopBinder V2 Lite is to be installed on the client computers for integra[...]

  • Seite 312

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 22 2 • Hard dis k spa ce 50 MB or more (200 MB or more recommended) • Displa y resolutio n 800 × 600 pi xels, 64K colours or higher • Network p rotocol TCP/IP ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Software installed with DeskTopBinder V2 Lite • Auto Doc ument Li nk A u t o D o c u m e n t L i n k o n t h e c l i e n t c[...]

  • Seite 313

    Installing Software 23 2 • Hardware PC/AT compatible • CPU Pentium 200 MHz or faster (Penti um II 350 MHz or faster recommended) • Oper ating sy stem Micr osof t Wind ows 95 ( OSR 2 or la ter ) Micr osof t Wind ows 98 Micr osof t Wind ows Mi llenn ium E diti on Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional (Service Pac k 1 or later) Microsoft Windows 2[...]

  • Seite 314

    Preparations for Use as a Network Scanner 24 2[...]

  • Seite 315

    25 3. Setting Originals This chapter ex plains the proced ure for placing original s on the exposure glass and in the Auto Document Feeder (ADF), and setting the original sc an area and orientation according to the placement m ethod. To correctly display the top/bottom orientation of the scanned original on a cli- ent computer, the plac ement of th[...]

  • Seite 316

    Setting Originals 26 3 Placing on the Exp osure Gla ss Originals which do not fit into the ADF, such as shee ts with glue d-on parts, books, etc., can be placed di- rectly on the exposure glass for scan- ning. Note ❒ For information about the origi- nals which can be place d on th e ex- posure glass , see Copy R eference . A A A A Lift the exposu[...]

  • Seite 317

    Placing Originals 27 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When plac ing the original so that the t op edge touches t he top left of the exposure glass Wh en us ing the mach ine as a network TWAIN sca nner, this orientation is the standard set- ting for the TWAIN d river. Nor- mally , use t his orien tation for placing originals. 1. Positioning mark C C C C Lower the [...]

  • Seite 318

    Setting Originals 28 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When placing the top e dges of the originals firs t Wh en us ing the mach ine as a network TWAIN sca nner, this orientation is the standard set- ting for the TWAIN d river. Nor- mally , use t his orien tation for placing originals. Note ❒ Originals are scann ed in the in- serted order, starting with the topm[...]

  • Seite 319

    Original Orientation 29 3 Original Orientation To correctly display the top/bottom orientation of a scanned original on a client compute r, original orien tation must be set when placing th e original. When using the e-mail fu nction or the network deliver y scanner function, settings are made on the c ontrol pa nel of the machine . When usi ng the[...]

  • Seite 320

    Setting Originals 30 3 Scanning Originals in Several Times using the Exposure Glass A A A A Place the originals. Reference p.25 “ Pla cin g O rig ina ls ” Note ❒ Or ig inal s a re sca nn ed in o rde r. Place them from the first page. B B B B Make setti ngs for sca nning ar ea and original orien tation. Reference p.29 “ Original Orientation [...]

  • Seite 321

    31 4. Sending Scan Files by E- mail Scan files ca n be sent from this machine to a specifi ed destination using e-mail. This chapter explains the preparation for sending scan files by e-mail, various display screens, procedures for sending, and how to check th e sending result when this function is us ed. Preparation for Sending by E-mail To send b[...]

  • Seite 322

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 32 4 E-ma il Sc reen These screen s are shown when u sing the machine f or e-mail . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Main disp lay ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When a d estinat ion is s elected 1. E-mail icon ( ) Indicates tha t the E-mail scree n is dis- played. 2. Destination field Displays the selected dest ination. If multiple d estinat ions are[...]

  • Seite 323

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 33 4 Sending Scan Files by E-mail Procedu re for Sending by E- mail Scan fil es are sent after specif ying scan settin gs and destinations. A A A A Press the { { { { Scanner } } } } key. B B B B If the user codes are set, enter a user code usin g the nu mber ke ys, and th en pres s the { { { { # } } } } key. The initial[...]

  • Seite 324

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 34 4 Using a Quick Dial key to select a destinat ion A Press the Quick Di al key in which the d estination is regis- tered. Reference For more information about how to register the destina- tion, see General Setti ngs Guide . B To select more destinations, re- peat step A A A A . Note ❒ To deselect a destination, pres[...]

  • Seite 325

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 35 4 D Select the destination u sing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. E To select more destinations, re- peat steps A A A A to D D D D . Note ❒ To deselect a destination, press { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } to display the destination in the [...]

  • Seite 326

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 36 4 C Enter a 3-digit registration number that has been as signed to a destination using the number keys, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. D Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E To select more destinations, re- peat steps A A A A to D D D D . Note ❒ To deselect a destination, press { { { {U U U U} } } } or {[...]

  • Seite 327

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 37 4 Manual entry o f an e-mai l address A Press [ Manual ] . B Enter the e-mail address. Note ❒ It is possible to u se letters, numbers, and pe riods. The symbols ( ),;: ” cann ot be used. Reference For informat ion about how to enter characters, see Gen er- al Settings Guide . C Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. [...]

  • Seite 328

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 38 4 H H H H Specify the e-mail send er. To speci fy a se nder, you can select it using the Quick Dial key, search for an d selec t it fr om the Des tina - tion List, or select it by specifying a registration number. A Press [ Options ] . B Select [ Sender's Na me ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } [...]

  • Seite 329

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 39 4 C For receivin g a return rec eipt confirmation , select [ On ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” message ap - pears, and then the Send O p- tions screen returns . Note ❒ When [ On ] is sele cted, an e- mail notifying that th[...]

  • Seite 330

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 40 4 Note ❒ When a se nder's pass word is set, a screen f or entering the sender's password appear s. Enter the sender's password using the n umber ke ys, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } or { { { { # } } } } key. If the password en tered is correct, the sender name is displayed. E Press the { { { [...]

  • Seite 331

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 41 4 D Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” message ap - pears, and then th e Return Re- ceipt screen re turns. E For receivin g a return rec eipt confirmation , select [ On ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” me[...]

  • Seite 332

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 42 4 D Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” message ap - pears, and then th e Return Re- ceipt screen re turns. E For receivin g a return rec eipt confor mation, select [ On ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” me[...]

  • Seite 333

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 43 4 D Select the sender using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ When a se nder's pass word is set, a screen f or entering the sender's password appear s. Enter the sender's password using the n umber ke ys, and then press the { { { { OK [...]

  • Seite 334

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 44 4 Man ual ent ry of a subjec t A Select [ Manual Input ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter a subject, an d then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” message ap - pears, and then the Send O p- tions screen returns . Note ❒ W[...]

  • Seite 335

    Checking the Status of E-mail 45 4 Checking the S tatus of E-mail The status of the l ast 50 sendings can be checked. For every new sending record after 50, the oldest record is delete d. Important ❒ When the main power switch is turned off, all records are deleted. Note ❒ When [ Print&Del. Scanner Journal ] is set to [ On ] , the whole s c[...]

  • Seite 336

    Sending Scan Files by E-mail 46 4[...]

  • Seite 337

    47 5. Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function Scan files can be se nt to a specified destination using the network delivery scan- ner function. Th is chapter explains the p reparation sequence, v arious display scre ens, deli very proc edures, and how to check t he deliver y result wh en this function is u sed. Important ❒ A delivery server i[...]

  • Seite 338

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 48 5 Network Deli very Scanner Scr een These scre ens are shown when using the mach ine as a network d elivery scanner. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Main disp lay ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When a d estinat ion is s elected 1. Network Deliv ery Scanner icon () Indicates that the Network Delivery Scann er screen i s displayed. 2.[...]

  • Seite 339

    Preparation for Delivering 49 5 Note ❒ Press the { { { { Check Dest ination } } } } key t o check the select ed destinatio n. ❒ Gro up de stinat ions are d eno ted by this symbol ( ). 3. [] E-ma il/Network Delivery Scanne r Press to switch betw een the n etwork delivery scanner function and the e- mai l f unct ion. 4. [ Manual ] When specifying[...]

  • Seite 340

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 50 5 Delivering Scan Files Delivery Procedure Scan files are delivered after sc an set- tings and destinations are s pecified. If necessary , you c an sele ct a se nder an d a subject. A A A A Press the { { { { Scanner } } } } key. B B B B If the user codes are set, enter a user code usin g the nu mber ke[...]

  • Seite 341

    Delivering Scan Files 51 5 Note ❒ When using Sc anRouter V2 Lite/Professional, the Destina- tion List is updated automati- cally. Using a Quick Dial key to select a destinat ion A Press the Quick Di al key in which the d estination is regis- tered. Reference For more information about how to register the destina- tion, see General Setti ngs Guide[...]

  • Seite 342

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 52 5 Reference For informat ion about how to enter characters, see Gen er- al Settings Guide . D Select the destination u sing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. E To select more destinations, re- peat steps A A A A to D D D D . Note ❒ To desele[...]

  • Seite 343

    Delivering Scan Files 53 5 B Select [ Search by Registr ation No. ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. C Enter a 3-digit registration number that has been as signed to a destination using the number keys, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. D Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E T[...]

  • Seite 344

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 54 5 D Select the destination u sing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. E To select more destinations, re- peat steps A A A A to D D D D . Note ❒ To deselect a destination, press { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } to display the dest[...]

  • Seite 345

    Delivering Scan Files 55 5 G G G G Specify the sender (scan file de- liver source) if necessary. To speci fy a s ender, you c an search for an d selec t it fr om the Des tina - tion List, or select it by specifying a registration number. A Press [ Options ] . B Select [ Sender's Na me ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , an[...]

  • Seite 346

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 56 5 Searching to select a sender by name A Press t he { { { { Sea rch D est ina tion } } } } key. B Select [ Search by Name ] usi ng { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and t hen press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. C Enter the b eginning of the sender name, and then p ress the { { { { OK } } [...]

  • Seite 347

    Delivering Scan Files 57 5 When sel ecting a sender fr om Destination L ist A Press t he { { { { Sea rch D est ina tion } } } } key. B Select [ Display D estin atio n List ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. C Select the sender using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and[...]

  • Seite 348

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 58 5 B Select [ Search by Registr ation No. ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. C Enter a 3-digit registration number that has been as signed to a sender using the number keys , and the n press the { { { { OK } } } } key twice. D Press the { [...]

  • Seite 349

    Delivering Scan Files 59 5 Man ual ent ry of a subjec t A Select [ Manual Input ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter a subject, an d then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. The “ A ccept ed ” message ap - pears, and then the Send O p- tions screen returns . Note ❒ When the[...]

  • Seite 350

    Using the Network Delivery Scanner Function 60 5 Checking the S tatus of Deliver y The status of the last 50 deliveries can be ch ecked. For ev ery ne w deli very record after 50, the oldest record is delete d. Important ❒ When the main power switch is turned off, all records are deleted. Note ❒ When [ Print&Del. Scanner Journal ] is set to[...]

  • Seite 351

    61 6. Using the Network TWAIN Scanner Function This chapter describes the operations for scanning originals with the network TWAIN scanner using DeskTopBinder V2 Lite. In addition, the preparation for using the network TWAIN sc anner and s ome functi ons of the TWAIN d river are introduced. Preparation for Using the Network TWAIN Scanner To use the[...]

  • Seite 352

    Using the Network TWAIN Scanner Function 62 6 Scanning Originals This section explains how t o scan originals usi ng the network TWAIN scanner function . A A A A Start DeskTopBinder V2 Lite, and then select t he scanner driver. A On the [ Start ] menu, point to [ Program ] , poi nt to [ Desk Top- Binder V2 ] , and th en click [ Desk- TopBinder V2 ][...]

  • Seite 353

    Scanning Originals 63 6 Note ❒ For advanced set tings, click [ Detail ] to display the Detail window. F or inform ation about the Detail window, see TWAIN drive r Help. C According to the settings of [ Document ] and [ Orientation: ] , change the other setting of the [ Document ] group. Reference p.29 “ For a Network TW AIN Scanner ” For info[...]

  • Seite 354

    Using the Network TWAIN Scanner Function 64 6 Functions of the TWAI N Driver The following is an introduction to the various functions of the TWAIN dri ver: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Automatic Tilt Correction This function automatically cor- rects charac ter strings that were scanned sla nted. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printing to the Image This function allows y ou t[...]

  • Seite 355

    65 7. Appendix Relationship between Resolution and File Size Resolution and sca n area are inversely re lated. The higher the r esolution is set, the smaller the area that can be scanned. Converse ly, the larger the scan area, the lower the resolution that can be set. The relationship between th e scanning resolution and the file s ize is shown be-[...]

  • Seite 356

    Appendix 66 7 Max. Number of Addres ses Which Can Be Specified *1 Up to 50 addresses can be entered directly . All remaining addresses have to be spec- ified using the registered ones. *2 The maximum number of addresses which c an be specified va ries depending on the software you use, ScanRou ter V2 Lite or ScanRouter V2 Prof essional. For more in[...]

  • Seite 357

    Troubleshooting 67 7 Troubleshooting This section contains advice on wha t to do if you have problems scann ing an origina l, or if the network deliver y scanner or e- mail functio n does not wo rk. Various messages that may appear on the control panel or cli ent computer are listed, along with causes and solutio ns. When Scanning Is Not Performed [...]

  • Seite 358

    Appendix 68 7 When an Error Messag e Appears on the Cont rol Panel Note ❒ If an error message that is not included in this section appears, turn off the main power switch of the machine, and then turn it on again. If the message still appears, note the conten t of the message and the error number (if li sted in the table), and contact your servic[...]

  • Seite 359

    Troubleshooting 69 7 Exceede d ma x.memo ry cap a. Sca nnin g will b e canc elled. Scan ned data wi ll be clea red. Because of insufficient memory space, the f irst page could not be scanned. Try one of the following measures: • Wait for a while, and then retry the scan opera tion. • Reduce the scan area or scanning resolution. Exceede d max . [...]

  • Seite 360

    Appendix 70 7 When an Error Messag e Appears on the Cli ent Computer This section describes the main possible c auses and actions for error messages displayed on the client c omputer when the TWAIN driver is used. Note ❒ If an error message that is not contained in this section app ears, turn off the main power switch of the machine, and then tur[...]

  • Seite 361

    Troubleshooting 71 7 [ Error has occurred in the scanner driver. ] • Che ck wh ether th e netw ork cab le is con- necte d corre ctly to t he clien t comp uter. • Check whether the Ethernet board of the client computer is recognized cor- rectly by Windows . • Check whether the client computer can use the TCP/IP protocol. [ Fatal error has occu[...]

  • Seite 362

    Appendix 72 7 Specifications *1 Scanning speed s vary acco rding to machine operat ing conditi ons, computer (sp eci- fication, netwo rk traffic, and soft ware, etc.), and original types. Scan method Flatbed scanning Scan sp eed *1 • E-mail/Network Delivery Scanner Appro x. 22 pa ges/m inut e [Scan size: A 4 S , Original type: Text(Print), Re sol[...]

  • Seite 363

    73 INDEX A Auto Document Link , 22 Automatic T ilt Correction , 64 Auto Run prog ram , 16 C Checking th e status of delivery , 60 Checking th e status of e-mail , 45 Comp re ssi on , 14 Cont rol panel , 6 Cus tom Si ze , 13 D Default Scan Settings , 12 Delivering sca n files , 50 Delivery procedure , 50 Check ing select ed dest inations , 54 Manual[...]

  • Seite 364

    74 GB GB B683-8710 P Plac ing origi nals , 25 Auto Document Feed er (ADF) , 27 exposu re glass , 26 Preparatio n for delivering , 47 Prepa rati on fo r se ndin g by e -mail , 31 Previ ew , 63 Print&D el. Scanner Journal , 14 Prin tin g to th e imag e , 64 Procedure for sending by e-mail , 33 Check ing select ed dest inations , 37 Manual entry o[...]

  • Seite 365

    In accord ance wi th IEC 60 417, this machine uses the followi ng symb ols for the main po wer switc h: a a a a means POWE R ON. c c c c means STAND BY. Decl arati on of C onfor mity “The Produc t compli es with th e requirem ents of th e EMC Dire ctive 89 /336/EEC and its a mending di- rectives and the L ow Voltag e Direct ive 73/23 /EEC and its[...]

  • Seite 366

    Operating Instructions Scanner Reference GB GB B683-8710[...]

  • Seite 367

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=76 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.800000 mm Operating Instruct ions Facsimile Reference <Basic Features> Operating Inst ructions Fa csimile Reference <Basic Features> Operat ing Instruc tions Fac[...]

  • Seite 368

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=76 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.800000 mm Declar ation of Conformi ty Notice t o Users in EEA Countr ies This pro duct compli es with th e essenti al requir ements and provisio ns of Direc tive 1999/ 5/EC [...]

  • Seite 369

    i Manuals f or This M achine The following manuals describe the oper ational procedures of this ma chine. For particular functions, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine ty pe. ❒ Adobe Acr obat Reader is nec essary to view t he manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are provided: • CD-ROM 1“[...]

  • Seite 370

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBind er V2 Lite Desk Top Binde r V2 L ite is a ut ilit y incl uded on th e CD- ROM l abe led “ Scanner Driv er & Docu men t Mana geme nt Ut ilit ies ” . • DeskTopBin der V2 Lite Setup Guide ( PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes installation of, and the operating environment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in de[...]

  • Seite 371

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machin e ...... ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . i How to Read Thi s Manual . ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ... 1 Symbols ....... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... ....... ..[...]

  • Seite 372

    iv Searchi ng for a Desti nation ........... ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ........ ... 32 Search by Destinati on Name .. ...... .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... .......... ....... .......... .... 32 Selecting fr om Destination List.......... ...... ........... ...... .......... .......... ......[...]

  • Seite 373

    1 How to Read This Manual Sym bol s In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- structi ons under t his symbo l. Be sure to read t he instruc tions, a ll of w hich are in - [...]

  • Seite 374

    2 Stell aC2-GBc ombi ne-F_FM_ ZF.book Page 2 Wedn esday, November 26, 20 03 5:0 4 PM[...]

  • Seite 375

    3 1. Getting Started Control Panel The illustrati on shows the control panel when options are installed. 1. Communicating indicator Lights during tran smission or reception. 2. Receive File indicator Lights to t ell you a message h as been re- ce ived in to me mor y. Bli nks w hen a Memory Lock file has been received. See p.75 “ Memory Lock ” ,[...]

  • Seite 376

    Getting Sta rted 4 1 12. { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key Use to chang e default or ope ration pa- rameters accord ing to the operating con- dit ion s. 13. { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key Press to clear the current setti ng. 14. { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key Clear: Clears an entered numeric value. Stop: Stops scan ning or other operat ions.[...]

  • Seite 377

    Control Panel 5 1 Reading t he Display The display shows you th e machine status, messages, and guides you thr ough oper atio ns. Note ❒ This machine automat ically retu rns to s tandby m ode if you do not use th e machine for a certai n period of time. You can sel ect the period using "Facsim- ile Auto Res et Timer". See “ Timer Sett[...]

  • Seite 378

    Getting Sta rted 6 1 1. Machine stat us or currently se- lected function 2. Message 3. Destinati on entry 4. Selection keys 5. Selectable items ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When Internet Fax Settings is ON 1. Switches the destination be- tween fax number and e-mai l ad- dres s. Note ❒ To us e the Internet F ax functions, the optional pr inter/s canner unit is[...]

  • Seite 379

    Control Panel 7 1 Com munic atio n displ ay While co mmunicating, the machine st atus is displ ayed. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Memory Transmission (fax transmission) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Reception ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Immediate Transmission ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ TX Mode When a funct ion is set to on, a “ clip ” mark is atta ched to th at functi on name . Note ❒ To set[...]

  • Seite 380

    Getting Sta rted 8 1 User code entry display When the following message a ppears on the disp lay, User Code Management is active . Enter a user cod e to de activate Use r Code Management. The mach ine can be set up so that no one can use it without e ntering a user code. This preve nts unauthoriz ed people from sending fax messa ges and helps tr ac[...]

  • Seite 381

    9 2. Faxing Transmiss ion Modes There are two types of transmission: • Memory Transmission • Immediate Transmission Note ❒ You can use Parallel M emory T ra n s- mission that dials while the origi- nal is being sc anned. See p.28 “ Parall el Mem ory Tran smissi on ” , Facsimile Reference <Advanced Fea- tures> . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Memor[...]

  • Seite 382

    Faxing 10 2 Importa nt ❒ If power outage lasts about an hour, or t he machine is discon- nected from the power outlet for abou t an hour, docu ments stored in t he fax machine's memory ar e deleted. If any doc - ument is d eleted, the Power Failure Rep ort is automatically printed out when the main powe r swit ch is t urned on. Use this repo[...]

  • Seite 383

    Placin g Originals 11 2 Placing Or iginals You can set your orig inals either in the Docu ment Feeder o r on the expo- sure glass. Some types of original s are unsuitable for the Document Feeder so they must be set on the exposure glass. Which way you place your original depends on its size and whether you are using t he Document Feeder or the expo[...]

  • Seite 384

    Faxing 12 2 ❒ Make sure that all ink, correcting fluid etc ., has compl etely dri ed be- fore placing your ori ginal. If it is still we t, the ex posure glass will be marked and tho se marks will ap- pear o n the r eceiv ed imag e. ❒ You can send the first pages from the exposure gl ass then the re- mainin g page s from t he ADF. Af- ter you ha[...]

  • Seite 385

    Placin g Originals 13 2 ❒ You c an ch ec k in form ati on a bout the sizes and number of originals t ha t c an be pl ac e d i n t h e A D F . S e e p.102 “ Acceptable Types of Origi- nals ” , F acsimile Reference <Ad- vanced F eatures> . A A A A Adjust the d ocument guide to match the size of the or iginals. B B B B Align the edges of t[...]

  • Seite 386

    Faxing 14 2 Memory Tr ansmission In Memory Transmission mode, af ter you press the { { { { Start } } } } key, the machine does not dial t he d estin atio n unti l all pages of your fax message have been scanned into memory (in contrast to Immed iat e Tra nsmi ssio n, wh ere t he num ber is dialed first and p ages are scanned and sent one by one). M[...]

  • Seite 387

    Memory Trans mission 15 2 B B B B Place the original in the ADF, or on the exposure glass. Note ❒ You can send the first few pages from the exposure glass then the remaining pages from the ADF. After you remo ve the last page from the exposure glass , you have 60 seconds to insert the remaining pa ges in the ADF. ❒ Note that y ou cannot pl ace [...]

  • Seite 388

    Faxing 16 2 ❒ Entered destinations can be checke d using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } . ❒ To delete a n entered des tina- tion, find it using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , press the { { { { Clear/Sto p } } } } key, and then press [ Delete ] . G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒ Do not lif[...]

  • Seite 389

    Cancelin g a Memory Transmis sion 17 2 Canceling a Me mory Transmissi on Even when fa x numb er and e -mail address are simultaneously speci fied, or on ly e-m ail addre ss is s pec ified, you can cancel the mode us ing th e s a m e p r o c e d u r e . H o w e v e r , y o u c a n - not cancel the transmission of a sent Internet Fax document. Befor [...]

  • Seite 390

    Faxing 18 2 A A A A Make sure that the standby dis- play appear s. Note ❒ If you press the { { { { Clear/S top } } } } key while the original is bei ng scanned , scanning stops. B B B B Pre ss th e { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key. C C C C Pre ss [ St op TX ] . D D D D Pre ss [ Dele te ] . The standby display appears. Note ❒ If you want to cancel[...]

  • Seite 391

    Immediate Tr ansmission 19 2 Immediate Trans mission With Imme diate Transmission, when you pres s the { { { { Start } } } } key, th e fax number is dialed immediately. The message is scanned and transmitted page by page without bein g stored in memor y. Th is co ntr asts wit h Mem ory Transmissio n which scans all pages into memory before dial ing[...]

  • Seite 392

    Faxing 20 2 Referen ce p.11 “ Placing Origi nals ” . C C C C Select t he scan se ttings yo u re- quir e. Referen ce p.23 “ Scan S ettings ” p.24 “ Origina l Type ” p.25 “ Ima ge Densi ty (Con- trast) ” D D D D Specify a destination . Note ❒ If you make a m istake, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key, and then enter the correc[...]

  • Seite 393

    Immediate Tr ansmission 21 2 - - - - Sendi ng orig inals using t he exposure gla ss A Mak e sur e the Memor y Tra ns. in- dicator is off. I f it is n ot, press t he { { { { Memory Trans. } } } } key. B Place the first page face dow n on the exposure gl ass. C Spe cify a d estin atio n. D Make the scan set tings you require. E Press the { { { { Star[...]

  • Seite 394

    Faxing 22 2 Canceling an Imme diate Transmis sion Before Yo u Have Press ed { { { { Start } } } } Key A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key. Note ❒ When the or iginal is placed in the ADF, you can also cancel an Immediate Tr ansmission by re- moving the original. After You Have Pres sed { { { { Start } } } } Key A A A A Pre ss th e [...]

  • Seite 395

    Scan Sett ings 23 2 Scan Settings You may wa nt to send many different types of fax messages. Som e of these may be difficu lt to repr oduce at the receiver's end. However, your ma- chine has three settin gs that you can adjust to help you tran smit your doc- ument with the best po ssible image quality . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Resolution: Standard , [...]

  • Seite 396

    Faxing 24 2 A A A A Press the { { { { Res olutio n } } } } key to switch between resolutions. The indica- tors above the key shows the cur- rent sele ction. Note ❒ The indicator s are off when the reso lution is set to Stand ard. Original Type If your origi nal contains phot o- graphs, illustrations, or diagrams with complex shading patterns or g[...]

  • Seite 397

    Scan Sett ings 25 2 Image Density (Contrast) The t ext an d dia gram s in your o rigi - nal sh ould stan d out clearly fro m the paper they are written on. I f your original has a darker background than normal (for example, a news pa- per cli pping), or i f the wr iting is faint , adjust the image density. Use the { { { { Image Densi ty } } } } key[...]

  • Seite 398

    Faxing 26 2 When placing originals i n the ADF Note ❒ Depending on what time the scan settings are adjust ed, the settings may no t be ref lected i n the r esult- ing operation. A A A A Check w hich pag es you wan t to scan with d ifferent settings. B B B B Select the image den sity, resolu- tion, and original type before the next page is sc anne[...]

  • Seite 399

    Specifying a Des tination 27 2 Specifying a De stination Yo u can spec ify th e dest inati on usin g one of three method s. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax number p.27 “ Entering a Fax Number ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ E-mail address p.29 “ E ntering an E-mail Ad dress ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Destination list p.29 “ Using the Destination List ” Th is se ctio n co[...]

  • Seite 400

    Faxing 28 2 Paus e Press the { { { { Pause/Redia l } } } } key when di- aling or storing a number to insert a paus e of about two seco nds. Note ❒ You cannot i nsert a p ause befor e the first digit of a fax number. If you pres s the { { { { Pause/ Redial } } } } key at the first digit, a redial occurs. See p.2 4 “ Redial ” , Facsimile Refere[...]

  • Seite 401

    Specifying a Des tination 29 2 Entering an E-mail Address When using In ternet Fax transmis- sion, specify the e-mail address in place of the fax number. Note ❒ You can enter up to 128 cha racters. A A A A Make sure that is displayed in the destination d isplay column. Note ❒ If it is not displa yed, press [] . B B B B Pre ss [ Manua l ] . C C [...]

  • Seite 402

    Faxing 30 2 Limitatio n ❒ Group Dial can be used for Memory Transmis sion only; not Immed iate Transmissio n. If you sp ecify Imme- diate Transmission in Group Dial, the " Try again after switching to memo ry tr ansmiss ion. " mes- sage appears. When this happe ns, press [ Exit ] , a n d t h e n s w i t c h t o M e m - ory Transmission.[...]

  • Seite 403

    Specifying a Des tination 31 2 Note ❒ If you make a m istake, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key and tr y again. ❒ If you wan t to specify other des- tinations, press [ Add Dest ] . C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒ If you press an incorrect Quick Dial key , press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key, and th en press t[...]

  • Seite 404

    Faxing 32 2 Searching for a De stination Use t his procedu re to search th rough the destinat ion lists for a particular destinat ion. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Search by Destination Name p.32 “ Search by Destin ation Name ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Select by Display Destination List p.33 “ Selectin g from De stination List ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Specifying a Reg [...]

  • Seite 405

    Searching f or a Destination 33 2 F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. A search progres s starts, then search re sult appe ars. Note ❒ If no destination is matched for specified text, " Specified des- tination is no t programmed. " is dis played . Press [ Exit ] to re- turn to the display of B . G G G G Select the desti nation na[...]

  • Seite 406

    Faxing 34 2 F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The speci fied de stinatio n is sele ct- ed. Note ❒ Press [ Add Dest ] to specify other destinations . ❒ You ca nnot sp ecif y des ti nati ons twice. If you t ry to, th e “ This destinat ion has already be en programm ed. ” messa ge appears. Press [ Exit ] t o return to the standby dis[...]

  • Seite 407

    Searching f or a Destination 35 2 Searc h by Fax Number Note ❒ The search returns only destina- tions whos e beginnings match the entered fax num ber. A A A A Pre ss [] to display . B B B B Pre ss th e { { { { Search D estination } } } } key. C C C C Sele ct [ Sea rch by Fax No. ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } . Note ❒ If[...]

  • Seite 408

    Faxing 36 2 H H H H Select the number to specify us- ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } . I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The destination which you searched is specified. Note ❒ Press [ Add Dest ] to specify other destinations . Searc h by E-ma il Ad dress Note ❒ The search returns only destina- tions whos e beginnin[...]

  • Seite 409

    Searching f or a Destination 37 2 G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Search result appe ars. Note ❒ If no dest ination is m atched for speci fied e-mail addr ess, " Spec- ified dest ination is not p ro- gramme d. " is disp layed. Press [ Exit ] to retur n to the display of C . H H H H Select t he e-mail addr ess to speci- fy us[...]

  • Seite 410

    Faxing 38 2 Recepti on There are two ways you can set up your mach ine to ha ndle in coming calls: • Manual Reception (external tele- phone req uired) • Auto R ecept ion ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Auto Switch In this mod e, the machine ri ngs a number of times. You can answ er the call while the m achine is r ing- ing. If yo u do not answ er th e call, th[...]

  • Seite 411

    Recepti on 39 2 B B B B Select the recep tion mode using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , an d then press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The standby display appears. Note ❒ To cancel the select ion, press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key. Receiving a Fax in Manual Reception Mode A A A A When the machine r ings, pick up the ha ndset of[...]

  • Seite 412

    Faxing 40 2 Stel laC2-GBc ombi ne-F_FM_ ZF.book Page 4 0 Wed nesday , Novembe r 26, 2 003 5 :04 PM[...]

  • Seite 413

    41 3. Using Internet Fax Functions Internet Fax Functions The optional printer/sca nner unit is required. This machine co nverts sca nned do cument im ages t o e-mail for mat and tr ansmi ts the da ta over the Inter net. The e-mail se nt by this machine can be recei ved by another Internet Fax ma- chine. I nstead of di aling the t elephone n umber [...]

  • Seite 414

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 42 3 Interne t Fax Precautions • Internet F ax communic ates with a server over a LAN. I t cannot co mmunicate direc tly wit h other part ies. • If a transmission is not successfu l, this machine usually receives a n e-mail er- ror noti fication . See p.97 “ Server-Generated Error E-ma il ” , Facs imile Ref er[...]

  • Seite 415

    Internet Fax Functio ns 43 3 T.37 Full Mode This machine is T.37 full mode compatib le. T.37 full mode is an international standard for Internet Fax transmission. (ITU-T announcement, RFC2532) When an I ntern et Fax c ommunica t io n is made betwee n T.37 full mo de compat - ible mach ines, t he recei ver sid e sends the retur n rece ipt (di spatch[...]

  • Seite 416

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 44 3 Note ❒ If the receiver is progr ammed as the simple mode mac hine or not pro- grammed in the Add ress Book , the r eceive r's rece ption ca pabili ty cannot be registered. ❒ If you know the receiver's reception capability, you can set it manually. How- ever, this setting will be ove rwritten when th[...]

  • Seite 417

    Tran smitti ng Inte rnet Fa x 45 3 Transmitting Internet Fax Prep arat ion You need to make System Settings beforeha nd. See “ Setting Up the Machine on a Netw ork ” , Net wo rk Guide . This section de scribe s how to scan a docum ent into the memo ry and send it as e-mail. Specify the destination's e-mail address instead of fax number. Yo[...]

  • Seite 418

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 46 3 ❒ You can l imit the si ze of transm it- ted e-mail messages. See p.68 “ E- mail Setti ngs ” , Fac simile R eference <Advanced Feat ures> . ❒ See p.54 “ Received Im ages ” for how e -ma il is a ctua lly r eceiv ed by the com puter wh en it is sent with mail op tions se lected. ❒ When you trans[...]

  • Seite 419

    Tran smitti ng Inte rnet Fa x 47 3 D Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The di splay return s to th at of step A . Note ❒ If you press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key, entering a subject is c anceled. The disp lay returns to that of ste p A . To enter the programmed subject A Select [ A ttach S ubject ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T [...]

  • Seite 420

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 48 3 ❒ The ori ginal can be pl aced ei- ther in the A DF or on the expo - sure gla ss, unti l the { { { { Start } } } } key is pressed. Referen ce p.11 “ Placing Origi nals ” . F F F F Selec t the sc an se ttings y ou requ ire. Note ❒ In Internet Fax transmission, the origina l is scan ned usin g "De- tai[...]

  • Seite 421

    Tran smitti ng Inte rnet Fa x 49 3 J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. This machin e starts scanning the document i nto memory. T he e- mail send operatio n starts after the scanning operation is complete. When scanning is complete, the Communicating indicator lights and transmiss ion starts. Note ❒ With a large volume of document, it [...]

  • Seite 422

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 50 3 Confirming Rec eption When Return Rec eipt is set under “ E- mai l O pti ons ” , the receiver sends back a return recei pt mes sage . Once the return receipt message has been received, "OK" appears in the Result column of Jo urnal, allowin g the orig i- nator to verify that the transmission has been[...]

  • Seite 423

    Canceli ng Interne t Fax Transmissi on 51 3 Canceling Inte rnet Fax Transm ission When fax and Inte rnet Fax d estina - tions are specified s imultaneously, you can c ancel sending using the same me th od. Note ❒ You cannot cancel a transmission once scanni ng is compl ete. Befor e the Original Is Scanned Use this procedure to cancel a trans- mis[...]

  • Seite 424

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 52 3 Receiv ing Internet Fax You ca n receiv e e-mail docu ments by Inte rnet Fax . There are two meth ods of receiving e- mail: Au to E-mail Reception and Ma nual E-ma il Re cept ion. Limitatio n ❒ E-m ail wi th attac hmen ts othe r than TIFF-F format files cannot be re- ceived. Senders receive an Error Mail Notifi[...]

  • Seite 425

    Receivin g Inter net Fax 53 3 B B B B Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Accesses the server to chec k for e- mail. E-mail is in the server A Start printing and receiving in the memory. If the receiving is finished, the stand by display appears. E-mail is not in the server A Press [ Exit ] . The standby display appears. ABZ006S Stel laC2-GBc om[...]

  • Seite 426

    Using Inter net Fax Funct ions 54 3 Received Image s Here is an example of an Internet Fax m essage sent from this machine and re- ceived on a com puter using Outlook e-mail softw are. The re ceiv ed im age va rie s ac cordi ng to e-mai l sof twa re. 1. E-mail transmit ted without speci- fying a subject in “E-mai l Options”. 2. E-mail transmitt[...]

  • Seite 427

    55 4. Programming Initial Setti ngs and Adjustments You can send i nformation to the ot her party wh en tran smit ting or receivi ng a fax message . Thi s infor mation is show n on the disp lay of the other ma - chine and pri nted as a rep ort. The fol- lowing information can be sent. Important ❒ You can co nfirm p rogram med set- tings from the [...]

  • Seite 428

    Programming 56 4 Programming A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Fax Fe atures ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ If the Key Operator Code is p ro- grammed and turne d on, en ter the Key Operator Code (m axi- mum 8 di git) using num[...]

  • Seite 429

    Initia l Settin gs and Adjustm ents 57 4 Refe rence "Entering Text", General Set- tings Guide. Programming an Own F ax Number A Select [ Own Fax Numbe r ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter an Own Fax Nu mber us- ing number keys, and then press th e { { { { OK } } } }[...]

  • Seite 430

    Programming 58 4 E E E E Sele ct [ Fax Head er ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key. All c haracte rs a re dele ted. G G G G Enter the char acters you want to program, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key . The information for edi[...]

  • Seite 431

    Initia l Settin gs and Adjustm ents 59 4 E E E E Sele ct [ Fax Head er ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key. All registered ch aracters are delet- ed. Note ❒ Press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key to canc el deleting. The displa y retu[...]

  • Seite 432

    Programming 60 4 Programming Fax Numbers and E-mail addres ses You can program fax destinations using Address Boo k Management in the Key Operator Too ls menu under System Settings. You can also register the programmed fax nu mbers and e-mail addresses in a Grou p. Note ❒ When you try to return to the standb y display after changing the contents [...]

  • Seite 433

    61 5. Troubleshooting Adjusting the Volume You ca n chan ge t he vol ume of the fol- lowing sounds that the machine make s. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ On Hook Mode Heard when the { { { { On Hook Dial } } } } key is pressed. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ At Transmissi on Heard when the machi ne sends a message. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ At Reception Heard wh en the machine rece ives [...]

  • Seite 434

    Troublesh ooting 62 5 G G G G You can adj ust the volume using { { { {W W W W} } } } or { { { {V V V V} } } } . Note ❒ You ca n adjust the vo lume b y seven levels. H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ Press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key to canc el setting and the display returns to that of step E . I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { Us[...]

  • Seite 435

    When { Facsim ile } Key Is Lit in Red 63 5 When { { { { Facsimile } } } } Key Is Lit in Red If thi s key is lit, press the key to enter t he facsimi le mode. Then, re fer to th e table below and take the appropr iate action. Problem S olutions A facsimile error has occurred. The facsimile has a p roblem. Contact your service representative. See p.6[...]

  • Seite 436

    Troublesh ooting 64 5 When Toner Runs Out When the machi ne has run out of ton- er, t he sy mbol app ears on t he di spl ay. Note that even if there is no toner left, you can still send fax messages. Important ❒ The number of communi cations, that have been exec uted after the toner h as run out an d that auto- matically-output Journal has not li[...]

  • Seite 437

    Error Mess ages and Their Mean ings 65 5 Error Mes sages and Thei r Meanings If there is an error, one of the following me ssages may appear on the display. If other message appears, follow the message. Messa ge Causes a nd solutio ns Put orig inal back, ch eck it and pres s Star t key. Original jamme d during Memory Transmis - sion. Place original[...]

  • Seite 438

    Troublesh ooting 66 5 Chec k whet her ther e are any netw ork pr oblems . [14-09] E-mail transmission wa s refused by SMTP au- thentication or POP before SMTP aut hentica- tion. • Check the user na me and pass word for SMTP or POP b efore SMTP authentication are co rrectly pr ogrammed in Fax Ma il Re- ceptio n Accou nt und er File Transfer in Sys[...]

  • Seite 439

    Error Mess ages and Their Mean ings 67 5 - - - - Out of pa per display message If the paper tray runs out of paper, “ Out of paper. Load it, then press [Ex- it]. ” appears on the display, as king you to add mo re paper. Note ❒ If there is paper left in t he other paper trays, you can receive messages as usu- al, even if the message appears on[...]

  • Seite 440

    Troublesh ooting 68 5 Solving P roblems This table lists some common problems and their solutions. Problem Causes and so lutions Reference Image background appears dirty when recei ved at the oth er en d. Im ages from the back page appear. Adjust scan densit y. p.25 “ Image Density (Con- trast) ” Printed or sent image contains spo ts. The ADF o[...]

  • Seite 441

    Solving Probl ems 69 5 When using On Hook Dial or Manual Dial, " Receiving " appears and tran smission is not al lowed. If the mac hine fails to detect the size of the original when the { { { { Start } } } } key is pressed, it performs a receivi ng opera- tion. All fax me ssages store d in m e m o r y h a v e b e e n l o s t . T h o s e m[...]

  • Seite 442

    Troublesh ooting 70 5 When Things D on't Go as Expect ed I Want... Operation Reference to cancel a Mem ory Transmis- sio n. If the origi nal is be ing scanned, pr ess the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key. p.17 “ Canceling a Mem ory Transmission ” If the original is b eing sent or if it is in standb y, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key[...]

  • Seite 443

    71 INDEX A Adju stin g the Volu me , 61 At Dialing , 61 At Pr inting , 61 At Recept ion , 61 At Transmission , 61 On Hook Mode , 61 Attach Subject , 45 Aut hor ized Rec ept ion , 42 Auto E-ma il Reception , 52 B Batch T ransmissi on , 42 Broadcasting , 14 Broadcasting Seq uence , 16 C Chain Di al , 42 Control P anel , 3 CSI->Own Fax Number , 55 [...]

  • Seite 444

    72 GB GB B168-86 00 Q Quick Dial Specifying a d estination , 30 Specifying a group of destinations , 30 R Received Image s , 54 Reception , 38 Auto Recepti on , 38 Manua l Rece ption , 38 Registration Number , 34 Resolution , 23 Return Receipt , 45 RTI->Own Name , 55 S Scan Se ttings , 23 Standard , 23 Switchin g the Reception Mode , 38 T T.37 F[...]

  • Seite 445

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=76 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.800000 mm Declar ation of Conformi ty Notice t o Users in EEA Countr ies This pro duct compli es with th e essenti al requir ements and provisio ns of Direc tive 1999/ 5/EC [...]

  • Seite 446

    Paper t ype: Wood Fre e 80g/m2, P aper Thickn ess=100 µ m // Pages in book=76 // Print scale=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 3.800000 mm Operating Instruct ions Facsimile Reference <Basic Features> Operating Inst ructions Fa csimile Reference <Basic Features> Operat ing Instruc tions Fac[...]

  • Seite 447

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 112 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.480000 mm Operatin g Instruction s Facsimile Refe rence <Advan ced Features> Operating Instructions Facsimile Reference <A dvanced Features > Operat i[...]

  • Seite 448

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 112 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.480000 mm Intr oduc tio n This man ual des cribes d etaile d instr uctions on the operat ion and notes about t he use of th is machi ne. To get maxi mum versat il[...]

  • Seite 449

    i Manuals f or This M achine The following manuals describe the oper ational procedures of this ma chine. For particular functions, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine ty pe. ❒ Adobe Acr obat Reader is nec essary to view t he manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are provided: • CD-ROM 1“[...]

  • Seite 450

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBind er V2 Lite Desk Top Binde r V2 L ite is a ut ilit y incl uded on th e CD- ROM l abe led “ Scanner Driv er & Docu men t Mana geme nt Ut ilit ies ” . • DeskTopBin der V2 Lite Setup Guide ( PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes installation of, and the operating environment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in de[...]

  • Seite 451

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machin e ...... ..... ........ ...... ....... ...... ....... ...... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . i How to Read Thi s Manual . ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ... 1 Symbols ....... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... ....... ..[...]

  • Seite 452

    iv Printed R eport ....... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ ..... ........ . 31 Memory Storage Repor t ...... .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... ....... . 31 Transmission Result Re port (Memory Transmission) ........ ....... .......... ...[...]

  • Seite 453

    v LAN-Fax Operation Messages ... .......... ....... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... .......... ....... . 57 LAN-Fax Error Report ...... .......... ....... .......... .......... ....... .......... ...... .......... ....... .......... . 57 LAN-Fax Result by E-mail .... .......... ...... ........... ...... .......... .......... .......[...]

  • Seite 454

    vi 9. Appendix Connect ing the Machine to a Telephone Line and Telep hone ... ......... ............ 99 Connecting the Telephone Line ........ ...... ........... ...... .......... .......... ....... .......... ....... .... 99 Selecting the Line Type........... .......... ...... ........... ...... .......... .......... ....... .......... ....... ...[...]

  • Seite 455

    1 How to Read This Manual Sym bol s In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- structi ons under t his symbo l. Be sure to read t he instruc tions, a ll of w hich are in - [...]

  • Seite 456

    2 Names of Major Options The followi ng software products are r eferred to using a general name : • DeskTopBinder V2 Lite and DeskTop Binder V2 Professional → DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite /Professional Stell aC2-AEc ombine -F_FM.b ook Page 2 Tues day, J anuary 13, 20 04 1:2 2 PM[...]

  • Seite 457

    3 1. Transmission Mode Sending at a Speci fic Time (Send Later) Usin g this funct ion, yo u can ins truct the m achin e to dela y tran smiss ion of your fax message until a spec ified la t- er time. This allows you to take ad- va ntage of off -peak t elep hone charges without having to be by th e machi ne at the time. If you have a non-u rgent fax,[...]

  • Seite 458

    Transmissi on Mode 4 1 Note ❒ To can cel the setting, select [ Off ] , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. The display re turns to that of step C . E E E E Enter the time using the number keys, and then press (24 hr for- mat). Note ❒ If you enter a wrong numbe r, press the { { { { Clear/Sto p } } } } key, and then reenter . ❒ To cance[...]

  • Seite 459

    User Tr ansmission 5 1 User T ransmi ssion This functio n allow s you to check each us er o r de part ment 's tra nsmis - sion history. To use the function, you need to program a user code (eight digits max.) for ea ch user or depart- m ent, to b e en tere d be for e tr ans mis - sion. See General Settings Guide . I f a u s e r c o d e s e t w[...]

  • Seite 460

    Transmissi on Mode 6 1 ❒ When canceling transmission by use r code, to de lete the pro- grammed user code, press the { { { { Clear/S top } } } } key, and then the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The dis play ret urns to that of step C . When your e-mail addres s is programmed with the us er code If your e-mail [...]

  • Seite 461

    E-mail Opti ons 7 1 E-mail Options When using the Internet Fax function, you can make the following settings: • Attach Subje ct You can enter a subjec t for the e- mail you want to send. Note ❒ For convenience, program fre- quen tly used subjec ts. [ Urgent ] and [ High ] ar e prog ramm ed by default. See "File Transfer", Net- work Gu[...]

  • Seite 462

    Transmissi on Mode 8 1 Fax Header Print In some cases, you may want the oth- er party to rec eive an unmarked copy of your origi nal. To do this, switch Fax Header off. When the Fax Header is set t o “ On ” , the stor ed name is printed o n the re- ceiver 's p aper . Note ❒ You can program a fax header name using the Program Fax Infor- m[...]

  • Seite 463

    Label I nsert ion 9 1 Label Inse rtio n With this function you can have the receiver name printed on the m essage when it is received at the other end. The name wi ll be print ed at the to p of the page and will be preceded by “ To: ” . Note ❒ When ther e is an image around the area where the Label is t o be print- ed, that image is deleted. [...]

  • Seite 464

    Transmissi on Mode 10 1 Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_FM.b ook Page 10 Tu esday, Ja nuary 13, 2004 1:22 PM[...]

  • Seite 465

    11 2. Communication Information After you have pressed the { { { { Start } } } } key (after scanning originals), you can chec k and edit the dest ination or setti ngs of Memory Transmiss ion. You c an also c an- cel a transmission, print a stored file and print a list of stored files. • Memory Transmission p.14 “ Memory Transmissio n ” , Facs[...]

  • Seite 466

    Communicati on Informat ion 12 2 D D D D Pre ss [ Dele te ] . The selected file is deleted. The displ ay re turns to that of ste p B . Note ❒ To quit transmission cancel, press [ No ] . ❒ To cancel another transmission, repe at fro m ste p B . E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { Cancel } } } } key. The standby display appears. Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_F[...]

  • Seite 467

    Printi ng a List of Fil es in Memory (Pr int TX Standby File List) 13 2 Printing a Li st of Files in Memo ry (Print TX Standby File List) Print this list if you want to fi nd out which fi les are st ored in memory and what their file numb ers are. Knowing the file num ber can be useful (for ex- ample when er asing files). Note ❒ The conten ts of [...]

  • Seite 468

    Communicati on Informat ion 14 2 Checking the Transmission Re sult (TX File Status) You can browse a par t of the Trans- mission Result Repo rt on the di splay. Note ❒ Only the transmission result of the last 100 commun ications (recep- tions & transmissio ns) are shown. ❒ You can also chec k the transmis- sion re sult using We b browser. F[...]

  • Seite 469

    Checking th e Reception Res ult (RX File Stat us) 15 2 Check ing the Recepti on Result (RX Fi le Status) You can browse a part of the Recep- tion R esul t Report on the displ ay. Note ❒ Only the re ception result of th e last 100 communic ations (receptio ns & transmissions) are shown. ❒ You can also ch eck the rec eptio n result using Web [...]

  • Seite 470

    Communicati on Informat ion 16 2 Printing a File (Print TX Standby File) If you want to c heck the content s of a file that is s tored in memor y and not yet sen t, use thi s procedur e to print it out. Note ❒ You can also pr int files t hat have not been successfully transmitted. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Job Inform ation } } } } key. B B B B [...]

  • Seite 471

    Printing a F ile Received with Memory Lock (Pri nt Memory Lock File ) 17 2 Printing a Fil e Receive d with Memory Loc k (Print Memory L ock File) This i s a secu rity func tion designed to preve nt un aut hori zed us ers from reading your m essages. If Mem ory Lock is s witch ed on, all recei ved mes - sag es ar e sto red in mem ory and ar e not au[...]

  • Seite 472

    Communicati on Informat ion 18 2 D D D D Enter a 4-digit M emory Lock ID usin g the numb er key s, and the n pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. The dis play ret urns to that of step C . Note ❒ If the Me mory Lock ID does not match, the mes sage " Sp ecifi ed code does not match the progra mme d Memory Lock ID. " appear s, and then t[...]

  • Seite 473

    Printi ng the Journa l 19 2 Printing the Journal The Journal contains information about the last 50 communica tions (maximum) made by your machine. It is print ed auto matica lly after every 50 communicat ions (reception s & trans- miss ion s). You ca n also prin t a copy of th e Jour- nal at any time by follow ing the pro- cedure b elow. Impor[...]

  • Seite 474

    Communicati on Informat ion 20 2 Journal 1. Printing date Shows the d ate and time when the report is printed. 2. Programme d sender name Shows the sender name program med for printin g. 3. Date Shows the transmis sion or receptio n dat e. 4. Time Shows the tr ansmis sion or rece ptio n start time . 5. Other en d T o p r i or i t i z e a f a x n u [...]

  • Seite 475

    Printi ng the Journa l 21 2 6. Communication mode • For fax transmissions and receptions Aft er “ T ” for outgoing fax or “ R ” for ingoing fax, s hows a comm unication mode . • For Internet Fax transmissions and re- ception s After the e- mail symbol, and "T" fo r outgoing e-mail or "R" for ingoing e- mail, t he com[...]

  • Seite 476

    Communicati on Informat ion 22 2 E-mail Rece ptio n You can rece ive Inter net Fax do cu- ments ma nually using the { { { { Job I nfor - mation } } } } key. Newly-arrived e-mail is printed out when received manu ally. Note ❒ E-ma il can als o be rece ived ma nu- ally using the User Function keys. See p.52 “ Receiving Internet Fax ” , Facsimil[...]

  • Seite 477

    23 3. Other Transmission Features Handy Dialing Functions Chain Dial This allows you to compose a tel e- phone number from various parts, some of which may be store d in Quick Dials and some of which may be entered usin g the number keys. Note ❒ Maximum length o f a telephone or fax number: 128 digits. ❒ For Memory Transmission and Im - mediate[...]

  • Seite 478

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 24 3 Redial The ma chine stores the las t 10 desti- nati ons spec if ied. If yo u wa nt t o sen d a message to a destination which you sent faxes to recently, the Redial f unc- tion saves you t ime by finding and entering the destination again. Limitatio n ❒ The following kinds of desti na- tions are not st ored: •[...]

  • Seite 479

    On Hook Dial 25 3 On Hook Dial The On Hook Dial functio n allows you to dial w hile hearing tone from the internal speaker. You can send a fax checking the connection. Note ❒ This fun ctio n is un avai labl e in some countries. A A A A Place the original, and then select the scan settings you require. Referen ce p.11 “ Placing Originals ” , F[...]

  • Seite 480

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 26 3 Manual Dial The externa l telephone is r equired. Pick up the handset of the external telephone and dial. When the lin e is connected and you hear a high- pitched to ne, press the { { { { Star t } } } } key to send your fax message. If, on the oth- er hand, you hear a voice a t the other end, continue conversation[...]

  • Seite 481

    Transmiss ion Features 27 3 Transmiss ion Features Detecting Bl ank Sheet Upon c ompl eti on of t he fi rst pa ge scanning, an alarm sounds if t he page is nearly blank. When this happens, a message appe ars for a fe w seconds. The message dif fers depending on number of page s to be scanned and transmission mode. • When sending a document using [...]

  • Seite 482

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 28 3 More Transmission Functions If M emory R uns Out While Storing an Origin al If memory runs out while storing or sending an original (free space reach- es 0%), one of the following m essages appears. Press [ Exit ] to tr ansmit stored pages only. • During Memory Transmissio n: " Memory is full . Scanni ng wi[...]

  • Seite 483

    More Tran smission Functio ns 29 3 Checking the Tra nsmission Result • Turn the Transmission Result Re- port on if you want a report to be print ed after every success ful transmissio n. See p.31 “ Transmis- sion Result Report (Memory Transmission) ” . • If you leave the Tr ansmission Re- sult Report off, t he report wi ll not be printed af[...]

  • Seite 484

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 30 3 Note ❒ Note that during Immediate Tr ans- mission or wh en in Us er Tools mode, the machine cannot scan an original. JBIG Tran smission If you us e JB IG (Joi nt Bi- lev el Ima ge Expe rts G roup) c ompre ssio n, you can send photogra phic originals faster than w ith ot her m ethod s of co mpres- sion. Referenc [...]

  • Seite 485

    Printed Report 31 3 Printed Report Memory Storage Report Thi s repor t is pr inted af ter an origin al is stored in memo ry. It he lps you re- view the contents and th e destina- tions of stored original s. Limitatio n ❒ If you use Parall el Memory Trans- miss ion , t he Memo ry S tor age R e- port is not printed . Note ❒ You can tu rn this rep[...]

  • Seite 486

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 32 3 Communication Failure Rep ort This repo rt is pri nted when a message coul d not be su ccessful ly tran smitted with Memory Transmission. If the machine is set up to print a Transmis sion Result Report, t his re- port is not printed. Use it to keep a record of failed transmissio ns so you can send th em again. Not[...]

  • Seite 487

    33 4. Reception Features Recepti on Imme diate Recepti on Each page of a f ax me ssag e is print ed as soon as it is received. This method is used for standard fax messages. Nor mal ly th is mac hine rece ives m es- sages by Immediate Reception. How- ever, dependi ng on settings or certain conditions, Mem ory Reception or Subs titute Rec eptio n is[...]

  • Seite 488

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 34 4 Important ❒ When abou t one h our p ass es af ter power of the m achine is tu rned off, all fax messages stored in memory will be lost. If an y message s have been lost for t his r eason , a Pow er Failu re Repor t is automa tically printe d when the op eration switch is turned on. Use this report to ide ntif y lo st m[...]

  • Seite 489

    Recepti on 35 4 Receiving mes sages uncondi tionally If one of th e conditions listed belo w occurs, t he machine receives all fax messag- es using Subs titute Recep tion. Receiving messages accordi ng to parameter-specified settings If one of the con ditions listed below occu rs, the machi ne receives only those mes- sages that match the conditi o[...]

  • Seite 490

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 36 4 Reception Functions Forwar ding Received Docume nts This machin e can forward received docume nts to other destinations pro- grammed in memory based on Own Name, Own Fax Number or sender 's e-mail address. I f a send er's e -mail address is progra mmed as the des tination, docu- ments received are forwarded as [...]

  • Seite 491

    Reception Fu nctions 37 4 SMTP Reception Using Inter net Fax You can se t SMTP r eception with this machin e. W i t h S M T P r e c e p t i o n , e - m a i l i s r e c e iv e d a s s o o n a s i t i s s e n t t o t h e e - m a i l a d d r e s s set by the machine. Y ou can route received e-ma il to other Internet Fax machi nes also. Note ❒ DNS se[...]

  • Seite 492

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 38 4 Routing E-mail Received via SMTP E-mail received via SM TP can be routed to other fax machines. It can also be routed to destinat ions progra mmed as Quick Dial entrie s or Groups. Prep arat ion Before routi ng e-mail received via SMTP, you first must set "SMTP RX File Delivery Settings" to "On". See [...]

  • Seite 493

    Reception Fu nctions 39 4 - - - - Specif ying E- mail Tra nsfer The originator can request tr ansfer of e-mail sent to another fax machine by spec- ifying the e-m ail address as follows: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax Number fax=destination fax number@ host name of this machine. domain name Example: to transfer to fa x number 212- 123-4567, s pecify: fax=2121[...]

  • Seite 494

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 40 4 Printing Options Print Completi on Beep When this f unction is turned on, the machine be eps to let you k now when a received message has been printed. Note ❒ You can a lter the volume of the beep or turn it off completely (set the v olum e to th e min imum l evel ). See p.61 “ Adjusting the Volume ” , Facsimile Re[...]

  • Seite 495

    Prin ting O ption s 41 4 Reception Time You can have th e da te and time pri nt- ed at the bottom o f the messa ge when it is re ceived . You c an tur n this f unc- tion on or off using Reception Set- tings. See p.67 “ Re cep tion Set tings ” . Note ❒ When a received m essage is print- ed on tw o or mor e sheet s, th e date and time is printe[...]

  • Seite 496

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 42 4 Page Separation and Length Reduction When the size of a received message is longe r than the paper l oaded in t he machine, eac h page of the message can be split and pr inted on seve ral sheets, or reduced and pri nted on a single sheet. For example, this func- tion s pli ts the mess age if t he me ssag e length is 20 m[...]

  • Seite 497

    Prin ting O ption s 43 4 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Priori ty Table • KK and LL indic ate that the message is split o ver two pages of paper wi th the orie ntatio n and size shown. Paper sele ct priority may differ if no page separation threshold is set. Note ❒ Widths that th is machine c an re- ceive are A 4, B4 J IS, and A3. An y messages narrower than [...]

  • Seite 498

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 44 4 Just size printing Received do cuments are pr inted on the paper tha t has first prio rity (see p.43 “ Priorit y Tab le ” ). Th is fun ction is set using "Use r Parameters"(s witch 05,bit 05). T he default is Off . If there is no suit able si ze pape r, the mes sasge "Out of paper " appears. Load [...]

  • Seite 499

    45 5. Using Fax with Computers Sendin g Fax Document s from Comput ers The optional printer/sca nner unit is required. Using com puters connected to th e machine through para llel ports, IEEE 1394 (IP Over 1394) ports, LANs, or wireless LANs, you can fax documents, created us- ing Windo ws applications, to ot her fax machines over a telephone line.[...]

  • Seite 500

    Using Fax with Co mputers 46 5 Before Use To use these features, a LAN-Fax Driver must be installed on your computer. Use the L AN -Fax driver i ncluded on th e printer CD-ROM. You must also mak e the re quired com puter to fax networ k settings on the machine, accor ding to the type o f conn ec tio n. Referenc e When a personal com puter and th e [...]

  • Seite 501

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 47 5 ❒ Auto Run might not work auto- maticall y with certai n OS settings . If this is the case, doubl e-click “ Set - up.exe ” , lo cated on the CD-RO M root d irectory. ❒ If you want to c ancel Auto Run, hold do wn the { { { { SHIFT } } } } key (when your system is Windows 2000/XP or Windows Server 2[...]

  • Seite 502

    Using Fax with Co mputers 48 5 Applications Stored on the CD-ROM This sect ion provide s informati on about LAN-Fax D river, Address Book, and L AN-Fax Cove r She et Ed i- tor. LAN-Fax Driver This drive r allows you to use LAN- Fax fu nct ion s. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Locatio n of the File The f ollowin g fo lders a re on th e CD-ROM: • LAN-Fax Driver f[...]

  • Seite 503

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 49 5 When this mach ine is con nected to a network, selection s for the option configuration ar e automatically per- formed. For details, see Help. Note ❒ If the opti ons on this m achine are not configured as i nstructed, LAN- Fax functi ons may fai l to work as intende d. ❒ If your o perating system is W[...]

  • Seite 504

    Using Fax with Co mputers 50 5 B B B B Sele ct [ LAN-Fax M5 ] in [ Pri nter Name ] . C C C C Click [ OK ] . The LAN-Fax dialog box appears. Note ❒ The setti ng method may d iffer depending on the applicatio n you are using. In a ll cases, select [ LAN-Fax M5 ] for the prin ter. D D D D Specify the destination. Use one of the f ollowing proce- dur[...]

  • Seite 505

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 51 5 B In the [ Name: ] list s elect [ Con- tact ] , [ Company ] , or [ Group ] , an d then sel ect [ All ] or an initial let- ter. The destinations matching the select ed paramet ers appear. C Clic k t he de sti nat ion to hig h- light it, and then cl ick [ Set as Dest ina tion ] . The entered destination is [...]

  • Seite 506

    Using Fax with Co mputers 52 5 Spec ifyin g optio ns You can specify the following op- tion s: For details, see Help. • Sending at S pecific Time • User Code • User ID • Print Fax Header A A A A Click [ Option. .. ] . B B B B Specify options you want to use. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ To send the fax do cument at a spe - cific time: Select t he [ Send[...]

  • Seite 507

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 53 5 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Web B rowse r • ID • User ID • Status • Page(s) • Starte d At • Document No. Referenc e For det ails, see Help. Printing and Saving You can print documen ts created us- ing Windows applications. You can al so save documents in TIF format. Open the applic ation document you wan [...]

  • Seite 508

    Using Fax with Co mputers 54 5 G Enter a file nam e. Note ❒ You can also change the fold- er in this step. H Click [ Save ] . The image file is saved in the specifie d folder. Editing Addr ess Book You can progr am an d edi t dest ina- tions in the address list using the Ad - dres s B ook. For details, see Help. A A A A On the [ St art ] menu, po[...]

  • Seite 509

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 55 5 Note ❒ The co nfi rmati on d ialog box does not app ear when you have not made any changes aft er starting Address Book. - - - - Usin g the ma chin e's Ad dres s Book data as the LAN-Fax's Address Bo ok data You can retr ieve the A ddress B ook data of this machine using SmartDe- viceM oni tor[...]

  • Seite 510

    Using Fax with Co mputers 56 5 Note ❒ Cover sheet d ata is stored in its own for mat (u sing "fcp " as i ts ex- tension) A A A A On the [ St art ] menu, poi nt to [ Pro- grams ] , [ LAN-Fax Utilities ] , an d then click [ LAN-Fa x Cover Sheet Editor ] . The dialog box of LAN-Fax Cover Sheet Editor appears. B B B B Edit the cover sheet. [...]

  • Seite 511

    Sending Fax Doc uments from Comput ers 57 5 LAN-Fax Operati on Messages Note ❒ You ca n have the LAN-Fa x Erro r Repor t prin ted when op tion s are not p rop- erly sele cted, or there is a communication er ror with a computer. See p. 76 “ User Para meters ” (swit ch 20, bit 0). LAN-Fax Error Report This rep ort is print ed whe n optio ns are[...]

  • Seite 512

    Using Fax with Co mputers 58 5 Editing Rec eiver's Fax Information Via Web Browse r When the r eceiv er being pro- gram med or added t o the a ddress book i s a T.37 full m ode compa tible type wit h the Interne t Fa x funct ion, you can set the follo wing receiv er's fax infor mat ion u sin g a W eb br owser . • Compression t ype • P[...]

  • Seite 513

    Editing Receiver's Fax Informat ion Via Web Browse r 59 5 B Under [ In ternet Fax Data F ormat ] , set the items of fax information to meet the receiver 's specifica- tions, excep t for [ Select mode ] . Note ❒ If [ Simple mode ] is select ed, the fax information cannot be set. Selec t the T.37 full mode compatible receiver in step A , [...]

  • Seite 514

    Using Fax with Co mputers 60 5 Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_FM.b ook Page 60 Tu esday, Ja nuary 13, 2004 1:22 PM[...]

  • Seite 515

    61 6. Facsimile Features Function List The User Tool s allow you to program you r identification, store frequentl y used number s and settings, an d customize d efault settings to m eet your needs. The User Tools are grouped by functions so that you can quickly and easily fi nd the de sire d User To ol. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Print List/Report ❖ ❖ ❖[...]

  • Seite 516

    Facsimil e Features 62 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ E-mail Setting s ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Key Operator Tool s - - - - Displa ys • Press the { { { { User To ols/Counter } } } } key to enter User Tools menu. • You can switch the display using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } . • The selected item is highlighted. • When you h ave made all requir[...]

  • Seite 517

    Func tio n List 63 6 - - - - Key Operator Code When Key Op erator Code is p rogrammed and turned on, u sers have to enter a progr ammed Ke y Opera tor C ode ( eight digit s max imum) t o oper ate the Us er Tools. This prevents unauthorized peop le from changing settings. Note ❒ You can turn the K ey Operator Code o n or off in “ System Setting [...]

  • Seite 518

    Facsimil e Features 64 6 Accessi ng User Tools ( Facsimi le Feature s) Customize the fac simile settings ac- cording to the operations to be fre- quentl y perfor med. Note ❒ Cus tomized facs imile defau lts are kept until the defaults are changed again. The new settings are not canceled b y turning of f the mai n powe r swi tch or the O per atio [...]

  • Seite 519

    Accessing User Tools (F acsimile Featu res) 65 6 E E E E Follow the displayed instructions to chang e the default, and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Depending on the menu, y ou may need t o rep eat st ep E . When yo u have sele cted th e pri nt menu, press the { { { { Start } } } } key to print . Note ❒ If you make a mistake, repeat fr[...]

  • Seite 520

    Facsimil e Features 66 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Print TX Stand by File List (P rint Transmission Standby Fil e List) Use t his fun cti on to pri nt th e tran s- mission standby file list. A Sele ct [ Print TX Standby File Li st ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and the n press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ If the machi ne is [...]

  • Seite 521

    Accessing User Tools (F acsimile Featu res) 67 6 • Print TX St atus Report (Print Transmission Stat us Report) • Manual E-mail Recept ion A Select User Function key yo u want t o progra m. B Select the functi on you want to program in the U ser Function key, and th en press t he { { { { OK } } } } key. Reception Settings ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Switch [...]

  • Seite 522

    Facsimil e Features 68 6 E-mail Settings ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Internet Fax Settings You can se lect to displ ay [] or not. When you wa nt to send an In- ternet F ax, set On to dis play the icon. • On • Off ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Maximum E-mail Size Make this se tting when you want to li mit th e si ze of e -ma il mes sage s that are transm itted, if receiv[...]

  • Seite 523

    Accessing User Tools (F acsimile Featu res) 69 6 A Sele ct [ On ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Enter the sen ding e-mail ad- dress with transmissio n permis- sion. C Press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_FM.b ook Page 69 Tu esday, Ja nuary 13, 2004 1:22 PM[...]

  • Seite 524

    Facsimil e Features 70 6 Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_FM.b ook Page 70 Tu esday, Ja nuary 13, 2004 1:22 PM[...]

  • Seite 525

    71 7. Key Operator Setting Key Operator Tools L ist You can also set the line type for the machine connec tion, program Memory Lock I D, fax destinations, and many other items. In additi on, you can c heck the numb er of document s transmitted and received. Function name Description Reference Communicati on Page Count C hecks the transmissi on and [...]

  • Seite 526

    Key Operator Set ting 72 7 Using Ke y Opera tor Set tings Counters This f unction allo ws you to check the total num ber of pages trans mitted and rece ived on the display. • Transmissions: Total nu mber of tr ansmitted pages • Recepti ons: Total number of received page s A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele[...]

  • Seite 527

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 73 7 Note ❒ An e-mail address can be set as the forwarding destinati on. ❒ If you do not progra m an End Re- ceiver, the machin e performs printing but not forwarding even with the For war ding func tio n On. ❒ You can progr am one of the User Funct ion ke ys with opera tions for this func tion. Yo u can then swi[...]

  • Seite 528

    Key Operator Set ting 74 7 Note ❒ If ther e is an End Receiver alre ady progr ammed , a r ecei ver name is shown. If you want to change the receiver, press the { { { { Clear/ Stop } } } } key and proceed to st ep F . ❒ To cancel Forwarding, press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key and p roceed to step G . F F F F Spec ify an En d Rece iv er us ing [...]

  • Seite 529

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 75 7 Memory Lock When you switch Memory Lock on, received messages are stored in mem- ory and not print ed automat ically. When a mess age is r eceived in the Memor y Loc k mode , the Recei ve F ile indicato r blinks. To prin t this mes- sage, enter the Memory Lock ID. A user without the ID cannot print th e message. T[...]

  • Seite 530

    Key Operator Set ting 76 7 User P aramet ers User Parameters allow you to customize various settings to suit your needs. To change function settings, set the User Parameter Switches. Prep arat ion Access t o some U ser Param eter Se ttings requires other settings be made be - forehand. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Switches and Bits Each User Parameter has a set[...]

  • Seite 531

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 77 7 05 0 Receive S ervice Call ( SC) Conditio n (Substit ute Rece p- tion duri ng service ca ll) Possible (Substi- tute RX) Not possible (Re- ceptio n off) 2, 1 Substitu te the rec eption wh en the mach ine cannot p rint (bec ause all pa- per trays have run out of pape r, toner is empty, o r all paper trays are o ut o[...]

  • Seite 532

    Key Operator Set ting 78 7 18 0 Print date with Fax Heade r Off On 1 Print transmitter origin with Fax Head er Off On 2 Print file numb er with Fax Head er Off On 3 Print p age number with F ax Head er Off On 19 1 Sort Journal by line type Off On 20 0 A utomatic printing of the LAN-Fa x Error Report Off On 1 Repri nt do cume nts th at co uld not be[...]

  • Seite 533

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 79 7 Changing the User Parameters Important ❒ We reco mme nd you pr int an d keep a User Parameter l ist when you program or change a User Pa- rameter. See p.80 “ Printing the User Parameter List ” . ❒ Do not change any bit switch es other than t hose show n on the pre- vious pages. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { [...]

  • Seite 534

    Key Operator Set ting 80 7 Printing the User Parameter List Print this list t o see the current User Parameter settings. However, only item s of impor tance or often-us ed items are i ncluded in th e list. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Fax Fe atures ] using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } [...]

  • Seite 535

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 81 7 Home Position Items used for transmitting documents can be set as the home positions. When documents are sc anned and transmiss ion is c ompleted, items au tomatically re- turn to thei r home positions. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Home Posit ion Setti ng Functi ons • Image Density Allows one of five image density steps to b[...]

  • Seite 536

    Key Operator Set ting 82 7 Imp ortan t ❒ If yo u tu rn th i s f un ct io n of f, th e sca l e o f t he o rig ina l i s m ain ta i ned and some parts o f the image ma y be lost at the other end. • Fax Header Allows the f ax header as the home positi on to be set to on or off. See p.8 “ Fax Header Print ” . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Home Position Param[...]

  • Seite 537

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 83 7 Changing the Home Positio n Note ❒ For details about setting parame- ters, see p.76 “ User P aramete rs ” . Follow t he procedu re below to set the home posi tion par ameters. Important ❒ Do not change any bit switch es othe r than tho se sho wn in th e above table. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ [...]

  • Seite 538

    Key Operator Set ting 84 7 Special Senders t o Treat Differ ently By pr ogra mmin g part icula r receiv ers in advance, you can set the follow ing function for eac h receiver: • Author ized Rece ption • Forwarding • Memor y L ock Use the Own Name or Own Fax Number to program your receivers. If the rece iver has a machine of the same ma nufa c[...]

  • Seite 539

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 85 7 ❒ You cannot use the foll owing func- tions with Inte rnet Fax recep tions. • Auth orized R ecept ion • Memory Loc k ❒ To use t he Forwardin g, with Inter - net Fax receptions, program the e- mail address of the sender. ❒ To search by partial matc hing, en- ter the firs t characters of the E-m ail addres[...]

  • Seite 540

    Key Operator Set ting 86 7 Referen ce p.91 “ Programm ing a Mem ory Lock ID ” Lim ita tion ❒ If y ou pro gra m the s ame sende r in Memory Lock an d Forward- ing, Forwarding is d isabled. Program ming/ Changi ng Special Send ers A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Sele ct [ Fax Fe atures ] using { { { {U U U U[...]

  • Seite 541

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 87 7 I I I I Select the i tem you want to pro- gram using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You must select only the item you want to program. ❒ To cancel these sett ings, press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key. The display re- turns to that of step E[...]

  • Seite 542

    Key Operator Set ting 88 7 D Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The di splay return s to th at of Step I . Note ❒ After you p erform step J , set "Forwarding" of “ Re ceptio n Settings ” to "On". See p.67 “ Reception Sett ings ” . Memory Lock A Select [ Memory Lock ] usin g { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } [...]

  • Seite 543

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 89 7 D D D D Sele ct [ Prog ram Spec ial S end er ] us- ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E E Sele ct [ Delete Special S ender ] us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , an d then press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Select the Speci[...]

  • Seite 544

    Key Operator Set ting 90 7 F F F F Select the func tion you w ant to program. Note ❒ In this feature, “ Autho rized Re- cept ion ” has the same settings as “ Reception Settings ” . See p.67 “ Reception Set tings ” . Programming Authorized RX A Select [ Authorized Receptio n ] us- ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , an[...]

  • Seite 545

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 91 7 E E E E Sele ct [ Print S pecial Se nder Lis t ] us- ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ To cancel print ing, press the { { { { Cancel } } } } key. The dis play re- turns to that of step E . F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒[...]

  • Seite 546

    Key Operator Set ting 92 7 E E E E Enter an ID using the number keys, and then pre ss the { { { { OK } } } } or { { { {# # # #} } } } key . Note ❒ If you make a m istake, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key before pressing the { { { { OK } } } } key, a nd th en try again. To cance l programm ing an ID, press t he { { { { Cancel } } } } key. [...]

  • Seite 547

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 93 7 G3 Analog Lin e You need to ma ke the fol lowing set- tings for the G3 An alog Line befor e you connect the machine to a stand- ard G3 analog line. • When your ma chine is connected through a PA BX, set to Extension. If it is c onnec ted di rectl y to the t el- ephone net work, set to Outside. • Outside Access[...]

  • Seite 548

    Key Operator Set ting 94 7 B Select the i tem using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. Selectable item s differ depend - ing on the mach ine de stina tion . or The di splay return s to th at of step A . Note ❒ When you sel ect [ Extens io n ] , or [ PREFIX ] , [ GROUND ] or [ FLASH ] , ent[...]

  • Seite 549

    95 8. Solving Operation Problems When An Error Repor t is Printed An Error Repor t is pr inted if a mes- sage cannot be successfully sent o r re- ceived . Possib le cause s incl ude a pr oblem with your machine or noise on th e tel- ephone line. If an error occurs during transmissio n, resend the original. If an error occurs d uring re ceptio n, as[...]

  • Seite 550

    Solving Operat ion Problems 96 8 Turning Off the M ain Po wer/In Cas e of a Power Failure R CAUTIO N: Even if the main pow er switch i s turned off, the con tents of the ma - chine memory (for example, pro- grammed numbers) will not be lost. Howeve r, if power is lost for about one hou r because th e main pow er switch is turned off, there is a pow[...]

  • Seite 551

    When an Error Occurs Us ing Int ernet F ax 97 8 When an Error Occ urs Using Internet Fax Erro r Mail Notifi cat ion The ma chine sends the Error Mail No tification to the sender when i t is unable to successful ly receive a par ticular e -mail message . A "cc" of this notificat ion is als o sent to t he key oper ator's e-mail add res[...]

  • Seite 552

    Solving Operat ion Problems 98 8 Stell aC2-AEco mbine -F_FM.b ook Page 98 Tu esday, Ja nuary 13, 2004 1:22 PM[...]

  • Seite 553

    99 9. Appendix Connecti ng the Machine to a Te lephone Line and Tel ephone Connecting the Telephone Line To connect th e machine to a teleph one line, use a snap-in modular type connec- tor. Important ❒ Make s ure the connector i s the co rrect t ype befor e you sta rt. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Where to conn ect the machine 1. G3 interface unit connector [...]

  • Seite 554

    Appendix 100 9 Speci fications ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax Transmission and Reception ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Power Co nsumptio n *1 *1 The mach ine conf igura tio n is m ain unit with the ADF fax u nit , pri nter/ sca nner u nit , and pa per tray u nit. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Internet Fax Transmission and Reception Standard G3 Resolution 8 × 3.85/ mm • 200 × 100 dpi[...]

  • Seite 555

    Specificat ions 101 9 *1 Support ed for A4 or smal ler si ze docum ent. Compatible Machines This machi ne can commun icate with Internet Fax mach ines that meet the follow - ing specification requirem ents. *1 Available in f ull mode, dependin g on the other party's setti ngs. Communication Protocols • Transmissi on SMTP , TC P/I P • Recep[...]

  • Seite 556

    Appendix 102 9 Acceptabl e Types of Originals Make sure your or iginal s are complet ely dry befo re setting them in the machine. Wet ink or corr ecting fluid from ori ginals will mark the exposure glass and affect the resu lting im age. Acceptable original sizes Paper size and scanned area ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Exposure Glass ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ ADF Where o[...]

  • Seite 557

    Specificat ions 103 9 Limitatio n ❒ There may be a difference i n the size of the image when it is printed at the des- tination. ❒ If you place an origi nal larger than A4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" on the exposure glass, only an A 4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" area is scanned. Note ❒ Ev en i f a n o ri gi nal is co rre ct l y p la ce d on t[...]

  • Seite 558

    Appendix 104 9 Maximum Values The followi ng list contains the maximum value for each item. Note ❒ The max imum num ber of pages that can be stor ed or transm itt ed may de - crease depending on the contents of docum ents. Item Descrip tion Memory 3 MB The number of pages that you can store in m emory (Using A4 size Standard <I TU-T #4Chart>[...]

  • Seite 559

    105 INDEX A Address B ook , 48 Applicat ions Stor ed on the CD-ROM , 48 Aut hor ized Rec ept ion , 67 , 85 Auto Fax Reception P ower- up , 39 Automatic Redial , 29 Auto Reduce , 81 Auto run pro gram , 46 B Basic Transm issio n , 49 Batch T ransmissi on , 29 C Cancel ing a Tr ansmiss ion , 11 Centre Mar k , 40 , 67 Chain Di al , 23 Checke red Mark ,[...]

  • Seite 560

    106 AE AE B168-8658 L Label Ins ertion , 9 LAN-Fax Cover Shee t Editor , 48 Driver , 48 Erro r Report , 57 Operatio n Messages , 57 Properties, Se tting , 48 Result by E-mail , 57 Line Type Sele ct ing , 99 M Manual Dial , 26 Maxim um E-ma il Size , 68 Maximum Valu es , 104 Memory Lock , 75 , 85 Memory Lock ID , 91 Memory Recepti on , 33 More Tr an[...]

  • Seite 561

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 112 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.480000 mm Intr oduc tio n This man ual des cribes d etaile d instr uctions on the operat ion and notes about t he use of th is machi ne. To get maxi mum versat il[...]

  • Seite 562

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 112 // P rint scal e=81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thick ness / 2 = 4.480000 mm Operatin g Instruction s Facsimile Refe rence <Advan ced Features> Operating Instructions Facsimile Reference <A dvanced Features > Operat i[...]

  • Seite 563

    Network Guide For safe and correct use of this machine, please be sure to read the Safety Information in the "Copy Referen ce" before you use it. Functions Availabl e over a Network Connecting the Ne twork Cable to th e Network Setting Up the Machine on a Network Windows Configur ation Using the Pr inter Functio n Using Smar tDeviceMonito[...]

  • Seite 564

    Introduction This manu al descri bes detail ed instruc tions o n the operatio n and no tes about the use of this m achine. To get m aximum versat ility fro m this mach ine all operators are requested to read this m anual c arefull y and follo w the in structi ons. Plea se keep t his m anual in a handy p lace n ear the ma chine . Important Contents [...]

  • Seite 565

    i Manuals for This Machine The following manuals describe the operational procedures of this machine. For particular function s, see the relevant parts of the manual. Note ❒ Manuals provided are specific to machine type. ❒ Adobe Acrobat Reader is n ecessary to view the manuals as a PDF file. ❒ Three CD-ROMs are pr ovided: • CD-ROM 1 “Oper[...]

  • Seite 566

    ii ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manuals for DeskTopBinde r V2 Lite DeskTopBinder V2 Lite is a u tility included on the CD-ROM labeled “ Scanner Driver & Document Manag ement Utilities ” . • DeskTopBinder V2 Lite Setup Guide (PDF file - CD-ROM2) Describes i nstallation of, and the operating env ironment for DeskTop- Binder V2 Lite in d etail. This guid[...]

  • Seite 567

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS Manuals for This Machine ...... ....... ....... ....... .......... ....... ....... ........ ....... ....... ....... ...... i How to Read Thi s Manual ........... ......... ......... ......... .......... ......... ......... ....... ......... ... 1 1. Functions Available over a Network Usi ng the Pri nter ..... ....... ...... ..[...]

  • Seite 568

    iv 5. U sing the Printe r Function Printing wi th Windows ....... ..... ........ ....... ....... ........ ..... ....... ........ ....... ....... ........ .... 47 Printing wi th a Windows 2 000/XP, Windo ws Server 2003 or Window s NT 4.0 Print Server ... 4 7 Printin g without a Prin t Serve r ...... .......... ......... ......... .......... ...... .[...]

  • Seite 569

    v Understanding Di splayed Info rmation ....... .......... ......... ......... ......... ......... ........ 105 Print J ob Inform ation .. ......... ...... .......... ......... ......... ....... ......... ......... .......... ...... ........ 105 Print L og Inform ation ..... ......... .......... ...... ......... ......... .......... ...... ........[...]

  • Seite 570

    vi[...]

  • Seite 571

    1 How to Read This Manual Symbols In this manual, the following sy mbols are used: R WARNING: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed, could result in death or serious inj ury. R CAUTION: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed,[...]

  • Seite 572

    2 Names of Major Components a nd Software The following software products ar e referred to using a general name: • DeskT opBinder V2 Lite and DeskT opBinder V2 profession al → De skT op- Binder V2 Lite/pr ofessi onal • ScanRouter V2 Lite and ScanRouter V2 professional (optional) → ScanRo uter V2 Lite/professional[...]

  • Seite 573

    3 1. Functions Available over a Netwo rk This ma chine prov ides prin ter, LA N-Fax, Inter net Fax , an d scanner funct ions over a network. Using the Printer The network interfac e board is compatible wi th NetWare *1 (IPX/SPX, TCP/IP), Windows NT 4.0 (TCP/IP, NetBEUI *2 , IPP *3 ), Windows 2000 (TCP/IP, Net- BEUI *2 , IPP *3 ), W indows XP (TCP/I[...]

  • Seite 574

    Functions Available over a Network 4 1 Using Fax Internet Fax This machine converts scann ed document images to e-mail format and transmits the data over the Internet. Specify the e-mail addres s instead of the fa x number, and then sen d the docu- ment . E-mail can be received on a fax machine that supports Internet Fax, or on a com - puter that c[...]

  • Seite 575

    Using Fax 5 1 LAN-Fax You can fax documents over phone lines from any computer connected to the machine via Ethern et, IEEE 1394 (IP over 1 394), or IEEE 8 02.11b (wireless LAN). To send a fax, print from the Windows application you ar e working with, select LAN-Fax as the printer, and then sp ecify the destination. You can also chec k the sent ima[...]

  • Seite 576

    Functions Available over a Network 6 1 Network Scanner E-mail Scan f ile atta ched to an e- mail ca n be s ent usi ng the e- mail s ystem through a LAN or the In ternet. Reference For details abo ut what settings to make, see p.15 “ Setting Up the Ma chine on a Network ” . For details about us ing this func tion, se e “ Sending Scan Files by [...]

  • Seite 577

    Network Scanner 7 1 Network De livery Scanner You can use the machine as a delivery scanner for Sc anRouter V2 Lite / Profes- sional. Scan file or document received by fax can be stored in the delivery server, or de- livered via the network to specified folders on client computers. Reference For details abo ut what settings to make, see p.15 “ Se[...]

  • Seite 578

    Functions Available over a Network 8 1 Network T WAIN Scan ner You can use the scann ing function o f this machine from a comp uter connect ed via a network (Ethe rnet, IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394), or IEE E 802.11b (wireless LAN)). You can sc an documen ts the same way you woul d if you wer e using a scan ner connect ed direct ly to your c omputer. Re[...]

  • Seite 579

    9 2. Connecting the Network Cable to the Network Confirming the Connection 1. 10BASE-T/100BASE -TX port Port for connecting the 10BASE-T or 100BASE-TX cable 2. IEEE 1394 ports (optional) Ports for co nnecting the IE EE 1394 int er- face cable 3. Wireless LAN card (optional) Port for u sing th e wir eless L AN ABW022S1 When the IEEE 1394 interface b[...]

  • Seite 580

    Connecting the Network Cable to the Network 10 2 Connectin g to the Eth ernet Interf ace The network interface board supp orts 10BASE-T or 1 00BASE-TX connec - tions. A A A A Turn o ff the main power s witch. Important ❒ Make sure the main po wer is off. See “ Turning On the Po w- er ” , Copy Reference . B B B B Loop the ne twork interface ca[...]

  • Seite 581

    Confirming the Connection 11 2 Connecting to the IEEE 13 94 Interf ace Important ❒ Before maki ng the co nnectio n, touch the metallic part to ground your self. Note ❒ Use the inter face cable supplied with the IE EE 1394 i nterface board (optional). ❒ Make sure the interface cable is not looped. A A A A Connect the IEEE 1394 interface cable [...]

  • Seite 582

    Connecting the Network Cable to the Network 12 2 Confirming the Connection A A A A Make s ure the LE D of the IE EE 802.11b card is l it. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When using in inf rastructure mode 1. If it is co nnect ed pr oper ly t o the network, the LED is green when in infrast ructure mode. If t he LED is blinking, the machine is searching for dev ices[...]

  • Seite 583

    Confirming the Connection 13 2 Checkin g the m achine 's radi o wave status When using in infrastructure mode, you can check the machine's radio wave status using the contr ol panel. Note ❒ To check the radio wave s tatus, se- lect [ IEEE 802.11 b ] under [ LAN Type ] on t he [ Ne twork ] scr een. A A A A Press the { { { { User Tools/Co[...]

  • Seite 584

    Connecting the Network Cable to the Network 14 2[...]

  • Seite 585

    15 3. Setting Up the Machine on a Network User Tools Menu ( System Settings ) This section des cribes the network settin gs you can change with User Tools (Sys- tem Set tings ). Make se ttin gs accordin g to fu nctions you want t o use and the in- terface to be connected. Important ❒ These settin gs should be made by the sys tems administrator, o[...]

  • Seite 586

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 16 3 *1 Appears when the IEEE 139 4 inter face board ( optional) is install ed. *2 Appears when the IEEE 802 .11b unit (op tional) i s installed . If Ethernet and IEEE 802.11b (wir eless LAN) are both connected to the machine, the selected int erface has priority . *3 Check [ Ef fective ] is selected for TCP/IP. [...]

  • Seite 587

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 17 3 Internet Fax Interface Se ttings Ethernet Interface Set tings/ Network See p.28 “ Interfa ce Settings /Network ” . IP Addr ess $ Gateway Address $ DNS Configuration ❍ WINS Configuration ❍ Effective Protocol *5 $ LAN Ty pe *2 $ Ethernet Sp eed ❍ Host Name ❍ Domain Name ❍ File Transfer See p.32 “[...]

  • Seite 588

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 18 3 IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394) Interface Settings/ IEEE 13 94 *1 See p.29 “ Interfa ce Settin gs/IEE E 1394 ” . IP Addr ess $ WINS Configuration ❍ IP ove r 1394 $ Host Name ❍ Domain Name ❍ Interface Settings/ Network See p.28 “ Interfa ce Settings /Network ” . Gateway Address $ DNS Configuration ❍ [...]

  • Seite 589

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 19 3 *1 Appears when the IEEE 139 4 inter face board ( optional) is install ed. *2 Appears when the IEEE 802 .11b unit (op tional) i s installed . If Ethernet and 802.11b (w ireless LAN) are both connected to t he machine, the select- ed inte rface has pr iority. *3 Minimum settings required to use transmission. *4[...]

  • Seite 590

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 20 3 E-mail Interface Se ttings Ethernet Interface Set tings/ Network See p.28 “ Interfa ce Settings /Network ” . IP Addr ess $ Gateway Address $ DNS Configuration ❍ WINS Configuration ❍ Effective Protocol *3 $ LAN Ty pe *2 $ Ethernet Sp eed ❍ Host Name ❍ Domain Name ❍ File Transfer See p.32 “ Fil[...]

  • Seite 591

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 21 3 *1 Appears when the IEEE 139 4 inter face board ( optional) is install ed. *2 App ears whe n the 80 2.11b u nit (opt ional) i s instal led. If Ethernet and 802.11b (w ireless LAN) are both connected to t he machine, the select- ed inte rface has pr iority. *3 Check [ Ef fective ] is selected for TCP/IP. *4 If [...]

  • Seite 592

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 22 3 Network De livery Scanner Interface Se ttings Ethernet Interface Set tings/ Network See p.28 “ Interfa ce Settings /Network ” . IP Addr ess $ Gateway Address ❍ DNS Configuration ❍ WINS Configuration ❍ Effective Protocol *4 $ LAN Ty pe *2 $ Ethernet Sp eed ❍ Host Name ❍ Domain Name ❍ File Tran[...]

  • Seite 593

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 23 3 *1 Appears when the IEEE 139 4 inter face board ( optional) is install ed. *2 Appears when the IEEE 802 .11b unit (op tional) i s installed . If Ethernet and IEEE 802.11b (wir eless LAN) are both connected to the machine, the selected int erface has priority . *3 When deliv ery opti on is set t o [ On ] , make[...]

  • Seite 594

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 24 3 *1 Appears when the IEEE 139 4 inter face board ( optional) is install ed. *2 Appears when the IEEE 802 .11b unit (op tional) i s installed . If Ethernet and 802.11b (w ireless LAN) are both connected to t he machine, the select- ed inte rface has pr iority. *3 Check [ Ef fective ] is selected for TCP/IP. IE[...]

  • Seite 595

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 25 3 Networ k Configur ation Any change you make with User Tool s rema ins in effe ct even if th e main power sw itch or operation switch is turne d off, or the { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key is pressed. Configuring the network us ing the control panel Note ❒ Operations for System Sett ings are differ ent from n[...]

  • Seite 596

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 26 3 Configuring the network using othe r utilities As well as using the control panel to make network settings, utilities such as a We b br owser an d Smar tDev ice Mo nito r for Adm in can also be u sed. The fol low- ing table shows available s ettings: Note ❒❍ Indic ates machine s ettings can be changed . [...]

  • Seite 597

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 27 3 *1 You can make the TCP/IP settings if SmartDeviceMo nitor for Admin is communi- cati ng wi th the m achin e usin g IPX /SPX . *2 You can make the IP X/SPX sett ings if Smar tDeviceMo nitor for Ad min is communi- cati ng wi th the m ach ine us ing T CP/I P. Inte rface Settings IEEE 1394 IP Address Specify IP A[...]

  • Seite 598

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 28 3 Settings You C an Change with User Tool s Interfa ce Settings/Net work ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ IP Address Before using this machine in the netw ork en viro nmen t, you must configure the I P address and sub- net ma sk. • Auto-Obtain (DHCP) • Spec if y When you sel ect [ Specify ] , enter [ IP Address: ] and [ Su[...]

  • Seite 599

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 29 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Effective Protocol Select the protoco l to use in the network. • TCP/IP:Effective/In valid • NetWare:Effective/Invalid • SMB:Effective/Invalid • AppleTalk:Effective/Invalid Note ❒ Def au lt : TCP /IP: Effe ctive , Net- Ware: Effective , SMB: Effective , AppleT alk: Effec tive ❖ ❖ [...]

  • Seite 600

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 30 3 ❒ When you use the IEEE 1394 in- terf ace on a networ k, you can- not use the Ethern et interf ace in the same domain. To use b oth interfaces in the same domain, set di fferen t value s for [ Sub-net Mask: ] . ❒ The physical addres s (MAC ad- dress) also app ears. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ WINS Configuration You [...]

  • Seite 601

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 31 3 Interfac e Setti ngs/IE EE 802.1 1b Preparation You must install the IEEE 802.11b unit (optional) into the machine. Note ❒ Be sure to make all settings simul- taneo usly. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Communication M ode Specifies the communication mode of th e wireless LAN. • 802.11 Ad hoc • Ad hoc • Infrastructure[...]

  • Seite 602

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 32 3 Interface Settings/Print I/F Settings List You can check i tems relat ed to the network in use. Reference For details about printin g, see p.36 “ Printing the interface settings lists ” . File Transfer ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Delivery Option Ena bles or disab les se ndin g scanned documents via the Scan- Router [...]

  • Seite 603

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 33 3 ❒ [ Encryp t: ] - [ On ] : If the authentica- tion meth od is CRAM-MD5. ❒ [ Encryp t: ] - [ Off ] : I f the authentica- tion method is PLAIN, or LOGIN. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ POP before SMTP You can configure POP aut hentica- tion (POP before SMTP). Authenticatio n prevents unau- thorized access, by authenticati [...]

  • Seite 604

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 34 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Key Operator' s E-mail Add. If the sender is not specifie d on e- mailed scanned documents, this appears as the s ender ’ s addr ess. This can be used as the sender with SMTP authentication for Internet Fax. If [ On ] is selected for [ SM TP Au- thentication ] be sure to en ter the key[...]

  • Seite 605

    User Tools Menu (System Settings) 35 3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax Mail Reception Account Spec ify [ E-mail Address ] , [ User Name ] , and [ Password ] for receiving Inte rnet f axes. • E-mail Address • User Na me • Password Limitatio n ❒ Enter an e-mail address using up to 128 a lphanumeric charac- ters . ❒ Enter a u ser name us ing up to 64 al[...]

  • Seite 606

    Setting Up the Machine on a Network 36 3 Delet ing a subje ct A Select [ Del ete ] us ing { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. B Select the subject using { { { {U U U U} } } } or { { { {T T T T} } } } , and then pr ess the { { { { OK } } } } key. Confirmation message appear s. C To delete the [...]

  • Seite 607

    37 4. Windows Configuration Configuring TCP/I P This de scribes h ow to conf igure Win- dows for TCP/I P and IPP. Configuring a Windows 95/98/Me Computer Follow th e procedure below to con- figure a Windows 9 5/98/Me compu- ter to use TCP/ IP. A A A A Open [ Control Panel ] , and then double-click the Network icon . Make sure [ TCP/IP ] is selected[...]

  • Seite 608

    Windows Configuration 38 4 Configuring a Windows XP Computer Follow th e procedure below to con- figur e a Windo ws XP co mput er to use TCP/IP. A A A A On the [ Start ] men u, cli ck [ Contro l Pane l ] , and then click [ Network and Internet Connections ] . B B B B Click [ Network Connec tions ] , and then double-clic k [ Local Area Con - nection[...]

  • Seite 609

    Configuring TCP/IP 39 4 Configur ing a Windows NT 4. 0 Computer Follow th e procedure below to con- figure a Windows NT 4. 0 computer to use TCP/IP. A A A A Open [ Control Panel ] , and then double-click the Network icon . Make sure [ TCP/IP Protocol ] is se- lected in the [ Network pro tocols ] box on the [ Protocols ] ta b. Note ❒ S e l e c t T[...]

  • Seite 610

    Windows Configuration 40 4 Configuring NetBEUI This de scribes h ow to conf igure Win- dows to use Ne tBEUI. Limita tion ❒ NetBEU I cannot be use d under Windows XP. Note ❒ NetBEUI appears as SMB in the control pa nel, manual, and rel ated utilities. Configuring a Windows 95/98/Me Computer Follow th e procedure below to con- figure a Windows 9 [...]

  • Seite 611

    Configuring NetBEUI 41 4 Configur ing a Windows NT 4. 0 Computer Follow th e procedure below to con- figure a Windows NT 4. 0 computer to use NetBE UI. A A A A Open [ Control Panel ] , and then double-click the Network icon . Make su re [ NetBEUI Protocol ] is listed in the [ Network protoco ls ] box on th e [ Protocols ] tab. Note ❒ If NetBE UI [...]

  • Seite 612

    Windows Configuration 42 4[...]

  • Seite 613

    43 5. Using the Printer Function This section cont ains in structions f or con figuring the m achine a s a netw ork printer. Read th e section th at relates to yo ur network en vironment for informa- tion about correct c onfiguration. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printing with a Windows 2000/XP, Windows Se rver 2003, or Windows NT 4.0 Print Server To set up the[...]

  • Seite 614

    Using the Printer Function 44 5 • Printi ng wi thou t a pri nt se rver Note ❒ Under W indows X P, you c annot pr int via Ne tBEUI us ing SMB. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printing with a Macintosh To set up the machine as a network prin ter in a Macin tosh environment, see p.51 “ Printin g with a Macint osh ” . TCP/IP SMB IPP TCP/IP SMB IPP LPR TCP/IP S[...]

  • Seite 615

    45 5 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printing with NetWare To set up the machine as a print server or remote printer in a NetWare envi- ronment, see p .53 “ Prin ti ng with NetWa re ” . Th e network interface board al- lows you to use the machine as either a print server or a remote print er. • Configuring the machine as a print s erver • Configuring the m[...]

  • Seite 616

    Using the Printer Function 46 5 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printing with UNIX For UNIX printing in formation, visit ou r Web site or c onsult your au thorized dealer. UNIX ABW013S1 TCP/IP[...]

  • Seite 617

    Printing with Windows 47 5 Printing with Windows Printi ng with a Windows 2000/XP , Windows Server 2003 or Windows NT 4.0 Print Server This describes how to configure a cli- ent computer on a network using Windows 2000/XP, Window s Server 2003, Windows NT 4.0 Server or Win- dows NT 4.0 Wo rkstation as a print server. When using a Windows 2000/XP, W[...]

  • Seite 618

    Using the Printer Function 48 5 E E E E On the ne twork tree, double-click the name of t he co mpu ter us ed as the print server. The printers connected t o the net- work are displayed. F F F F Click the name of the printer you want to use, and then click [ OK ] . G G G G Click [ OK ] . H H H H Make sure the port n ame is dis- played in the [ Print[...]

  • Seite 619

    Printing with Windows 49 5 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ NetBEU I Note ❒ Do not use NetB EUI un- der W indows X P. A Click [ NetBEUI ] , and then click [ Sear ch ] . Available printers are l ist- ed. B Click the printer you want to use, and then click [ OK ] . Note ❒ Printers that res pond to a broadcast from the com- puter wi ll be displayed. To print to a [...]

  • Seite 620

    Using the Printer Function 50 5 Stan dard TCP/I P Port A Cli ck [ Standard TCP/IP ] , and then click [ Ne w Port ] . B In t he [ Add Standa rd TCP/IP Print- er Port Wizard ] dialog box, cli ck [ Next ] . C In t he [ Printer Name or IP Address ] box, ent er the print er name or IP address, and then clic k [ Next ] . D In t he [ Add Standa rd TCP/IP [...]

  • Seite 621

    Printing with a Macintosh 51 5 Printing with a Macintosh This des cribes how to con figure a Macinto sh comp uter to us e EtherTalk. Actual pr ocedures ma y vary depending on the version of the Mac O S. The foll owing proce dure s describe h ow to c onfigure Ma c OS 9.1 and Mac OS X v10.1. If you are using othe r versio n than Ma c OS 9.1 and Mac O[...]

  • Seite 622

    Using the Printer Function 52 5 Configur ing the Printer Use the control panel to activate the AppleTalk protocol. (The default is active.) Reference For more in format ion about con - figuration , see p.28 “ Interf ace Set- ting s/Netwo rk ” . Changin g the Printe r Name If th e network ha s several sim ilar model printers, the na mes will be [...]

  • Seite 623

    Printing with NetWare 53 5 Printing with NetWare This describes how to configure the machine for use a s a print server or remote printer in a NetWare environ- ment . This secti on assu mes NetW are is functional and the necessary environ- ment for the NetWare print service is available. Note ❒ NetWare m ust be set to ac tive us- ing the control [...]

  • Seite 624

    Using the Printer Function 54 5 H H H H Select the [ NetWare ] chec k box, and then click [ Next > ] . I I I I Click [ Bindery Mode ] , enter the file server na me in the [ File Server Name: ] box, an d then click [ Ne xt > ] . • In t he [ File Serv er Na me: ] box , en- ter the file server name (up to 47 alphanumeric charac ters) of the se[...]

  • Seite 625

    Printing with NetWare 55 5 F F F F Click [ Wizard ] , and then click [ OK ] . G G G G If necessary, enter the print server name in the [ Device Nam e: ] box, and then click [ Next > ] . H H H H Select the [ NetWare ] chec k box, and then click [ Next > ] . I I I I Click [ NDS Mode: ] , enter the file server na me in the [ File Server Name: ] [...]

  • Seite 626

    Using the Printer Function 56 5 Using P ureIP in t he NetW are 5/5. 1, 6 environ ment Note ❒ When not using IPX, it is recom- mended that you change the print server protocol in the W eb browser from [ TCP/ IP+ IPX ] to [ TCP/IP ] . A A A A Log on to the file server as an ad- ministrator, or equivalent. B B B B Start SmartDeviceMonitor for Admi n[...]

  • Seite 627

    Printing with NetWare 57 5 Note ❒ As co ntext, ob ject na mes are entered in lower object order and div ided b y a period. Fo r exampl e, if you want to cr e- ate a prin t server into NET unde r d, e nte r “ d ” . F In th e [ Pri nt Se rver Oper atio n Mode ] area, click [ As Print Serv- er ] . G Cli ck [ OK ] to close the [ NIB Set- up Tool [...]

  • Seite 628

    Using the Printer Function 58 5 I I I I Enter “ PCONS OLE ” from the co m- mand p rompt . F:> P CONSO LE J J J J Create a print queue as follows: Note ❒ If you are using a currently d e- fined print queue, proceed to step K A On the [ Availabl e Options ] menu, click [ Print Queue Inform ation ] , and then press the { { { { ENTER } } } } k[...]

  • Seite 629

    Printing with NetWare 59 5 M M M M Press the { { { { ESC } } } } key until the “ Ex- it? ” appears, and then click [ Yes ] to qu it PCON SOLE. N N N N Start the print server by entering the fo llowing fr om the N etWare server's keyb oard. If it is runni ng, resta rt after quit - ting . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ To quit CAREE : unloa d pserver ❖ ?[...]

  • Seite 630

    Using the Printer Function 60 5 Limitation ❒ Enter up to 32 alphanumeric characte rs ( “ - ” and “ _ ” can be used). E In the [ NDS Conte xt: ] box , enter the context in which the print server is to be created. Limitation ❒ Enter up to 127 alphanumer- ic characters. F In th e [ Pri nt Se rver Oper atio n Mode ] area, click [ As Remote [...]

  • Seite 631

    Printing with NetWare 61 5 E After checking the settings, click [ OK ] . M M M M Create a print server as follows: A Select t he context s pecified us- ing NIB Setup Tool (Step G G G G - B B B B ), and o n the [ Object ] menu , click [ Create ] . B In the [ Class of new object ] list, click [ Pr int Server ] , and then click [ OK ] . If you are usi[...]

  • Seite 632

    Using the Printer Function 62 5 Reference For more information about in- stalling the printer driver, see Printer Refer ence 1 . Note ❒ Any po rt can be sel ected d uring ins talla tion. Howe ver, L PT1 is recomm ended. B B B B On the [ Sta rt ] menu, point to [ Set- tings ] , and then click [ Pr int ers ] . C C C C In th e [ Printers ] window , [...]

  • Seite 633

    Printing with NetWare 63 5 C C C C Insert the CD-ROM labeled “ Printer Drivers and Utilities ” into the CD-ROM drive, and then click [ Hav e Disk ] . If the setup menu starts automati- cally, y ou can proceed t o the nex t step. If not, see Printer Referen ce 1 . D D D D Follow the instructions on screen to com plete inst allation of the printe[...]

  • Seite 634

    Using the Printer Function 64 5[...]

  • Seite 635

    65 6. Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Client SmartDeviceMonitor for Client SmartDeviceMonito r for Client is equipped with the following functions. We recommend all users of this printe r to install this software. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Protocol Stack Operating sys tem Protocol stack Microsoft Windows 95/98 /Me TCP/IP provided with Windows 95/98 /Me IPX/SPX [...]

  • Seite 636

    Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Client 66 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ What can it d o? • Peer-to-Peer print f unction • Print directly on the netw ork printer without a prin t server. • Print on a substitute printer if too man y jobs accumulate in the specified printer, or if an error di sables printing (Recovery Printing). • Allocate multiple printings[...]

  • Seite 637

    SmartDeviceMonitor for Client 67 6 Reference For more information about using Recovery Printing/Parallel Printing, see SmartDeviceMonitor for Client Help. Setting the Net work Monito ring Function To view the status of machines using SmartDeviceMonitor for Client, you must configure SmartDeviceMonitor for Client in advance, so that it monitors the [...]

  • Seite 638

    Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Client 68 6 Displaying the Stat us of Mach ines Follow the procedure below to monitor machine status using SmartDeviceMon- itor for Client. A A A A Start SmartDeviceMonitor for Client . B B B B The status of machines is d isplayed on th e SmartDeviceMonitor fo r Client icon on the taskbar. Note ❒ For more information [...]

  • Seite 639

    69 7. Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, not only can yo u monitor the status of network pri nters, but you c an also chan ge th e configu ration of the netwo rk in- terface board using TCP/IP or IPX /SPX protoc ol. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Protocol Stack *1 IPX is us ed for moni tori ng the m[...]

  • Seite 640

    Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin 70 7 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ What can it d o? • Limit setting s done from the con trol pan el, a nd dis able c hange s made t o certain items . • Select of paper type loaded in the machine. • Switch to, and com e out of Energy Sa ver mode. • Check information about printing, pape r quantity, etc. • Simultaneousl[...]

  • Seite 641

    SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin 71 7 Changing the Network Interf ace Board Confi guration Limita tion ❒ Internet Explorer 4.01 or a later ver- sion is required to use NIB Setup Tool. A A A A Start Smar tDev iceM onit or f or Ad- min. B B B B On the [ Group ] m enu , poin t to [ Searc h Devi ce ] , and the n click [ TCP/IP ] or [ IPX/SP X ] . A list [...]

  • Seite 642

    Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin 72 7 Locking t he Con trol Panel Menu A A A A Start Smar tDev iceM onit or f or Ad- min. B B B B On the [ Group ] m enu , poin t to [ Searc h Devi ce ] , and the n click [ TCP/IP ] or [ IPX/SP X ] . A list of machines appears. Note ❒ Select the prot ocol of the ma- chine f or whi ch yo u want to change configura[...]

  • Seite 643

    SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin 73 7 Managing U ser I nformatio n A A A A Start Smar tDev iceM onit or f or Ad- min. B B B B On the [ Group ] menu, point to [ Search Devi ce ] , an d then click [ TCP/IP ] or [ IPX/SPX ] . A list of machines appears. Note ❒ Select the prot ocol of the ma- chine f or whi ch yo u want to change configurat ion. C C C C [...]

  • Seite 644

    Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin 74 7 Managing A ddress Infor matio n A A A A Start SmartDeviceMonitor for Admi n. B B B B On the [ Group ] menu, point to [ Search Devi ce ] , an d then click [ TCP/IP ] or [ IPX/SPX ] . A list of machines appears. Note ❒ Select the prot ocol of the ma- chine f or whi ch yo u want to change configurat ion. C C C[...]

  • Seite 645

    75 8. Configuring the Network Interface Board Using a Web Browser You can chec k the status of a m achine and chan ge its settings usin g the Web browser. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ What can it d o? You can remotely check the status of a machine or specify its settings over the network usi ng a comput er's Web brows er. The fol lowi ng func tion s are a [...]

  • Seite 646

    Configuring the Network Interface Board Using a Web Browser 76 8 Going to the Top Page 1. Header area You can reg ister favorite URLs using [ URL ] . To view the Help section, click [ Help ] . 2. Menu area These menus are for configuring the net- work inter face board and checking ma- chine status. 3. Status Displays ma chine sta tus, ne twork inte[...]

  • Seite 647

    Types of Menu Configuration and Mode 77 8 Types of Menu Configurat ion and Mode Items that appear on the menu area d iffer between u ser mode and administr ator mode . The work area whic h appe ars under the selected menu d isplays machine status under user m ode and machi ne status and setti ngs under ad ministrator mode. Note ❒❍ Indicates mac[...]

  • Seite 648

    Configuring the Network Interface Board Using a Web Browser 78 8 *1 You can make the IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 1 394, or parallel interf ace setting s. You can a lso check the Eth ernet status. Reference For more information about displaying statu s and changing settings, see p.81 “ Using Help on the Web Browse r ” . Con figura tion Paper - $ System -[...]

  • Seite 649

    Verifying the Network Interface Board Settings 79 8 Verifying the Network Interface Board Settings A A A A Start the Web br owser. B B B B In th e [ A ddress ] box, enter th e ma- chine' s IP addre ss (for ex ample http:/ /XXX.XX X,XXX,X XX, where the Xs are th e numbers of the IP address ). The sta tus of t he mach ine you chose appears on th[...]

  • Seite 650

    Configuring the Network Interface Board Using a Web Browser 80 8 Configuring the Network Interface Board Settings A A A A Start the Web br owser. B B B B In th e [ A ddress ] box, enter th e ma- chine' s IP addre ss (for ex ample http:/ /XXX.XX X,XXX,X XX, where the Xs are th e numbers of the IP address ). The sta tus of t he mach ine you chos[...]

  • Seite 651

    Using Help on the Web Browser 81 8 Using Help on the Web Browser Whe n usin g Help fo r the fi rst ti me , clicki ng either [ Help ] in the header area or th e icon marked “ ? ” in th e work area makes the following s creen appear. From ther e you can che ck Help in two different ways, as shown below: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Checki ng a Help Us ing the[...]

  • Seite 652

    Configuring the Network Interface Board Using a Web Browser 82 8[...]

  • Seite 653

    83 9. Appendix Remote Maintenance by telnet You can view p rinter status and c on- figure the network interface board us- ing telnet. Note ❒ You shou ld s pecif y a p assw ord so only the network adm inistrator, or a person wi th network admin istra- tor pri vilege s, can us e remote mainte nance. ❒ The passwo rd is th e same as t hat used for [...]

  • Seite 654

    Appendix 84 9 Commands List Use t he “ help ” command to displa y remote maintena nce use. Note ❒ Enter “ help ” to display a lis t of commands that can be used. msh> h elp ❒ Enter “ help command_na me ” to display information about the syn- tax of that command. msh> h elp comman d_name TCP/IP address Use the “ if config ”[...]

  • Seite 655

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 85 9 - - - - Address ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Subnet Mask A number us ed to numerical ly “ mask ” or hide the IP a ddress on the network by eliminating t hose parts of the address that are alike for all machines on the network. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Broadcas t address A specified address for sending data to s pecific devices on th[...]

  • Seite 656

    Appendix 86 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Access control ini tialization msh> acc ess fl ush Note ❒ This restores the factory de fault so all access ranges be come “ 0.0.0.0 ” . DHCP Use the “ dhcp ” command to con fig- ure the DHCP settings. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Reference The fo llo wing c omman d di splays the current DHCP setting s. msh> d hcp ?[...]

  • Seite 657

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 87 9 Note ❒ I f y o u p r o h i b i t r e m o t e a c c e s s v i a TCP/IP and then lo g out, you can- not use re mote access. If you did this by mistake, you can use the control panel to allow access by TCP/IP. ❒ When you prevent access via TCP/IP, you are also prevented from using ip1394, lpr, ftp, rsh, diprint, w[...]

  • Seite 658

    Appendix 88 9 ❒ Default access settings 1 and 2 are as follows: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Display Shows SNMP informat ion and available protocols. msh> snm p ? The followin g command displays the settings of registered number specifi ed. msh> sn mp [ registe red_nu mber ] Omit ting the num ber di spla ys al l access set tings. msh> snm p [-p] Note[...]

  • Seite 659

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 89 9 Note ❒ To specify TCP/IP pr otocol , en- ter “ ip ” followed by a space, and then the I P address. ❒ To specify the IPX/S PX proto- col, enter “ ipx ” followed by a space, and then the IPX add ress followed by a decima l, and then the MAC address of the net- work interface board. The following is a samp[...]

  • Seite 660

    Appendix 90 9 Direct printing port The direct printing port allows print- ing directly fro m a computer, con- nected to the n etwork, to the printer. Use t he “ diprint ” command to change direct printing po rt settings. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ View settin gs The fo llo wing c omman d di splays the current dire ct printing port set- ting s: msh> dip[...]

  • Seite 661

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 91 9 SMB Use the “ smb ” comm and to co nfigu re or delete the NetBEU I settings such as the computer name or workgroup name. msh> sm b para meter Note ❒ You canno t use a comp uter name starting with “ RN P ” or “ rnp ” . ROUTE Use the “ ro ute ” com ma nd to cont rol the routing table. This comman[...]

  • Seite 662

    Appendix 92 9 SPRINT Use the “ sprint ” comma nd to v iew and configure SCSI p rint (SBP-2) on IEEE 1394. Limita tion ❒ You ca n use this func tion when th e optional IEEE 1394 board is in- stalled. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Viewing settings The fo llo wing c omman d di splays the current IEEE 1394 (SCSI print) setting s: msh> spr int ❖ ❖ ❖ ?[...]

  • Seite 663

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 93 9 Note ❒ Wh en c han gin g the in terf ace to IEEE 802.11b, see p.84 “ TCP/IP address ” . ❒ When configuring the IEEE 802.11b TCP/IP , see p.84 “ TCP/IP ad- dress ” . Changing the host name Use the “ hostname ” comman d to change the printer nam e. msh> h ostna me interfac e_nam e printe r_nam e *1[...]

  • Seite 664

    Appendix 94 9 Note ❒ Enter the printer name using up to 15 characte rs. ❒ You cannot u se a printer name starting with “ RN P ” or “ rnp ” . ❒ The Ethernet interface and I EEE 802.11b int erface will have the same printer name. WINS Use the “ wins ” command to config- ure WINS server set tings. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Viewing setting The [...]

  • Seite 665

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 95 9 AutoNet Use the “ autonet ” comma nd to c on- figure AutoNe t settings. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Display The fo llo wing c omman d di splays the current AutoN et settings. msh> aut onet ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Configuration You ca n confi gure t he Aut oNet setting s. msh> auto net in terface _nam e [on|of f] Note ❒ Sel[...]

  • Seite 666

    Appendix 96 9 DNS Use the “ dns ” command to c onfig ure or display DNS (Domain Name Sys- tem) settings . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ View settin g The fo llo wing c omman d di splays current DNS sett ings : msh> d ns ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Using the D NS server obta ined from the DHC P serv er The foll owing c ommand ena - bles/disables use the DNS server obt[...]

  • Seite 667

    Remote Maintenance by telnet 97 9 - - - - Setting Protocols The protoc ols described in this sec- tion provide various funct ions that can b e u sed o n the m ach ine. Important ❒ If a protocol is disabled or inactive, functions provided by that proto- col cannot be used. Reference For more informati on about set- ting protocols, consult your net[...]

  • Seite 668

    Appendix 98 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ SNMP • Bidi rectional communicat ion func- tion usi ng a pri nter driv er • Function to obtain d evice infor- mation us ing SmartDeviceMon- itor for Client/Admin ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ IPP • Printer func tion using S martDe- viceMonitor for Client ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ HTTP • Web browser function • Printer func tion using[...]

  • Seite 669

    Using DHCP 99 9 Using DHCP You can use the printer in a DHCP en- vironment. You can also register the printer N etBIOS name on a WINS server when it is ru nning. If you connect an Ethernet interface and IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394) interface simultaneo usly, pay attention to the following: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When a st atic IP a ddres s is set f or both in[...]

  • Seite 670

    Appendix 100 9 Note ❒ If a static address is not selected, or i s set t o 0.0. 0.0, th e int erface using the addres s assigned by DHC P is used . Note ❒ Printers that register the p rinter NetBIO S name on a WINS serve r mus t be conf igure d for the WINS server. See p.94 “ WINS ” . ❒ Support ed DHCP ser vers: Mi cro- soft DHCP serve r -[...]

  • Seite 671

    SNMP 101 9 SNMP The machine is equ ipped with an SNMP (Simple Network Management Proto- col) agent that operates under UDP and IPX on the Ethernet/wireles s LAN in- terface, and UDP on th e IEEE 1394 ( IP over 1394) in terface. Us ing the SNMP manager yo u can get information about the machin e. The def ault community names are “ publ ic ” and [...]

  • Seite 672

    Appendix 102 9 Error Messages on the Display This sec tion describes the most common netwo rk-related messages that appear on the display. If a message not described here appears, act accordin g to that mess age. Messages witho ut Code Numbers Reference Before turning the main power off, see “ Tur ning On the Po wer ” , Cop y Re fer- ence . Mes[...]

  • Seite 673

    Error Messages on the Display 103 9 Messages with Cod e Numbers Note ❒ A message reporting an error appea rs on the display as shown. Message Causes Solutions Code numbers Cannot connect with DHCP server The DHCP server cannot be found. Check the DHCP s erver is running on the network. 101 201 301 The s ame IP Addr ess alre ady exists The specifi[...]

  • Seite 674

    Appendix 104 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Code Numbers The problem interface is displayed. • 1XX: Ethernet • 2XX: IEEE 802.11b • 3XX: IEEE 1394 • 0XX: Independent of inte rface ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Order of priority of me ssages (when multiple errors occ ur) Order of interface priori ty • 1.Ethernet • 2.IEEE 802.11b • 3.IEEE 1394 Order of prot ocol p[...]

  • Seite 675

    Understanding Displayed Information 105 9 Understanding Displayed Information This section descri bes how to read the status information returned by the net- work interface board. Print J ob In format ion Print job status can be viewed using the following c ommands: • telnet : Use the “ status ” command. Se e p.87 “ Printer stat us ” . Pr[...]

  • Seite 676

    Appendix 106 9 Machine St atus and Configur ation You can ch eck the mach ine status an d configurat ion using telnet or UNIX. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ telnet Use the “ info ” or “ status ” command . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ UNIX Use the “ lpr ” or “ lpstat ” command, or “ stat ” , “ info ” parameter of rsh, rc p, or ftp. Machi ne sta tus Sta[...]

  • Seite 677

    Understanding Displayed Information 107 9 Machin e configuration Note ❒ “ * ” (asterisk) is displayed with the current setting. ❒ Regarding *1-*5, see table below. Misma tch: Paper Size and Type Indicated paper t ray do es not c ontain p aper of selec ted s ize and type. Auto Paper Select cannot d etect selected pap er size an d type. Misma[...]

  • Seite 678

    Appendix 108 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ *1 Input Tray : Name ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ *2 Input Tray : Paper Size ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ *3 Input Tray : Status Output Tray No. ID number of the output tra y Name Name of the output tray *4 Statu s Current status of the output tray *5 Name Descript ion Tray X Name of installed paper tray (X is the number of tray.) Bypass Tray [...]

  • Seite 679

    Understanding Displayed Information 109 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ *4 Output Tray: Name ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ *5 Output Tray: Status Configur ing the Network Int erface Board The network interface board settings can be displayed using the commands be- low. • telnet : Use the “ show ” command. See p.87 “ Network interface board config- uration settings inf[...]

  • Seite 680

    Appendix 110 9 Apple Talk Mod e Apple Talk prot oco l sel ecte d Net Network number Object Macintosh printer name Type The type o f print er Zone Name of zone the printer belongs to TCP/IP Mode “ Up ” me ans activ e, “ Down ” means inactive. ftp lpr rsh teln et diprint web http ftpc snmp ipp auton et EncapType Frame typ e DHCP Dynamic Host [...]

  • Seite 681

    Understanding Displayed Information 111 9 NetW are EncapType Frame typ e RPRINTER num ber Remote printer number Print serve r name Print server name File server name Name of the connect f ile server Context name Context of print ser ver Switch Mode Active mode NDS/Bindery (this value is fixed) Packet negotiation (this value is fixed) Login Mode Pri[...]

  • Seite 682

    Appendix 112 9 *1 You can displa y these item names when i nstalling t he optional 1394 inter face board. *2 ✩ represents a t arget number be tween 1 and 5. *3 You can display the se item names when install ing the optional 802.11b inter face unit. *4 ✩ represents a t arget number be tween 1 and 3. Authentication V alidity or invalidity of the [...]

  • Seite 683

    Message List 113 9 Message List This is a list of messa ges written to the machine's system log. The syste m log can be viewed using the “ syslog ” comm and. System Log Info rmation You can use the following methods to view the system log: • telnet : Use the “ syslog ” command. See p.87 “ System log information ” . Mess age Cause[...]

  • Seite 684

    Appendix 114 9 Change IP address from DHCP Server. The IP address change s when DHCP LEASE is renewed. To a lways assign t he same IP a d- dress, se t a stat ic IP addr ess to th e DHCP serv - er. child process exec error! (p rocess name) The network service failed to star t. Turn the printer off and then on. If this does not work, contact your ser[...]

  • Seite 685

    Message List 115 9 IEEE 802.11 b <Transmis sion mo de> m ode Trans mission mode for IEE E 802.1 1b (Example: current mode is infrastr ucture mod e.) IEEE 80 2.11b [infras tructure] mode (Exam ple: c urren t mode is 802. 11 ad h oc mod e.) IEEE 802.11b [802.1 1 ad h oc] mode (Example: current mode is ad hoc mode.) IEEE 802.11b [ad h oc] mode I[...]

  • Seite 686

    Appendix 116 9 <Interface>: Subnet overlap. Subnet from Netmask and the IP addres s you tri ed to set f or <In terf ace > ov erlap the su bne t of another interface. Set Subnet so it does not overlap with another interface. IPP cancel-job: permission denied. The printer coul d not authenticate the name of the u ser a ttem ptin g to c an[...]

  • Seite 687

    Message List 117 9 permission denied. Job ca ncellation was determined to be unau- thorized after checking the user name and host ad dress (ex cept for ROO T auth orization ). phy release file open failed. A replacement network interface board is re- quired. Contact your sal es or serv ice repre - sentat ives. Print queue <print queue name> c[...]

  • Seite 688

    Appendix 118 9 Snmp over ipx is ready. Communi cation over I PX vi a SNMP i s avai labl e. snmpd start. SNMP s ervice has start ed. starte d. Direct print s ervic e has s tarted. The print server received error <error number> during a ttempt to log in to the net- wor k.Ac ces s to the netw ork was den ied. Ver ify that the print server na me [...]

  • Seite 689

    Message List 119 9 SMTPC: failed to connect smtp server. Failed to connect the SMTP server. This could be be cau se: • There is no c onnection to the network. • The network configuration is inc orrect, so there is no response from the SMTP se rver. • The SMTP server name is incorrect. • The specified SMTP server is incorrect. • There is n[...]

  • Seite 690

    Appendix 120 9 When Using Windows Terminal Service/MetaFrame Operating Environmen t The follo wing combina tions of ope r- ating system and MetaFrame are sup - ported: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Windows NT Server 4. 0 Termin al Serv- er Ed ition • MetaFrame 1.8 SP3/FR1 SP3 • MetaFrame XP 1. 0 SP1/SP2/FR1 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Windows 2000 Server /Advanced Serv-[...]

  • Seite 691

    When Using Windows Terminal Service/MetaFrame 121 9 • When print ing a large number of bitmap images or us ing the serv er in a WAN envi ronmen t over dial-up lines su ch as ISDN, depending on th e data rat e, printing may be disabled or er- ro rs ma y o ccu r. • When using MetaFrame XP 1.0 or lat er vers ions, we reco m- mend configuring [ Cli[...]

  • Seite 692

    Appendix 122 9 Precautions Please pay attention to the follo wing when usin g the netw ork i nterface board. When configuration is n eces- sary, fol low the ap propri ate proce- dures b elow . Connectin g a Dial -Up Ro uter to a Network When using NetWare (file server) If the NetWare file server and pr inter are on opposit e sides of a router, pack[...]

  • Seite 693

    Precautions 123 9 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When a d ial-up router is connec ted in a network envi ronment The settings for the delivery server to b e conn ected mu st be made ap- propriately for the machine with Scan Route r V2 L ite/P rofes siona l, Auto Doc ument Link , or Des kTop- Binder V2 Lite/Pr ofessi onal . In ad- diti on, s et u p conn ecte d devi[...]

  • Seite 694

    Appendix 124 9 • Under Windows 95/98/Me, clear the [ For m feed ] check box on the [ Printer Settings ] tab in the pri nte r properties dialog box . • Under Windows 2000/XP, clear the [ For m feed ] check box on the [ NetWare Settings ] tab in the printer properties dialog box . • Un der Wi ndo ws N T 4.0, clea r the [ Form feed ] check box o[...]

  • Seite 695

    Precautions 125 9 • A n I P a d d r e s s c a n n o t b e u s e d f o r the IPP port name because the IP addres s is us ed for th e SmartDe- vic eMo nito r fo r Cli ent po rt na me. When the IEEE 80211. b interf ace unit (opt ional) Is Insta lled When usin g the wi reless LAN in ter- face on the network, note the follow - ing: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Whe[...]

  • Seite 696

    Appendix 126 9 Specifications *1 The 1394 int erface boa rd suppor ts only TCP/IP . *2 Use the SmartDeviceMo nitor fo r Client p ort. *3 To use IPP u nder Windows XP o r Windows Serv er 2003, use the Standar d IPP port. Note , in Sma rtDe viceM onit or for Cl ient how ever, this po rt doe s not su pport digest access authen tication. *4 Under Windo[...]

  • Seite 697

    127 INDEX A Access Control , 85 access type , 88 AutoNet , 95 , 100 B Bidirectional SCSI print , 30 Broadcast addre ss , 85 C Cha nne l , 31 Commun ication Mod e , 31 Commun ication Sp eed , 31 commun ity name , 88 config uration access type , 88 community name , 88 Netw ork In terface Board co nfigu ration , 109 Web Bro wser , 75 D Delivery Optio [...]

  • Seite 698

    128 GB GB EN USA B683-8640 S SCSI print (SBP-2) , 30 SLP , 91 SmartDeviceM onitor for Client , 124 SMB , 91 SMTP Server , 32 SNMP , 87 , 10 1 specification s , 126 SPRINT , 92 SSID Setti ng , 31 subne t mask , 85 syste m Log , 113 syste m log information , 87 T Teln et , 106 teln et remote main tenance , 83 using , 83 U UNIX , 106 W Web B rowse r ,[...]

  • Seite 699

    Copyri ght © 2003[...]

  • Seite 700

    Network Guide GB GB EN USA B683-8640[...]

  • Seite 701

    PostScript 3 Operating I nstructions Supplement[...]

  • Seite 702

    Introduction This manu al descri bes detail ed instruc tions o n the operatio n and no tes about the use of this m achine. To get m aximum versat ility fro m this mach ine all operators are requested to read this m anual c arefull y and follo w the in structi ons. Plea se keep t his m anual in a handy p lace n ear the ma chine . Important Contents [...]

  • Seite 703

    i TABLE OF CONTENTS How to Read Thi s Manual ........... ......... ......... ......... .......... ......... ......... ....... ......... ... 1 1. PostScri pt 3 Ins tallab le O ptions .. ....... ...... ....... .... ....... ....... ...... ..... ...... ....... ...... ..... ...... ....... ....... .. 3 Setting Up O ptions .. ......... ......... .........[...]

  • Seite 704

    ii[...]

  • Seite 705

    1 How to Read This Manual Symbols In this manual, the following sy mbols are used: R WARNING: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed, could result in death or serious inj ury. R CAUTION: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed,[...]

  • Seite 706

    2[...]

  • Seite 707

    3 1. PostScript 3 Installable Options The following options ar e available: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Input Paper Device •L o w e r P a p e r T r a y Setting Up Options To use installed option s correctly, first set up the p rinter driver. If the options are not recognized, you cannot use them, even though they are p hysically installed. The procedur e to [...]

  • Seite 708

    PostS crip t 3 4 1 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Mac O S You can set up all options using the [ Chooser ] dial og box. Limitatio n ❒ Under Mac OS X , this function is no t available.[...]

  • Seite 709

    Printing a Document 5 1 Printing a Document This section descr ibes how to print documents from an application. Note ❒ The Mac OS X referred to in this section is Mac OS 10.1. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper Source The following ta ble shows where you can select this func tion. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Media Type Use this to select the pap er type. The following ta[...]

  • Seite 710

    PostS crip t 3 6 1 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Collate Use this function to enable collation. With it, the printer can efficiently print collated sets of multiple-page documents. Limitatio n ❒ If you are us ing Windows 2000/XP, Mac OS, or Mac OS X, make sur e the following check box es have not been s elected: • Windows 2000/X P The [ Collated ] che ck box[...]

  • Seite 711

    Printing a Document 7 1 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Toner Saving Use this f unction to reduce the amount of tone r used when p rinting. Limitatio n ❒ When [ Toner Saving ] i s selected, [ Edge Smoothing ] is disabled. Note ❒ This will inc rease the life of the toner, but the output wi ll appear slightl y lighter. The following ta ble shows where you can se[...]

  • Seite 712

    PostS crip t 3 8 1 Windows 20 00 A A A A From an application, click [ Print ] on the [ File ] menu. The [ Pr int ] dialog box appears . B B B B Click the [ Paper/Quality ] tab. C C C C Click [ Adva nced ... ] . The [ Advanced Opt ions ] dialog box appears. D D D D Click [ Print Mode ] to select the function you want to use. E E E E After making the[...]

  • Seite 713

    Printing a Document 9 1 Windows NT 4.0 A A A A From an application, click [ Print ] on the [ File ] menu. The [ Pr int ] dialog box appears . B B B B Select the printer, and then click [ Properties ] . C C C C Click the [ Advanced ] tab. D D D D Fro m [ Document Options ] , click [ Print Mode ] to select the function you want to use. E E E E After [...]

  • Seite 714

    PostS crip t 3 10 1 Printer Utility for Mac By using Prin ter Utility for Mac, you ca n download fon ts, cha nge the printer name, and so on. Limita tion ❒ If the Macint osh and prin ter are connec ted by USB, you can not use Print er Utility for Mac. Note ❒ Printer Utility for Mac is included on the CD-ROM labeled “ Printer Drivers and Utili[...]

  • Seite 715

    Printer Utility for Mac 11 1 Starti ng Printer Utility for Mac This descri bes how to start Printer Utility for Mac. Mac OS Important ❒ Before starting Printer Utility for M ac, make sure the printer is selected in [ Chooser ] on the Apple menu. A A A A Double-click the Printer Utility for Mac icon . The [ Printer Utility for Mac ] dial og box ap[...]

  • Seite 716

    PostS crip t 3 12 1 Printe r Utility for Ma c Functi ons Printer Utility for Mac functions are described below. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Apple menu (Mac O S), Printer Ut ility for Mac m enu (Mac OS X) • [ About Printer Utility for Mac... ] • [ Choose Printer... ] (Mac OS X) Displays the [ C hoose target printer ] dialog box. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ [ File ] men[...]

  • Seite 717

    Printer Utility for Mac 13 1 Downloadin g PS Fo nts You can do wnload the PS fonts to the machine m emory. Important ❒ The following downl oad procedure as sumes you are a s ystem administrator. If you a re not, consult you r system adm inistrat or. ❒ Resetting the mac hine deletes the fonts. ❒ Make sure the machine and Macintosh are connecte[...]

  • Seite 718

    PostS crip t 3 14 1 Deleting Fonts You can de lete font s from machine memory. A A A A On the [ Fi le ] menu, click [ Display Printer's Fonts... ] . The dialog box appea rs. B B B B Select the fonts you want to d elete. Limitatio n ❒ You cannot delete fonts that appear in italics. C C C C Click [ Delete ] . A confirmation message appears. D [...]

  • Seite 719

    Printer Utility for Mac 15 1 Printin g Font Samples You can pr int samples o f fonts that ha ve been downloade d into the m emory. Limita tion ❒ Under Mac OS X, this function is not available. Note ❒ The paper sel ected under [ Page Set up ] is used. A A A A On the [ Fi le ] menu, click [ Print Fonts Sample... ] . B B B B Click [ Print ] . Rena[...]

  • Seite 720

    PostS crip t 3 16 1 Mac OS X A On the [ Pri nter Utility for Mac ] menu, click [ Choose Printer... ] . B In th e [ A vailable Networ k Zones: ] list, clic k the zone for the Macinto sh in use. C In the [ Available Printers: ] list, sel ect the printer whose n ame you changed in step B B B B , and then click [ Choose ] . Restarti ng the Machine You [...]

  • Seite 721

    Printer Utility for Mac 17 1 Selectin g the Zone You can ch ange the zone the machin e belongs to und er Appletalk. Important ❒ Make sure the machine and Macintosh are connected in the Appletalk envi- ronment. A A A A On the [ U tility ] menu, click [ Select Zone... ] . The zone the p rinter belongs to and th e available z one list app ear. B B B[...]

  • Seite 722

    PostS crip t 3 18 1 Launching t he Dialog Consol e You can create and edit PostScr ipt files for printing and downloading to the ma- chine. Important ❒ Because the “ Launch Di alogue Consol e ” is r ecommended for u sers who have a firm grasp of PostScript, you a re advised to take extreme care when us ing it. ❒ Only download PostScript fil[...]

  • Seite 723

    19 INDEX C Collate , 6 D Deleting Fo nts , 14 Disp laying Fon ts , 13 Display ing the Machin e Status , 17 Download ing PostScript Files , 16 Down loadi ng PS Font s , 13 Dupl ex Pr inti ng , 5 E Edge Smooth ing , 6 I Install ing Printer Util ity for Mac , 10 L Launchin g the Dialog Con sole , 18 P Page S etu p , 14 Pap er So urc e , 5 Print er Uti[...]

  • Seite 724

    20 GB GB EN USA B6 83-8680[...]

  • Seite 725

    Copyri ght © 2003[...]

  • Seite 726

    PostSc ript 3 Operati ng Inst ructions Suppl ement GB GB EN USA B683-8680[...]

  • Seite 727

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 80 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.20 0000 mm Operati ng Instruc tions Copy Reference For safety, p lease read this manual carefully bef ore you use this prod uct and keep it handy f or future re fe[...]

  • Seite 728

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 80 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.20 0000 mm In acco rdance wi th IEC 60417, th is machine uses the f ollowi ng symbols for t he main po wer switc h: a a a a mean s P OWE R ON. c c c c means STAN D[...]

  • Seite 729

    i Safety Information When using th is machine, the fol lowing safety precautions shoul d always be fol- lowed. Safety Duri ng Operation In th is manu al, the f ollowing i mportant symbo ls are used : R WARNIN G: R WARNING: Indicates a potentially h azardous situation w hich, if instru ctions are not followed, could result in death or serious injury[...]

  • Seite 730

    ii R CAUT ION: • Protect the machine from dampness or wet wea ther, such as rain and snow. • Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the machine, you should take care that the po wer cord will not be damaged under the m achine.Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. Wh[...]

  • Seite 731

    iii Positi ons of Labels and Hallmarks for R R R R WARNING and R R R R CAUTION This mach ine has labels and hallmarks for R WAR NING, R CAUTION at the positions shown below. For safety, please follo w the instructions and handle the mach ine a s i ndicat ed . The ins ide of the machine becomes ve ry hot. Do not tou ch the insi de. Doing so could re[...]

  • Seite 732

    iv How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e d[...]

  • Seite 733

    v What You Can Do with This Machine Page36 Page33 Page35 GCFM132N Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age v Wednes day, Se ptembe r 12, 200 1 4:03 PM[...]

  • Seite 734

    vi TABLE OF CONTENTS Guid e to C ompon ents .. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ..... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ... 1 Option s ......... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... ...... .... ...... .... ....... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... .... 3 Con trol Pane l .. ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ..[...]

  • Seite 735

    vii Othe r Functi ons .. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ..... 31 User Codes ...... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ...... ..... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ... 31 Auto Star t ......... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ...... ..... ....... .... ....... [...]

  • Seite 736

    viii 6. Specifi catio ns Mainfr ame. .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... 6 3 Docu ment Fee der (AD F) (Opt ion) ... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... . 66 32MB C opier Mem ory U nit (Op tion ) ..... .... ...... ....... .... ...... .... ...[...]

  • Seite 737

    1 Guide to Comp onents 1. Exposur e glass cover Lower the ex posure glass cover over the original placed on the exposure glass f or copyi ng. 2. Document feeder (ADF) (Option) Originals wil l be fed automatical ly. 3. Exposur e glass Pos ition o rigin als h ere fa ce dow n for co pying . See p .10 “ Ori gina ls”. 4. Internal tray Copied paper i[...]

  • Seite 738

    2 8. On indicator This indicator lights up when the opera- tion switch is turned on, and goes off when the switch is turned off. 9. Operation switch Press this switch to turn the power on (the On indicator lights up) . To turn the power off, pr ess this switch a gain (the On indicator g oes off). 10. Contr ol pa nel See p.4 “ Contr ol Pan el ” [...]

  • Seite 739

    3 Optio ns 1. Document f eeder (A DF) Originals wil l be fed automatical ly. Other op tions: • 32MB copier memory unit Increases memory capacity. Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 3 Wednes day, Se ptembe r 12, 200 1 4:03 PM[...]

  • Seite 740

    4 Control Panel ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copi er only ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax and/or printer installed 1. Indicators f or fax mode (Fax in- stalled machine only) See the F acsimile Reference manual. 2. { { { { Facsim ile } } } } key (Fax insta lled ma- chine only) Press to use facsimile f unctions. 3. { { { { Printer } } } } key (Printer installed ma- chine onl[...]

  • Seite 741

    5 9. { { { { OK } } } } key 10. { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key Pre ss to chang e the def ault setting s an d conditions to meet your requirements. See p.51 “ U ser To ols (C opier Featu res ) ” . 11. { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key While entering numbers, press to cancel a number you have entered. While copy- ing, press to stop copying.[...]

  • Seite 742

    6 Panel D ispla y The panel display shows the status of the machine, err or messages, and func tion menu s. Important ❒ Do not apply a strong shock or force of about 30N (about 3kgf) or more to the panel display. Otherwise, the display might be damaged. Note ❒ T h e m a c h i n e i s i n C o p y m o d e w h e n t u r n e d o n . T h i s c a n b[...]

  • Seite 743

    7 1. Basics Turning On t he Powe r To tu rn the machin e on, pr ess the operatio n switch. Note ❒ This m achin e auto matica lly ente rs Ener gy Save r mode or turns it self of f if you do not use the machine for a w hile. See “ 6. Auto Off Ti mer ” in the System Set- tings manual. - - - - Power switch es This machine has two power switches. [...]

  • Seite 744

    Basics 8 1 Starti ng the Machine A A A A Press the operation switch to make the On indicator go on. The display panel will come on. Note ❒ If the power is not turned on when the op eration switch is pressed, check if the main power switc h is on . If of f, turn it on. ❒ During the warm-up period (less than 20 seconds), you can use the Auto Star[...]

  • Seite 745

    Changing Modes 9 1 Changing Modes You can use this machine not onl y as a copi er, but optionall y as a fax machine or a printer as well . Press the { { { { Copy } } } } key to use copy func tions, or press the { { { { Fac- simil e } } } } key to use facsimile functions. If the display shows a mode other than copy mo de, press the { { { { Copy } } [...]

  • Seite 746

    Basics 10 1 Origina ls Sizes a nd Weights of Recommended Originals ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Metric version ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Inch version Non-recommended origin als for the document feeder (ADF) Placing the followi ng originals in the document fee der (ADF) might cause paper misfeeds or damage to the originals. Place these origi nals on the exposure glass. ?[...]

  • Seite 747

    Origin als 11 1 Original Siz es and Scanning Area/Mis sing Image Area ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Exposure glass ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Document feeder (ADF) Limitatio n ❒ Even if y ou correc tly plac e origin als in the d ocument feeder (A DF) or on the exposure glass, margins (about 4mm, 0.2") o n all four si des might not be cop- ied. Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _[...]

  • Seite 748

    Basics 12 1 Copy Paper Recommended Paper Sizes and Ty pes The fol lowin g limi tati ons app ly to each tr ay: *1 Paper wei ght: 80g/m 2 , 20 lb Important ❒ Use of damp or curled paper may cause a misfeed. If a misfeed occurs, try turning over the paper stack in the paper tray. If there is no improvement, change to copy pap er with l ess cur l. Pa[...]

  • Seite 749

    Copy Paper 13 1 Note ❒ Postcards should be fed from the bypass tray. ❒ When prin ting on envel opes, note the follo wing: • Load th e envelope with the copy si de face dow n on the byp ass tray. • Check that envel ope flap is securely fo lded up. • Before loading t he envelope, flatten the leading edge (the side being fed into the machine[...]

  • Seite 750

    Basics 14 1 ❒ Do not use en velopes in the follow ing conditions. • damp • excessiv ely curle d or tw isted • stuck together • damaged in any way • with stamps at tached • with windows, holes, perforations, cutouts or embossing • with me tal clasps, st ring ties or me tal folding bar s • designed to be interlocked • with nicked [...]

  • Seite 751

    Toner 15 1 Toner Handling Toner R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ If you use toner o ther than that r ecommended ty pe, a fault might oc cur. Referenc e If you want t o add toner, see p.43 “ h Changi ng the Toner Cartridge ” . Toner Storage Note ❒ When stor ing toner, the foll owing precautions should always be followe d: • S[...]

  • Seite 752

    Basics 16 1 Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 16 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 753

    17 2. Copying Basi c Procedure A A A A Make sure that the machine is in Copy mode . Note ❒ If not, press the { { { { Copy } } } } key. B B B B If the machine is set for User Code, enter the c ode wi th th e number ke ys, and then pre ss the { { { { OK } } } } key. See p.31 “User Codes”. C C C C Make sure that there are no previ- ous settings [...]

  • Seite 754

    Copying 18 2 - - - - Auto Off The m achin e turn s itself off au tomat- ically after your job is finished, aft er a certai n period of tim e. This fu nction is called “ Auto Off ” . Note ❒ How to exit Auto O ff mode: • Turn on the ope ration switch • Place an original in the docu- ment feeder (ADF) • Lift and l ower the exp osure glass [...]

  • Seite 755

    Placin g Originals 19 2 Placing Or iginals Limitatio n ❒ Place original s after c orrection f lu- id and ink has completely dried. Not taking this precaution could mark the exposur e glass and caus e mark s to b e copi ed. Note ❒ Basicall y, the origin als should be aligned to the rear left corner. H o w e v e r , s o m e c o p y f u n c t i on[...]

  • Seite 756

    Copying 20 2 Loading Origin als in the Document Feeder (ADF) Note ❒ The original mi ght become dirty if it is wr itten w ith a penc il or si milar tools . ❒ Do not place any foreign objects on the docu ment feeder (ADF ) or cov- er it with your hand. Referenc e Regarding originals that the docu- ment feeder (ADF) can handle, see p.10 “ Or igi[...]

  • Seite 757

    Placin g Originals 21 2 C C C C Make sure that "Standard Size" is selected , and t hen pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key . Note ❒ If not, press the 0 or 1 key to sele ct it. D D D D Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select original size, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { Select Pa per Tray } } } [...]

  • Seite 758

    Copying 22 2 C C C C Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select "3. Original Siz e", and t hen pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You c an also enter this mod e by pressing the { { { { R/# } } } } key. D D D D Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select "Custom Size", and t hen press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E[...]

  • Seite 759

    Basic Funct ions 23 2 Basi c Functions Note ❒ You can select functions to be acti- vated when Syst em Re set is tur ned on, when En ergy Saver is turned off, or after t he machine is pow - ered on. See p.54 “ Settings Yo u Can Change with the User Tools ” . ❒ You can change def ault settin gs for basic functio ns. See p.54 “ Se ttings You[...]

  • Seite 760

    Copying 24 2 Selecting Copy Paper You can ma nually sele ct the paper tray for the pap er size you wi sh to use. A A A A Select t he paper tra y or bypass tray by pressing t he { { { { Select Paper Tray } } } } key. Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 24 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 761

    Sort 25 2 Sor t The optiona l 32MB copi er memory uni t is required to us e this function. The m achine can scan y our orig inals into m emory and automa tically sort the co pies . Limitatio n ❒ The maximu m paper length for the sort fu nction is 356 mm. ❒ You cannot use t he bypass tray with th is f unctio n. Note ❒ The maximu m tray cap aci[...]

  • Seite 762

    Copying 26 2 D D D D Enter the number of copy sets with the numb er keys. Note ❒ The maximu m number of sets is 99. You can change the default numb er with “ 1. Max. Copy Q'ty ” i n the cop ier feat ures . See p.54 “ Settings You Can Change with the User Too ls ” . ❒ To change the n umber enter ed, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } [...]

  • Seite 763

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 27 2 Copying from the By pass Tray Use th e bypass tray to copy ont o OHP transparencies, adhesive l abels, trans- lucent paper , postca rds, e nvelop es, and copy paper that cannot be set in the pap er tra y. Note ❒ If you do not use standard size copy pap er, you should enter ver- tical an d horizont al dime nsions[...]

  • Seite 764

    Copying 28 2 Referen ce For deta ils abo ut how to set the copy paper, see p.28 “ When copying onto OHP transparen- cies ” , p.29 “ When copying onto standa rd size pap er ” , p.2 9 “ When copying onto c ustom size co py pa per ” or p.30 “ When copying onto envelope s ” . C C C C Place your originals, and th en pre ss th e { { { { S[...]

  • Seite 765

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 29 2 When copying onto standard size pa per Important ❒ You should specify the size of pa- per to avoid paper mis feeds. Note ❒ The de fau lt copy pap er siz e for the pape r tray and the bypass tr ay is A4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { R/# } } } } key. B B B B Make sure that "Stand[...]

  • Seite 766

    Copying 30 2 D D D D Enter the vertical size of the pape r with the number keys , and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ To change the n umber enter ed, press the { { { { Clear/Sto p } } } } key, and then enter the new number. When copying onto envelopes Note ❒ Set the dire ction of the envel ope to L Referenc e For details about e[...]

  • Seite 767

    Othe r F uncti ons 31 2 Other Functions User Codes When user codes are set, operators mus t enter their user codes b efore the machine can be operated. The ma- chi ne keep s count of the nu mber o f copies made under each user co de. Note ❒ When user co des are set, the ma- chine will prompt you for your user code after the powe r switch is turne[...]

  • Seite 768

    Copying 32 2 Auto Start If you press the { { { { Sta rt } } } } key during the warm-up p eriod, the { { { { Star t } } } } key will blink and your copies will be made as soon as warm-up finishes. A A A A Make any adjustments to copy settings during the warm-up peri- od. B B B B Place your originals. C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Th[...]

  • Seite 769

    Preset Redu ce/Enlarge 33 2 Preset Reduce/Enlarge You ca n select a preset r atio for cop y- ing. Note ❒ You can select one of 5 preset r atios (2 enlargement ratios, 3 reduction ratios) . ❒ You can change the pr eset ratios to other rati os you frequently use. See “ 3. Set Ra tio ” in p.54 “ Copier Fea- tures ” . ❒ You can sele ct a [...]

  • Seite 770

    Copying 34 2 D D D D Place your originals, and th en pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒ When the copy paper size and the original size dif fer, set the origin al size . See p.2 0 “ Placi ng Standard Size Original s ” Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 34 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 771

    Zoom 35 2 Zoom You can chan ge the re product ion ra- tio in 1 % step s. Note ❒ You can change the reproduction ratio fro m 50 – 200%. ❒ You can sele ct a ratio r egardless of the size of an original or copy pa- per. With some rati os, par ts of the image might not be c opied or mar- gins will appear on copies. ❒ You can select a preset rat[...]

  • Seite 772

    Copying 36 2 Combi ne Use this feature to c ombine two orig- inal images onto one page. Limitatio n ❒ The machi ne cannot co py original s diff erent in s ize and direc tion. ❒ You cannot use t he bypass tray with th is f unctio n. Note ❒ A5, 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " K copy paper can- not be co mbined. ❒ The number of originals copi[...]

  • Seite 773

    Combine 37 2 C C C C Sele ct “” with the 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You can specify the orientat ion of orig inals. See “ 5. Orig. Ori en- tation ” in the Copier Features in p.54 “ Settings You Can Change with the User Too ls ” D D D D Pre ss th e { { { { Select Pa per Tray } } } } key to[...]

  • Seite 774

    Copying 38 2 Combination C hart The com bination chart given below shows which mod es can be used together. When you read the char t, please refer to t he following table. The f ollowi ng shows th e combin ation s of functi ons. ✩ means that these modes can be used together . → means that these modes c annot be used together. The mode after you[...]

  • Seite 775

    39 3. Troubleshooting Machine Ope ration Proble ms General Display Machi ne's Condition Problem/Cause Action The machin e instruc ts you to wait. The ma chin e is wa rmin g up. Wai t for the mach ine t o warm- up. Referenc e You can use Auto Start mode d uring the warm-up period. See p .32 “ Auto Start ” . You cannot enter the desire d cop[...]

  • Seite 776

    Troublesh ooting 40 3 Canno t Mak e Cl ear Copi es Pro blem C ause Action Copies appear di rty. The image densit y is too dark. Adjust the image density. See p.23 “ Adjusting Copy Image Densi ty ” . The reverse side of an or iginal image is c opied . The image density is too dark. Adjust the image density. See p.23 “ Adjusting Copy Image Dens[...]

  • Seite 777

    Cannot Mak e Desi red Copi es 41 3 Cannot Mak e Desired C opies Combine Pro blem C ause Action Misfeeds occ ur frequently. Copy paper size setting is not correct . Set the pr oper pap er size. Se e p.47 “ Changing the Paper Size ” or p.27 “ Copying fr om the Bypass Tray ” . You can not combi ne several func tion s. Sele cted func tions can [...]

  • Seite 778

    Troublesh ooting 42 3 h h h h Loading Paper Note ❒ If you want to change the paper size, see p.47 “ Changing the Paper Size ” . Referenc e Regarding pape r types and sizes that can be used, see p.12 “ Copy Paper ” . A A A A Make sure that the paper tray is not being used . B B B B Pull out the paper tray until it stop s. C C C C Push the [...]

  • Seite 779

    h Changing the Tone r Cartridge 43 3 h h h h Changing the Toner Cartridge When h is displa yed, it is time to sup ply tone r. R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ If you use toner o ther than that recom mended, a fault m ight occur. ❒ When adding to ner, do not turn off the power switch. If you do, your settings are cleared. ❒ Alway[...]

  • Seite 780

    Troublesh ooting 44 3 • Hold the new toner cartri dge horizontally, and then shake it 5 or 6 times. • Remove the se al. • Insert t he new tone r cartridg e. • Push the new toner cart ridge in unt il it clicks . • Close the front cover of the mac hine. Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 44 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 781

    h Clearing Mis feeds 45 3 h h h h Clearing Misfee ds R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ When cl earing misfeeds, do not turn off th e power sw itch. If you do, your copy settings are cleared. ❒ T o p r e v e n t m i s f e e d s , d o n o t l e a v e a n y t o r n s c r a p s o f p a p e r w i t h i n t h e m a - chi ne. ❒ If paper mi sfeeds occur repeat[...]

  • Seite 782

    Troublesh ooting 46 3 Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 46 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 783

    Changing the Paper Size 47 3 Changing the Pape r Size Important ❒ Select the p aper size with the user tools, or misfeeds might o ccur. Referenc e For paper sizes, weight, and capac- ity that can be loaded in the tray, see p.12 “ Copy P aper ” . Changin g the Paper Size in t he Paper Tray A A A A Make sure that the paper tray is not being use[...]

  • Seite 784

    Troublesh ooting 48 3 F F F F Square t he paper and l oad it in the tray . Importa nt ❒ Do not stack paper over the lim- it m ark. G G G G Adjus t the side and back fences to the new pa per size. Importa nt ❒ When setting small quantities of copy paper, be careful not to sque eze in th e side fe nce too much or pa per will not be fed prope rly.[...]

  • Seite 785

    Changing the Paper Size 49 3 E E E E If you have selecte d "3. Bypa ss" on step D D D D , select "Standard Size" or "Custom Size", and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Sele ct the desi red pa per si ze. When you have s elected "Custom Size" on step E A Enter the hor izontal size of t he paper wi[...]

  • Seite 786

    Troublesh ooting 50 3 Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 50 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 787

    51 4. User Tools (Copier Features) Accessi ng the User Tool s (Copier Features) This sect ion is for th e key operator s in charge o f this ma chine. Th e user to ols allow you to change or set th e ma- chine's d efault settings. Prep arat ion Always exit the user tool s when you have finished. Referenc e For details about how to access the sy[...]

  • Seite 788

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 52 4 Exitin g the User Tools A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. Note ❒ You can exit th e User Tools mode by pressing the { { { { Cancel } } } } key. ❒ If you wa nt to retur n to the pr e- vious mode, press the { { { { User Tools/Counte r } } } } key. Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P ag[...]

  • Seite 789

    User To ols Menu (Copier Featu res) 53 4 User To ols Menu (Copie r Features) Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 53 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 790

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 54 4 Settings You C an Change wit h the User Tools Referenc e For de tails abo ut how to ac cess the us er tools, see p.51 “ Acce ssing the User Tools ( Copier Features) ” . Copier F eatures Menu Des cription 1. Maximum Copy Quan- tity (1. Max. Copy Q'ty) The maximum copy quantity can be set be tween 1 and 99[...]

  • Seite 791

    Settings You Can Chan ge with the User Tools 55 4 3. Set Ratio Select which Reduce, Enlarge or Input Ratio is shown on the panel display with prio rity when the { { { { Reduce/Enlarge } } } } key is p ressed. Note ❒ Default : • Ratio 1: 65% 8 1 / 2 " × 11" → 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " • Ratio 2: 78% 8 1 / 2 " × 14&quo[...]

  • Seite 792

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 56 4 5. Clear all User Codes (5. Clr All User C odes) You c an clea r all us er cod es. Note ❒ The number of copies made under the old code is added to that made under the ne w user code. ❒ The number of c opies made under the deleted code is also de- leted . 6. Reset All Counter s You can reset each user code&apo[...]

  • Seite 793

    57 5. Remarks Do's and Don'ts R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ Make sure the remaining memory space is 100%, before you unplug the pow- er cord. ❒ While the machine is unplugged, you can neither send nor receive a fax. Referenc e For details, see the Facsimile Reference manual. • When you use this machine for a long time in a confined space [...]

  • Seite 794

    Remarks 58 5 Where to P ut Your Machine Machi ne En viron ment Your machin e's location should be carefully chosen because environment al con- diti ons g reat ly aff ect its pe rfor manc e. Optimum environm ental conditions R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: • Temperature: 10 – 32 ° C (50 – 89. 6 ° F), humidity 54% at 32 ° C, 89.6 ° F • Humid[...]

  • Seite 795

    Where to Put Your Machine 59 5 Power Connect ion R WARNING: R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: • When th e main switch is in the Sta nd-by posi tion, the opti onal anti-c onden- sation heaters are on. In c ase of emergency, un plug the machine's p ower cord. • When you unp lug the power cord, the anti-condensati on heaters turn off. • Make sure the [...]

  • Seite 796

    Remarks 60 5 Access t o Machine Place the machine near the power source, provi ding clearance as shown. 1. Rear : mor e than 1c m (0.4 ") 2. Right: more than 1cm (0.4") 3. Front: more than 75cm (29.6 ") 4. Left: mo re than 1cm (0.4") Note ❒ For information abou t required space w hen options are installed, please con- tact you[...]

  • Seite 797

    Mainta ining Your Machin e 61 5 Maintaining Yo ur Machine If the exposure glass, ex posure glass cover or docume nt feeder (ADF) white sheet is dirty , clean t hem if you find them dirty. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Cleani ng the machine Wipe the machine with a soft, damp cloth. Then wipe it wi th a dry cloth to remo ve the water. Important ❒ Do not use chem[...]

  • Seite 798

    Remarks 62 5 Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 62 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 799

    63 6. Specifications Mainframe ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Confi gura tion: Desktop ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Photosensitivity type: OPC drum ( Φ 30) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Original s canning: One-dimensional solid scanning system through CCD ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy proc ess: Dry elec trostatic transfer system ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Development: Dry two -component magnetic b rush de ve[...]

  • Seite 800

    Specificat ions 64 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy pape r weigh t: • Paper tray (Standard size): 60 – 90g/m 2 (16 – 24 lb.) • Bypass tray: 60 – 1 57g/m 2 (16 – 42 lb.) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Non-repr oduction area: • Leading edge: 3 ± 2 mm, 0.14" ± 0.08" • Trailing edge: 3 ± 2mm, 0.14" ± 0.08" • Left edge: 2 ± 1.5mm, 0.0 [...]

  • Seite 801

    Mai nfr ame 65 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Dimensi ons (W × × × × D × × × × H up to exposure glass): 468 × 450 × 371mm (18. 43 × 17.72 × 14.61 inch ) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Noise Emission *1 : • Sound p ower le vel • Sound pressur e level *2 *1 The abov e measure ments ma de in accordan ce with ISO 777 9 are actual value. *2 It is measured at the po[...]

  • Seite 802

    Specificat ions 66 6 Docume nt Feeder (ADF) (Opt ion) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Mode : • ADF mode ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Origin al size: • A4 L – A5 KL • 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L – 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " KL ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Orig inal wei ght: • 1-s ided or igina ls: 52 – 105g/m 2 (14 – 28 lb.) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Number of o riginals to be [...]

  • Seite 803

    32MB Copier Memor y Unit (Option ) 67 6 32MB Copie r Memory Unit (Optio n) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Memory capacity: 32MB ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Additional function s: Increas ed me mory ca pacity ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Number of o riginals that can b e stored: abo ut 99 pages ITU-T No.4 cha rt Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 67 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4[...]

  • Seite 804

    68 INDEX 32MB Cop ier Memo ry Un it , 3 , 67 A Access to Machine , 60 Adju stin g C opy Im age Den sity , 23 Adjust Orig inal Mode , 54 Auto Off , 18 Auto Start , 32 B Basic Functions , 23 Bypas s Paper T ype , 55 Bypass tray , 2 C Changin g the Pape r Size , 47 Changing the Toner Cartrid ge , 43 Cleari ng Misf eeds , 45 Combin ation Cha rt , 38 Co[...]

  • Seite 805

    69 T Toner , 15 U User Cod es , 31 User Tools , 51 V Ventil ation hole , 1 Z Zoom , 35 Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 69 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 806

    70 MEMO Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 70 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 807

    71 MEMO Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 71 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 808

    72 UE US A B04 5 MEMO Stel laC1a-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 72 Wednes day, S eptembe r 12, 2001 4: 03 PM[...]

  • Seite 809

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 20 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thi ckness / 2 = 0 mm Operat ing Instr uctions System Settings For safet y, please read this manual care fully before you use this prod uct and keep it handy for future reference. Typ[...]

  • Seite 810

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 20 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thi ckness / 2 = 0 mm Note to user s in the Un ited States o f America Notice: This equip ment has been tes ted and fou nd to comply with the li mits for a Class B digital device, pur[...]

  • Seite 811

    i ENER GY ST AR Pr ogra m •L o w P o w e r m o d e This product automatic ally lowers its power co nsumption 15 minutes after the last copy or print job has fi nished. Fax reception and printing is stil l pos- sible in Low Power mode, but if you wish to make copies press th e operation switch f irst. For deta ils about how to c hange the defau lt[...]

  • Seite 812

    ii Specification Recycled Paper In acco rdance wi th the ENERGY S TAR Program , we recom mend use of recy cled paper which i s environmentally friendly. Please contact your sales representa- tive for rec ommende d paper. Copier only Fax or prin ter installed Low P ower mode Power consum ptio n 50 Wh 60 Wh Defau lt interval 15 minutes 15 minutes Rec[...]

  • Seite 813

    iii How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e [...]

  • Seite 814

    iv TABLE OF CONTENTS Manu als f or Thi s Mac hine ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ..... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ... 1 Addit iona l Funct ions Provi ded b y Inter nal O ptions ... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... . 2 Copy Mod e ......... ....... ....... .... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ....... [...]

  • Seite 815

    1 Manuals f or This M achine Thi s is a mu lti-f unct ional ma chine comb ining c opier , printe r and fax fu nctions . A separate manual is provided for each funct ion. Please consult the manual that suits your needs. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ System Settings Provides an overview of the machine. This manual introd uces the functions of the machine. It also [...]

  • Seite 816

    2 Additional Functio ns Provided by Internal Optio ns You can expand the capabili ties of this machine to include fax functions and printer func tions. When you w ant to add a func tion, contact your sales or service representative. Copy Mode In copy m ode you can make basic co pies and also copy usi ng more sophisticated techni ques, suc h as red [...]

  • Seite 817

    3 1. Modes Changing Modes Pre ss the { { { { Copy } } } } , { { { { Facsimile } } } } or { { { { Printer } } } } key to s witch to copy, fax or print er mode r espe ct ively . Limitatio n ❒ You cannot sw itch modes in any of th e following cases: • When scanning in a fax m essage for transmission. • During immediate transmissio n. • When ac[...]

  • Seite 818

    Modes 4 1 Mult i-access You can carry out another job using a different function while the current job is being performe d. This allows y ou to handle your jo bs efficiently regardless of how the machine is being used. For example: • While making copies, the machi ne can send a fax message that has been stored in memory . • You can ma ke cop ie[...]

  • Seite 819

    Multi-acce ss 5 1 ✩ … means that these func tions can be used togeth er. ❍ … means that you can interrupt the current job with function keys to proceed to a subsequent job. → … means th at anoth er job w ill auto matically st art afte r the cur rent job is fin- ished. × … means that yo u must manually s tart another job after the cur[...]

  • Seite 820

    Modes 6 1 Copy Mode Changing to Copy Mode You can always make a copy when the machine is not printing or scan- ning fax data. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Copy } } } } key. The copy display appea rs on the panel display. Referen ce For details, see the Copy Refer- ence m anual. Stell aC1a-EN -SysF_V 4_FM.b ook Pag e 6 We dnesda y, Sept ember 1 2, 20[...]

  • Seite 821

    Facsi mile Mo de 7 1 Facsimile M ode Changing t o Facsimile Mode You ca n always use the machine fo r faxing when you are not using the scanner function. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Facsimi le } } } } key. The fa x disp lay appe ars on t he panel display. Note ❒ The Memory Transmission/Re- ception function is performed automa tically ev en when a[...]

  • Seite 822

    Modes 8 1 Printer Mo de Changing t o Printer Mode Whenever you print fr om applica- tions, you do not have to sw itch to Printer mode. Referenc e For details, see t he Printer Refer- ence ma nual. Prin ti ng The machine can receive a print data while another feature is running. Stell aC1a-EN -SysF_V 4_FM.b ook Pag e 8 We dnesda y, Sept ember 1 2, 2[...]

  • Seite 823

    9 2. User Tools (System Settings) Keys for User T ools (System Set tings) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When the machine has the copier feature only ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When the machine has the printer and/or fax feature 1. { { { { Cancel } } } } key Press to return to the previous menu . 2. Panel d isplay Shows operation status, error messages and functi on menu. 3[...]

  • Seite 824

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 10 2 7. { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key Press to clear th e previously entered copy job settings. 8. { { { { Facsimile } } } } key (Fax installed ma- chine only) Press to use facsimile f unctions. 9. { { { { Copy } } } } key Press to use copy functions. 10. { { { { Printer } } } } key (Printer installed machine only)[...]

  • Seite 825

    Accessi ng the User Tool s (System Set tings) 11 2 Accessi ng the User Tools (System Sett ings) This sect ion is for th e key operator s in charge of this machine. You can change or set th e machine's def ault settings . Prep arat ion After u sing the user tool s, be s ure to retu rn to C opy mo de. The settings ar e not canc eled even if the [...]

  • Seite 826

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 12 2 C C C C Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key until your desi red m enu is disp laye d, an d then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ 1 : Press to go to the next menu. ❒ 0 : Press to go back to the previ- ous menu . Referen ce p.13 “ User Tool s Menu (System Settings) ” D D D D Change the settings by f[...]

  • Seite 827

    User Tool s Menu (System Set tings) 13 2 User T ools Me nu (Sys tem Sett ings) Stell aC1a-EN -SysF_V 4_FM.b ook Pag e 13 W ednesda y, Sep tember 12, 20 01 4:16 P M[...]

  • Seite 828

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 14 2 Settings You C an Change wit h the User Tools Referenc e For details abo ut how to access the user tools, see p.13 “ User Tools Menu (System S ettings) ” . Syste m Settings Menu Des cription 1. Fu nctio n P riori ty You c an spec ify t he mo de (Cop ier or Fax) to be d ispla yed imm edi- ately after the oper[...]

  • Seite 829

    Settings You Can Chan ge with the User Tools 15 2 5. Energ y Saver Level You can sel ect the Energy Save r level. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Level 1 • Power Cons umption: Reduced by about 5% compared to standby mode. • Warm-Up Time: about 5 seconds ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Level 2 • Power Cons umption: Reduced by about 40% compared to standby mode. • Warm-Up T[...]

  • Seite 830

    16 UE US A B04 5 INDEX A AOF(Keep It On.) , 15 Auto Off Timer , 15 C Clear Mo des ke y , 10 Clear/S top key , 9 Contra st , 15 Copy Coun t Display , 14 Copy Mod e , 2 , 6 Curs or keys , 9 E Energy Saver Level , 15 Energy Saver Timer , 14 F Facs imile Mode , 2 , 7 Function Priority , 14 K Keys for User Tools (System Settings) , 9 M Measure ment U ni[...]

  • Seite 831

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 84 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.36 0000 mm Operati ng Instruct ions Copy Refer ence Read this manual carefully before you use this product and keep it h andy for future referenc e. For safety, pl[...]

  • Seite 832

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 84 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.360000 mm In acco rdance w ith IEC 6041 7, th is machine uses the follow ing symbol s for t he main po wer swit ch: a a a a means POWER ON. c c c c means STA ND BY[...]

  • Seite 833

    i Safety Information When using your equip ment, the following safety precaution s should always be followed. Safety Duri ng Operation In th is manu al, the f ollowing i mportant symbo ls are used : R WARNIN G: R WARNING: Indicates a potentially h azardous situation w hich, if instru ctions are not followed, could result in death or serious injury.[...]

  • Seite 834

    ii R CAUT ION: • Protect the equipment from dampness or wet weather, such as rain, snow, and so on. • Unplug the power cord from the wal l outlet before you move the equipment. While moving the equipment, you should take care that the power cord will not be damaged under the equipment. • When you disconnect the power plug from the wall outlet[...]

  • Seite 835

    iii Positi ons of Labels and Hallmarks for R R R R WARNIN G and R R R R CAUT ION This mach ine has labels and hallmarks for R WAR NING, R CAUTION at the positions shown below. For safety, please follo w the instructions and handle the mach ine a s i ndicat ed . The ins ide of the machine becomes ve ry hot. Do not tou ch the insi de. Doing so could [...]

  • Seite 836

    iv How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e d[...]

  • Seite 837

    v Machi ne Types This machin e has two m odels. Typ e 2 machine i s instal led with t he fax uni t as a standard. Type 1 T ype 2 Fax unit Option Stan dard Printer unit Option O ption Stell aC-EN-C opyF_V 4_FM.bo ok Pa ge v We dnesda y, July 4, 2001 11:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 838

    vi What You Can Do with This Machine Stel laC-EN-C opyF_V 4_FM.bo ok Pa ge vi We dnesday , July 4, 20 01 11 :23 AM[...]

  • Seite 839

    vii TABLE OF CONTENTS Guid e to C ompon ents .. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ..... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ... 1 Option s ......... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... ...... .... ...... .... ....... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... .... 3 Con trol Pane l .. ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... .[...]

  • Seite 840

    viii Othe r Functi ons .. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ..... 31 User Codes ...... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ...... ..... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ... 31 Auto Star t ......... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ...... ..... ....... .... .......[...]

  • Seite 841

    ix 6. Specifi catio ns Mainfr ame. .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... 6 5 Docu ment Fee der (AD F) (Optio n for Ty pe 1) . ..... .... ...... ...... ...... ...... .... ... 68 Pape r Tra y Unit (Opt ion) . ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... [...]

  • Seite 842

    x Stell aC-EN-C opyF_V 4_FM.bo ok Pa ge x We dnesda y, July 4, 2001 11:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 843

    1 Guide to Comp onents 1. Exposur e glass cover Lower the ex posure glass cover over the original placed on the exposure glass f or copyi ng. 2. Document feeder (ADF) (Option for Ty pe 1) Originals wil l be fed automatical ly. 3. Exposur e glass Pos ition o rigin als h ere fa ce dow n for co pying . See p .10 “ Ori gina ls”. 4. Internal tray Co[...]

  • Seite 844

    2 8. On indicator This indicator lights up when the opera- tion switch is turned on, and goes off when the switch is turned off. 9. Operation switch Press this switch to turn the power on (the On indicator lights up) . To turn the power off, pr ess this switch a gain (the On indicator g oes off). 10. Co ntrol pane l See p.4 “ Co ntrol Panel ” .[...]

  • Seite 845

    3 Optio ns 1. Document feeder (ADF) (Option for Ty pe 1) Originals wil l be fed automatical ly. 2. Pape r tra y uni t Holds 500 sheets of paper. Other op tions: • 32MB copier memory unit Increases memory capacity. Stell aC-EN-C opyF_V 4_FM.bo ok Pa ge 3 We dnesda y, July 4, 2001 11:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 846

    4 Control Panel ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copi er only ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Fax and/or printer installed 1. Indicators f or fax mode (Fax in- stalled machine only) See the F acsimile Reference manual. 2. { { { { Facsim ile } } } } key (Fax insta lled ma- chine only) Press to use facsimile f unctions. 3. { { { { Prin ter } } } } key (Pri nter installed machine onl[...]

  • Seite 847

    5 11. { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key While entering numbers, press to cancel a number you have entered. While copy- ing, press to stop copying. 12. { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key Press to clear th e previously entered copy job settings. 13. On i n dic ator This indicator lights up when the opera- tion switch is turned on, and goes off when the ope[...]

  • Seite 848

    6 Panel D ispla y The panel display shows the status of the machine, err or messages, and func tion menu s. Important ❒ Do not apply a strong shock or force of about 30N (about 3kgf) or more to the panel display. Otherwise, the display might be damaged. Note ❒ T h e m a c h i n e i s i n C o p y m o d e w h e n t u r n e d o n . T h i s c a n b[...]

  • Seite 849

    7 1. Basics Turning On t he Powe r To tu rn the machin e on, pr ess the operatio n switch. Note ❒ This m achin e auto matica lly ente rs Ener gy Save r mode or turns it self of f if you do not use the machine for a w hile. See “ 6. Auto Off Ti mer ” in the System Set- tings manual. - - - - Power switch es This machine has two power switches. [...]

  • Seite 850

    Basics 8 1 Starti ng the Machine A A A A Press the operation switch to make the On indicator go on. The display panel will come on. Note ❒ If the power is not turned on when the op eration switch is pressed, check if the main power switc h is on . If of f, turn it on. ❒ During the warm-up period (less than 20 seconds), you can use the Auto Star[...]

  • Seite 851

    Changing Modes 9 1 Changing Modes You can use this machine not onl y as a copi er, but optionall y as a fax machine or a printer as well. (T ype 2 machine is installe d with t he fax function as the stan- dard.) Press the { { { { Copy } } } } key to use copy functions, or press the { { { { Facsimile } } } } key to use facsim ile fu nctio ns. If the[...]

  • Seite 852

    Basics 10 1 Origina ls Sizes a nd Weights of Recommended Originals ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Metric version ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Inch version Non-recommended origin als for the document feeder (ADF) Placing the followi ng originals in the document fee der (ADF) might cause paper misfeeds or damage to the originals. Place these origi nals on the exposure glass. ?[...]

  • Seite 853

    Origin als 11 1 Original Siz es and Scanning Area/Mis sing Image Area ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Exposure glass ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Document feeder (ADF) Limitatio n ❒ Even if y ou correc tly plac e origin als in the d ocument feeder (A DF) or on the exposure glass, margins (about 4mm, 0.2") o n all four si des might not be cop- ied. Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4[...]

  • Seite 854

    Basics 12 1 Copy Paper Recommended Paper Sizes and Ty pes The fol lowin g limi tati ons app ly to each tr ay: *1 Paper wei ght: 80g/m 2 , 20 lb *2 Place one sheet at a time. See p.27 “ Copyin g from t he By pass Tr ay ” . Paper sizes P aper weigh t Paper capacit y Paper Tr ay A4 L , A5 K , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L , 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / [...]

  • Seite 855

    Copy Paper 13 1 Important ❒ Use of damp or curled paper may cause a misfeed. If a misfeed occurs, try turning over the paper stack in the paper tray. If there is no improvement, change to copy pap er with l ess cur l. Note ❒ Postcards should be fed from the bypass tray. ❒ When prin ting on envel opes, note the follo wing: • Load envelop es [...]

  • Seite 856

    Basics 14 1 Note ❒ Do not use any of the following kinds of paper o r a misfeed mi ght occur. • Bent, fo lded, or c reased paper • Damp paper • Torn pa per • Slippe ry paper • Perforated pap er • Rough paper • Thin pa per tha t has low stiffn ess • Paper wit h much paper dust on its s urface ❒ If you make c opies on rough grain [...]

  • Seite 857

    Toner 15 1 Toner Handling Toner R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ If you use toner o ther than that r ecommended ty pe, a fault might oc cur. Referenc e If you want t o add toner, see p.44 “ h Changi ng the Toner Cartridge ” . Toner Storage Note ❒ When stor ing toner, the foll owing precautions should always be followe d: • S[...]

  • Seite 858

    Basics 16 1 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 16 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 859

    17 2. Copying Basi c Procedure A A A A Make sure that the machine is in Copy mode . Note ❒ If not, press the { { { { Copy } } } } key. B B B B If the machine is set for User Code, enter the c ode wi th th e number ke ys, and then pre ss the { { { { OK } } } } key. See p.31 “User Codes”. C C C C Make sure that there are no previ- ous settings [...]

  • Seite 860

    Copying 18 2 - - - - Auto Off The m achin e turn s itself off au tomat- ically after your job is finished, aft er a certai n period of tim e. This fu nction is called “ Auto Off ” . Note ❒ How to exit Auto O ff mode: • Turn on the ope ration switch • Place an original in the docu- ment feeder (ADF) • Lift and l ower the exp osure glass [...]

  • Seite 861

    Placin g Originals 19 2 Placing Or iginals Limitatio n ❒ Place original s after c orrection f lu- id and ink has completely dried. Not taking this precaution could mark the exposur e glass and caus e mark s to b e copi ed. Note ❒ Basicall y, the origin als should be aligned to the rear left corner. H o w e v e r , s o m e c o p y f u n c t i on[...]

  • Seite 862

    Copying 20 2 Loading Origin als in the Document Feeder (ADF) Note ❒ The original mi ght become dirty if it is wr itten w ith a penc il or si milar tools . ❒ Do not place any foreign objects on the docu ment feeder (ADF ) or cov- er it with your hand. Referenc e Regarding originals that the docu- ment feeder (ADF) can handle, see p.10 “ Or igi[...]

  • Seite 863

    Placin g Originals 21 2 C C C C Make sure that "Standard Size" is selected , and t hen pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key . Note ❒ If not, press the 0 or 1 key to sele ct it. D D D D Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select original size, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { Select Pa per Tray } } } [...]

  • Seite 864

    Copying 22 2 C C C C Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select "3. Original Siz e", and t hen pres s the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You c an also enter this mod e by pressing the { { { { R/# } } } } key. D D D D Pre ss th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to select "Custom Size", and t hen press the { { { { OK } } } } key. E E E[...]

  • Seite 865

    Basic Funct ions 23 2 Basi c Functions Note ❒ You can select functions to be acti- vated when Syst em Re set is tur ned on, when En ergy Saver is turned off, or after t he machine is pow - ered on. See p.56 “ Settings Yo u Can Change with the User Tools ” . ❒ You can change def ault settin gs for basic functio ns. See p.56 “ Se ttings You[...]

  • Seite 866

    Copying 24 2 Selecting Copy Paper You can ma nually sele ct the paper tray for the pap er size you wi sh to use. A A A A Select t he paper tra y or bypass tray by pressing t he { { { { Select Paper Tray } } } } key. Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 24 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 867

    Sort 25 2 Sor t The optiona l 32MB copi er memory uni t is required to us e this function. The m achine can scan y our orig inals into m emory and automa tically sort the co pies . Limitatio n ❒ The maximu m paper length for the sort fu nction is 356 mm. Note ❒ The maximu m tray cap acity is as follows. When the number of cop- ies exceeds the t[...]

  • Seite 868

    Copying 26 2 D D D D Enter the number of copy sets with the numb er keys. Note ❒ The maximu m number of sets is 99. You can change the default numb er with “ 1. Max. Copy Q'ty ” i n the cop ier feat ures . See p.56 “ Settings You Can Change with the User Too ls ” . ❒ To change the n umber enter ed, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } [...]

  • Seite 869

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 27 2 Copying from the By pass Tray Use th e bypass tray to copy ont o OHP transparencies, adhesive l abels, trans- lucent paper , postca rds, e nvelop es, and copy paper that cannot be set in the pap er tra y. Note ❒ If you do not use standard size copy pap er, you should enter ver- tical an d horizont al dime nsions[...]

  • Seite 870

    Copying 28 2 Note ❒ Set the dir ection of the co py pa- per to L . ❒ Swing out the exten der to sup- port pap er sizes la rger than A4 L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L . ❒ Fan paper to get air between the sheets and avoid a multi-sheet feed. Referen ce For deta ils abo ut how to set the copy paper, see p.28 “ When copying onto OHP transpare[...]

  • Seite 871

    Copying f rom the Bypass Tray 29 2 F F F F Gently insert the OH P transpar- encies face down and adjust the pape r gui de. Importa nt ❒ The side of OHP transparencies t h a t i s c o p i e d i s f i x e d . B e f o r e you place the OHP transparen- cies in the byp ass tray, c heck the cutting position of the OHP transparencies. When copying onto [...]

  • Seite 872

    Copying 30 2 C C C C Enter the horizontal size of the pape r wit h the nu mber keys , and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ To change the n umber enter ed, press the { { { { Clear/Sto p } } } } key, and then enter the new number. D D D D Enter the vertical size of the pape r with the number keys , and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } }[...]

  • Seite 873

    Othe r F uncti ons 31 2 Other Functions User Codes When user codes are set, operators mus t enter their user codes b efore the machine can be operated. The ma- chi ne keep s count of the nu mber o f copies made under each user co de. Note ❒ When user co des are set, the ma- chine will prompt you for your user code after the powe r switch is turne[...]

  • Seite 874

    Copying 32 2 Preset Reduce/Enlarge You ca n select a preset r atio for cop y- ing. Note ❒ You can select one of 5 preset r atios (2 enlargement ratios, 3 reduction ratios) . ❒ You can change the pr eset ratios to other rati os you frequently use. See “ 3. Set Ra tio ” in p.56 “ Copier Fea- tures ” . ❒ You can sele ct a ratio r egardle[...]

  • Seite 875

    Preset Redu ce/Enlarge 33 2 D D D D Place your originals, and th en pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒ When the copy paper size and the original size dif fer, set the origin al size . See p.2 0 “ Placi ng Standard Size Original s ” Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 33 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 876

    Copying 34 2 Zoom You can chan ge the re product ion ra- tio in 1 % step s. Note ❒ You can change the reproduction ratio fro m 50 – 200%. ❒ You can sele ct a ratio r egardless of the size of an original or copy pa- per. With some rati os, par ts of the image might not be c opied or mar- gins will appear on copies. ❒ You can select a preset [...]

  • Seite 877

    Combine 35 2 Combi ne Use this feature to c ombine two orig- inal images onto one page. Limitatio n ❒ The machi ne cannot co py original s diff erent in s ize and direc tion. Note ❒ A5, 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " K copy paper can- not be co mbined. ❒ The number of originals copied (combined) can be 2. ❒ In this mode , the machine sele[...]

  • Seite 878

    Copying 36 2 C C C C Sele ct “” with the 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key, and then press the { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ You can specify the orientat ion of orig inals. See “ 5. Orig. Ori en- tation ” in the Copier Features in p.56 “ Settings You Can Change with the User Too ls ” D D D D Pre ss th e { { { { Select Pa per Tray } } } } key to[...]

  • Seite 879

    Combinat ion Chart 37 2 Combination C hart The com bination chart given below shows which mod es can be used together. When you read the char t, please refer to t he following table. The f ollowi ng shows th e combin ation s of functi ons. ✩ means that these modes can be used toge ther. → means that these mod es cannot be used together. The mod[...]

  • Seite 880

    Copying 38 2 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 38 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 881

    39 3. Troubleshooting Machine Ope ration Proble ms General Display Machi ne's Condition Problem/Cause Action The machin e instruc ts you to wait. The ma chin e is wa rmin g up. Wai t for the mach ine t o warm- up. Referenc e You can use Auto Start mode d uring the warm-up period. See p .31 “ Auto Start ” . You cannot enter the desire d cop[...]

  • Seite 882

    Troublesh ooting 40 3 Canno t Mak e Cl ear Copi es Pro blem C ause Action Copies appear di rty. The image densit y is too dark. Adjust the image density. See p.23 “ Adjusting Copy Image Densi ty ” . The reverse side of an or iginal image is c opied . The image density is too dark. Adjust the image density. See p.23 “ Adjusting Copy Image Dens[...]

  • Seite 883

    Cannot Mak e Desi red Copi es 41 3 Cannot Mak e Desired C opies Combine Pro blem C ause Action Misfeeds occ ur frequently. Copy paper size setting is not correct . Set the pr oper pap er size. Se e p.48 “ Changing the Paper Size ” or p.27 “ Copying fr om the Bypass Tray ” . You can not combi ne several func tion s. Sele cted func tions can [...]

  • Seite 884

    Troublesh ooting 42 3 h h h h Loading Paper Note ❒ If you want to change the paper size, see p.48 “ Changing the Paper Size ” . Referenc e Regarding pape r types and sizes that can be used, see p.12 “ Copy Paper ” . A A A A Make sure that the paper tray is not being used . B B B B Pull out the paper tray until it stops. C C C C Push the m[...]

  • Seite 885

    h Loading Paper 43 3 Note ❒ Shuffle the paper before loadin g it in the tray . ❒ If the paper i s curl ed, load t he paper up side do wn. E E E E Readjust the back fen ce and side fences. Importa nt ❒ Whe n load ing sm all qu anti ties of copy paper, be ca reful not t o sque eze in th e side fe nce too much or pa per will not be fed prope rly[...]

  • Seite 886

    Troublesh ooting 44 3 h h h h Changing the Toner Cartridge When h is displa yed, it is time to sup ply tone r. R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ If you use toner o ther than that recom mended, a fault m ight occur. ❒ When adding to ner, do not turn off the power switch. If you do, your settings are cleared. ❒ Always add toner aft[...]

  • Seite 887

    h Changing the Tone r Cartridge 45 3 • Press the Toner Cartri dge backwar d to raise its head, and then gently pull out the bottle. • Hold the ne w bottle horizontally, an d then shake it 5 or 6 times. Note ❒ Do not remove the bl ack cap when shak ing . • Remove the black cap. Note ❒ Do not remove the inner cap. • Put the Toner Cart rid[...]

  • Seite 888

    Troublesh ooting 46 3 h h h h Clearing Misfee ds R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ When cl earing misfeeds, do not turn off th e power sw itch. If you do, your copy settings are cleared. ❒ T o p r e v e n t m i s f e e d s , d o n o t l e a v e a n y t o r n s c r a p s o f p a p e r w i t h i n t h e m a - chi ne. ❒ If paper mi sfeeds occur repeated l[...]

  • Seite 889

    h Clearing Mis feeds 47 3 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 47 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 890

    Troublesh ooting 48 3 Changing the Pape r Size Important ❒ Select the p aper size with the user tools, or misfeeds might o ccur. Referenc e For paper sizes, weight, and capac- ity that can be loaded in each tray, see p.12 “ Copy P aper ” . Changin g the Paper Size in t he Paper Tray A A A A Make sure that the paper tray is not being used . B [...]

  • Seite 891

    Changing the Paper Size 49 3 F F F F Square t he paper and l oad it in the tray . Importa nt ❒ Do not stack paper over the lim- it m ark. G G G G Adjus t the side and back fences to the new pa per size. Importa nt ❒ When setting small quantities of copy paper, be careful not to sque eze in th e side fe nce too much or pa per will not be fed pro[...]

  • Seite 892

    Troublesh ooting 50 3 D D D D While pressing the relea se lever, adjust the side fences . E E E E Push the met al pla te down, and then square the paper and load it in the tray. Importa nt ❒ Do not stack paper over the lim- it m ark. ❒ Load paper so that the paper touche s the right side of the tray, or misfeeds might occur. Note ❒ Shuffle th[...]

  • Seite 893

    Changing the Paper Size 51 3 Sele cting the Paper Size with the User Tools A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. B B B B Pres s th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key to display "2.Syste m Settings", and then pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C Pres s th e 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 key until "8. Tray Paper Size" is [...]

  • Seite 894

    Troublesh ooting 52 3 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 52 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 895

    53 4. User Tools (Copier Features) Accessi ng the User Tool s (Copier Features) This sect ion is for th e key operator s in charge o f this ma chine. Th e user to ols allow you to change or set th e ma- chine's d efault settings. Prep arat ion Always exit the user tool s when you have finished. Referenc e For details about how to access the sy[...]

  • Seite 896

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 54 4 Exitin g the User Tools A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User Tools/ Counter } } } } key. Note ❒ You can exit th e User Tools mode by pressing the { { { { Cancel } } } } key. ❒ If you wa nt to retur n to the pr e- viou s mod e (c opy or fac simil e), press the { { { { User Tools /Counter } } } } key. Stel laC-EN -[...]

  • Seite 897

    User To ols Menu (Copier Featu res) 55 4 User To ols Menu (Copie r Features) Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 55 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 898

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 56 4 Settings You C an Change wit h the User Tools Referenc e For de tails abo ut how to ac cess the us er tools, see p.53 “ Acce ssing the User Tools ( Copier Features) ” . Copier F eatures Menu Des cription 1. Maximum Copy Quan- tity (1. Max. Copy Q'ty) The maximum copy quantity can be set be tween 1 and 99[...]

  • Seite 899

    Settings You Can Chan ge with the User Tools 57 4 3. Set Ratio Select which Reduce, Enlarge or Input Ratio is shown on the panel display with prio rity when the { { { { Reduce/Enlarge } } } } key is p ressed. Note ❒ Default : • Ratio 1: 65% 8 1 / 2 " × 11" → 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " • Ratio 2: 78% 8 1 / 2 " × 14&quo[...]

  • Seite 900

    User Tools (Co pier Featur es) 58 4 5. Clear all User Codes (5. Clr All User C odes) You c an clea r all us er cod es. Note ❒ The number of copies made under the old code is added to that made under the ne w user code. ❒ The number of c opies made under the deleted code is also de- leted . 6. Reset All Counter s You can reset each user code&apo[...]

  • Seite 901

    59 5. Remarks Do's and Don'ts R CAUTIO N: Important ❒ Make sure the remaining memory space is 100%, before you unplug the pow- er cord. ❒ While the machine is unplugged, you can neither send nor receive a fax. Referenc e For details, see the Facsimile Reference manual. • When you use this machine for a long time in a confined space [...]

  • Seite 902

    Remarks 60 5 Where to P ut Your Machine Machi ne En viron ment Your machin e's location should be carefully chosen because environment al con- diti ons g reat ly aff ect its pe rfor manc e. Optimum environm ental conditions R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: R CAUTIO N: • Temperature: 10 – 32 ° C (50 – 89. 6 ° F), humidity 54% at 32 ° C, 89.6 °[...]

  • Seite 903

    Where to Put Your Machine 61 5 Power Connect ion R WARNING: R WARNING: R CAUTIO N: • When th e main switch is in the Sta nd-by posi tion, the opti onal anti-c onden- sation heaters are on. In c ase of emergency, un plug the machine's p ower cord. • When you unp lug the power cord, the anti-condensati on heaters turn off. • Make sure the [...]

  • Seite 904

    Remarks 62 5 Access t o Machine Place the machine near the power source, provi ding clearance as shown. 1. Rear : mor e than 1c m (0.4 ") 2. Right: more than 1cm (0.4") 3. Front: more than 75cm (29.6") 4. Left: more than 1cm (0.4 ") Note ❒ For information abou t required space w hen options are installed, please con- tact your[...]

  • Seite 905

    Mainta ining Your Machin e 63 5 Maintaining Yo ur Machine If the exposure glass, ex posure glass cover or docume nt feeder (ADF) white sheet is dirty , clean t hem if you find them dirty. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Cleani ng the machine Wipe the machine with a soft, damp cloth. Then wipe it wi th a dry cloth to remo ve the water. Important ❒ Do not use chem[...]

  • Seite 906

    Remarks 64 5 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 64 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 907

    65 6. Specifications Mainframe ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Confi gura tion: Desktop ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Photosensitivity type: OPC drum ( Φ 30) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Original s canning: One-dimensional solid scanning system through CCD ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy proc ess: Dry elec trostatic transfer system ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Development: Dry two -component magnetic b rush de ve[...]

  • Seite 908

    Specificat ions 66 6 • Bypass tray (cus tom size ): Vertical : 90 – 216mm, 3.5" – 8.5" Horizontal: 140 – 3 56mm, 5 .5" – 14" • Paper tra y unit: A4 L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 14" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L ❖ ❖ ❖ ?[...]

  • Seite 909

    Mai nfr ame 67 6 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Power co nsumptio n: *1 Mainframe with the optional doc ument feeder (ADF), paper tray unit. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Dimensi ons (W × × × × D × × × × H up to exposure glass): • Type 1: 468 × 450 × 371mm (18.43 × 17.72 × 14.61 inch) • Type 2: 468 × 450 × 461mm (18.43 × 17.72 × 18.15 inch) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ [...]

  • Seite 910

    Specificat ions 68 6 Document Feeder (ADF) (Option for Type 1) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Mode : • ADF mode ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Origin al size: • A4 L – A5 KL • 8 1 / 2 " × 14" L – 5 1 / 2 " × 8 1 / 2 " KL ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Orig inal wei ght: • 1-s ided or igina ls: 52 – 105g/m 2 (14 – 28 lb.) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Number of o rigina[...]

  • Seite 911

    Paper Tray Uni t (Option ) 69 6 Paper Tray U nit (Option) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy pape r weigh t: 60 – 90g/m 2 (16 – 24 lb .) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Available paper size: A4 L , 8 1 / 2 " × 14 " L , 8 1 / 2 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 14" L , 8 1 / 4 " × 13" L , 8 1 / 2 " × 11" L ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Maximum [...]

  • Seite 912

    Specificat ions 70 6 32MB Copie r Memory Unit (Optio n) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Memory capacity: 32MB ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Additional function s: Increas ed me mory ca pacity ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Number of o riginals that can b e stored: abo ut 99 pages ITU-T No.4 cha rt Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 70 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 913

    71 INDEX 32MB Cop ier Memo ry Un it , 3 , 70 A Access to Machine , 62 Adju stin g C opy Im age Den sity , 23 Adjust Orig inal Mode , 56 Auto Off , 18 Auto Start , 31 B Basic Functions , 23 Bypas s Paper T ype , 57 Bypass tray , 2 C Changin g the Pape r Size , 48 Changing the Toner Cartrid ge , 44 Cleari ng Misf eeds , 46 Combin ation Cha rt , 37 Co[...]

  • Seite 914

    72 T Toner , 15 U User Cod es , 31 User Tools , 53 V Ventil ation hole , 1 Z Zoom , 34 Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 72 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 915

    73 MEMO Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 73 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 916

    74 UE US A B04 5 MEMO Stel laC-EN -CopyF _V4_FM. book P age 74 Wednes day, Ju ly 4, 2 001 1 1:23 AM[...]

  • Seite 917

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 24 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thi ckness / 2 = 0 mm Operat ing Instr uctions System Settings Read th is manua l careful ly before you us e this p roduct and keep it handy f or futur e referenc e. For safety, pleas[...]

  • Seite 918

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 24 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Paper thi ckness / 2 = 0 mm Note to user s in the Un ited States o f America Notice: This equip ment has been tes ted and fou nd to comply with the li mits for a Class B digital device, pur[...]

  • Seite 919

    i ENER GY ST AR Pr ogra m •L o w P o w e r m o d e This product automatic ally lowers its power co nsumption 15 minutes after the last copy or print job has fi nished. Fax reception and printing is stil l pos- sible in Low Power mode, but if you wish to make copies press th e operation switch f irst. For deta ils about how to c hange the defau lt[...]

  • Seite 920

    ii Specification Recycled Paper In acco rdance wi th the ENERGY S TAR Program , we recom mend use of recy cled pape r which is environmen t friendly. Please c ontact your sales represen tative for re comm ended pa per. Copier only Fax or prin ter installed Low P ower mode Power consum ptio n 50 Wh 60 Wh Defaul t inter val 15 minutes 15 minutes Reco[...]

  • Seite 921

    iii How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol ind icates a potentially hazardous situation that migh t result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e [...]

  • Seite 922

    iv TABLE OF CONTENTS Manu als f or Thi s Mac hine ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ..... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ... 1 Machi ne Typ es .... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... . 2 Addit iona l Funct ions Provi ded b y Inter nal O ptions ... ...... .... ...... ..[...]

  • Seite 923

    1 Manuals f or This M achine Thi s is a mu lti-f unct ional ma chine comb ining c opier , printe r and fax fu nctions . A separate manual is provided for each funct ion. Please consult the manual that suits your needs. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ System Settings Provides an overview of the machine. This manual introd uces the functions of the machine. It also [...]

  • Seite 924

    2 Machi ne Types This machin e has two m odels. Typ e 2 machine i s instal led with t he fax uni t as a standard. Type 1 T ype 2 Fax unit Option Stan dard Printer unit Option O ption Stell a-EN -SysF_ V4_FM .boo k Page 2 Wednesd ay, Ju ly 4, 20 01 1:2 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 925

    3 Additional Functio ns Provided by Internal Optio ns You can expand the capabili ties of this machine to include fax functions and printer func tions. When you w ant to add a func tion, contact your sales or service representative. Copy Mode In copy m ode you can make basic co pies and also copy usi ng more sophisticated techni ques, suc h as red [...]

  • Seite 926

    4 Stell a-EN -SysF_ V4_FM .boo k Page 4 Wednesd ay, Ju ly 4, 20 01 1:2 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 927

    5 1. Modes Changing Modes Pre ss the { { { { Copy } } } } , { { { { Facsimile } } } } or { { { { Printer } } } } key to s witch to copy, fax or print er mode r espe ct ively . Limitatio n ❒ You cannot sw itch modes in any of th e following cases: • When scanning in a fax m essage for transmission. • During immediate transmissio n. • When ac[...]

  • Seite 928

    Modes 6 1 Mult i-access You can carry out another job using a different function while the current job is being performe d. This allows y ou to handle your jo bs efficiently regardless of how the machine is being used. For example: • While making copies, the machi ne can send a fax message that has been stored in memory . • You can ma ke cop ie[...]

  • Seite 929

    Multi-acce ss 7 1 ✩ … means that these func tions can be used togeth er. ❍ … means that you can interrupt the current job with function keys to proceed to a subsequent job. → … means th at anoth er job w ill auto matically st art afte r the cur rent job is fin- ished. × … means that yo u must manually s tart another job after the cur[...]

  • Seite 930

    Modes 8 1 Copy Mode Changing to Copy Mode You can always make a copy when the machine is not printing or scan- ning fax data. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Copy } } } } key. The copy display appea rs on the panel display. Referen ce For details, see the Copy Refer- ence m anual. Stell a-EN -SysF_ V4_FM .boo k Page 8 Wednesd ay, Ju ly 4, 20 01 1:2 9 P[...]

  • Seite 931

    Facsi mile Mo de 9 1 Facsimile M ode Changing t o Facsimile Mode You ca n always use the machine fo r faxing when you are not using the scanner function. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Facsimi le } } } } key. The fa x disp lay appe ars on t he panel display. Note ❒ The Memory Transmission/Re- ception function is performed automa tically ev en when a[...]

  • Seite 932

    Modes 10 1 Printer Mo de Changing t o Printer Mode Whenever you print fr om applica- tions, you do not have to sw itch to Printer mode. Referenc e For details, see t he Printer Refer- ence ma nual. Prin ti ng The machine can receive a print data while another feature is running. Stel la-EN-Sy sF_V4 _FM.book Pag e 10 We dnesda y, July 4, 20 01 1:2 9[...]

  • Seite 933

    11 2. User Tools (System Settings) Keys for User T ools (System Set tings) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When the machine has the copier feature only ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ When the machine has the printer and/or fax feature 1. { { { { Cancel } } } } key Press to return to the previous menu . 2. Panel d isplay Shows operation status, error messages and functi on menu. [...]

  • Seite 934

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 12 2 9. { { { { Copy } } } } key Press to use copy functions. 10. { { { { Printer } } } } key (Printer installed machine only) Press to use printer functions. 11. Numbe r k eys Use to enter a numeric value. 12. { { { { Start } } } } key Press to start copying o r faxing. 13. Oper ation swi tch Press this sw itch to t[...]

  • Seite 935

    Accessi ng the User Tool s (System Set tings) 13 2 Accessi ng the User Tools (System Sett ings) This sect ion is for th e key operator s in charge of this machine. You can change or set th e machine's def ault settings . Prep arat ion After u sing the user tool s, be s ure to retu rn to C opy mo de. The settings ar e not canc eled even if the [...]

  • Seite 936

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 14 2 *1 *1 Displays when the optional paper t r a y u n i t i s e q u i p p e d w i t h y o u r machine. Note ❒ 1 : Press to go to the next menu. ❒ 0 : Press to go back to the previ- ous menu . Referen ce p.15 “ User Tool s Menu (System Settings) ” D D D D Change the settings by following the instructions on [...]

  • Seite 937

    User Tool s Menu (System Set tings) 15 2 User T ools Me nu (Sys tem Sett ings) *1 Displays when the optional paper tray unit is equipped with your mach ine. Stel la-EN-Sy sF_V4 _FM.book Pag e 15 We dnesda y, July 4, 20 01 1:2 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 938

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 16 2 Settings Yo u Can Change with the U ser Tools Referenc e For details abo ut how to access the user tools, see p.15 “ User Tools Menu (System S ettings) ” . Syste m Settings Menu Des cription 1. Fu nctio n P riori ty You c an spec ify t he mo de (Cop ier or Fax) to be d ispla yed imm edi- ately after the oper[...]

  • Seite 939

    Settings You Can Chan ge with the User Tools 17 2 5. Energ y Saver Level You can sel ect the Energy Save r level. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Level 1 • Power Cons umption: Reduced by about 5% compared to standby mode. • Warm-Up Time: about 5 seconds ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Level 2 • Power Cons umption: Reduced by about 40% compared to standby mode. • Warm-Up T[...]

  • Seite 940

    User Tool s (Syst em Setti ngs) 18 2 9. Pap.Tray P riority (for Copy mode only) When the opt ional pap er tray unit is equ ipped with you r machin e, you c an se lect a defa ult pap er tr ay in the fol lowin g co nditio ns: • When the operation switch is turne d on. • When the { { { { Clea r Mod es } } } } key is pressed. • When the Copy Rese[...]

  • Seite 941

    19 INDEX A AOF(Keep It On.) , 17 Auto Off Timer , 17 Auto Tray Swi tch , 18 C Clear Mo des ke y , 11 Clear/S top key , 11 Contra st , 18 Copy Coun t Display , 16 Copy Mod e , 3 , 8 Curs or keys , 11 E Energy Saver Level , 17 Energy Saver Timer , 16 F Facs imile Mode , 3 , 9 Function Priority , 16 K Keys for Us er Tools (System Settings) , 11 M Meas[...]

  • Seite 942

    20 UE US A B04 5 MEMO Stel la-EN-Sy sF_V4 _FM.book Pag e 20 We dnesda y, July 4, 20 01 1:2 9 PM[...]

  • Seite 943

    Operating I nstructions Facsimil e Reference <Basic Features> Read this manual carefully before you use this product and keep it handy for future reference. For safety, p lease follow th e instructions i n this manua l.[...]

  • Seite 944

    i NOTICE R CAUT ION: Use of co ntrol s, adjus tmen ts or perf orman ce of pr ocedure s oth er than th ose specified herein may resul t in hazardous radiation exposure. Shie lde d in terc onne ct cabl es mu st be empl oye d wit h thi s eq uipm ent to en sure complianc e with the per tinent RF em ission limits g overning this devic e. Note to users i[...]

  • Seite 945

    ii Note to users in Canada - - - - Note: This Class B digital ap paratus complies with Canad ian ICES-003. Remarque conce rnant les u tilisateurs au Canada - - - - Avertissement: Cet appareil num é rique de la c lasse B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Can- ada. - - - - Notice abou t the Telephon e Consumer P rotection Act ( Valid in USA only).[...]

  • Seite 946

    iii Important Safet y Instruc tions Caution When usi ng your telephon e equipment, bas ic safety prec autions should always b e f o l l o w e d t o r e d u c e t h e r i s k o f f i r e , e l e c t r i c s h o c k a n d i n j u r y t o p e r s o n s , i n c l u d - ing the following: • Do not u se this product near water , for exampl e, near a ba[...]

  • Seite 947

    iv How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol indicates a potentially hazardo us situation that might result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e de[...]

  • Seite 948

    v Manuals f or This M achine Two Facsimile Reference manuals are provided, the Basic Fe atures manual and the Advanced Featur es manual. Please refer to the manual that suits your needs. Basic Fe atures (t his manual) The Basic Features manual ex plains the most frequently used fax functions and oper ation s. Advanced Fea tures The A dvanced Fe atu[...]

  • Seite 949

    vi TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. Getting Star ted Machi ne Typ es .... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... . 1 Guid e to C ompon ents .. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ..... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ... 2 Front V iew ...... ...... ....... ..... ....... .... .......[...]

  • Seite 950

    vii Reception Modes ...................................................................................... 31 Selecti ng the Reception Mode ......... .... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ....... ..... ....... .... ... 31 3. Registering Own Name /Fax He ader/ Own Fax Number ..... ..... ...... .... ...... .... ...... ...... .... 33 Register ing ..[...]

  • Seite 951

    viii StellaCEN-basic_V4_FM. book Page viii Thursday, July 19, 2 001 1:39 PM[...]

  • Seite 952

    1 1. Getting Started Machi ne Types This ma chine c omes in three models . Model A Model B Type1 Typ e1 Type 2 Copy Speed 12 copies/minute (A4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" ) 13 copies/minute (A4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" ) 13 copies/minute (A4, 8 1 / 2 " × 11" ) Paper C apacity for Bypass Tra y 1 sheet 100 sheets 100 sheets Paper Tray U[...]

  • Seite 953

    Getting Sta rted 2 1 Guide to Comp onents Front View Following illustra tion is for Model B. 1. Exposur e Glass Cov er Lower th e Exposure Glass Cover over originals placed on the exposure glass. 2. Document F eeder (ADF) (Optio n for T ype1 ) Originals wil l be fed automatical ly. 3. Exposur e Glass Place the original face down on the upper left c[...]

  • Seite 954

    Guide t o Component s 3 1 6. Operation switch Press this switch to turn the power on (the On indi cator lights up). To t urn the power off, press this switch again (the On indicator goes off). See p.6 “ Tu rning On the P ower ” . 7. Pape r Tray Set paper he re. 8. Paper Tray Unit (Option for Mod- el B Onl y) You can set more paper here. Sid e V[...]

  • Seite 955

    Getting Sta rted 4 1 Control Panel 1. Receive File Indicator Lights when a me ssage has been received into memory. 2. Commu nic ati ng Ind icat or Lights during tran smission or reception. 3. { { { { Job Informati on } } } } key Press to search for information on a spe- cific jo b. 4. { { { { Tran smissio n Opt ion } } } } key Press to chan ge the [...]

  • Seite 956

    Control Panel 5 1 18. User Function k eys Each of these can b e program med for rapid ac cess to frequently used f unctions. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Function s Program med by Def ault 19. { { { { Resoluti on } } } } key Press to switch between St and ard , Deta il and Fine . When the indi cator is not lit, Standard is selected. 20. { { { { Memory Trans. } [...]

  • Seite 957

    Getting Sta rted 6 1 Starti ng the Ma chine To s tart the mach ine, tur n on the op - eration switch. Note ❒ This ma chine a utom aticall y ent ers Energy Saver mode or turns itself off if you do not use the machine for a while. See Chapter 2 “ Se tting s You Ca n Chang e wit h the User Tools ” i n the System Settings ma n- ual. - - - - Power[...]

  • Seite 958

    Star ting the Mach ine 7 1 Turni ng Off the Po wer A A A A Turn off the operation switch. The On indicator will go out. Importa nt ❒ Befo re you unp lug the powe r cord , confirm tha t the disp lay in Facsimil e mode indi cates t hat the remaining memory space is 100%. Turning Of f the main power switch When th e main pow er switch is turned off [...]

  • Seite 959

    Getting Sta rted 8 1 Changing Modes This machi ne is both a fax and a co pier. If the machine is not in Facsim ile mode, press the { { { { Facsimi le } } } } key to use f ax function. You can se t this machine to disp lay facsimil e mode immedia tely a fter th e oper- ation switch is t urned on. See Chapter 2 “ Settings You C an Change with the U[...]

  • Seite 960

    Reading t he Display 9 1 Reading t he Displ ay The machine status and instruc tions are shown on the display. Note ❒ All pro cedures in this manual assum e you are in Fac simile mo de. If the ma- chine is not in Facsi mile m ode, press t he { { { { Facsimile } } } } key to change to Facsim- ile mode. You can have the machine start in Facsim ile m[...]

  • Seite 961

    Getting Sta rted 10 1 Standby Display While th e machin e is in stan dby mode (immediately after it is turned on or af- ter th e { { { { Cancel } } } } key is pressed), the fol- lowing display is sh own. Note ❒ To re turn the machi ne to stand by mode, do one of th e foll owing : • If you have set the o riginal and have not pressed the { { { { [...]

  • Seite 962

    11 2. Faxing Transmiss ion Modes There are two types of transmission. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Memory Transmission When a fax doc ument is stor ed in memory, then tra nsmission starts autom atica lly. This makes it conv enient when you would like to take documents back in a hurr y. You can send the same message to more than one destination in a sin- gle ope[...]

  • Seite 963

    Faxing 12 2 Switching between Memory Transmission and Immediate Transmissi on Pres s the { { { { Memory Tr ans. } } } } key to switch between Memory Transmis- sion and Immediate Transmission. When the indica tor of the { { { { Memo ry Trans. } } } } key is not lit, Immediate Transmission i s selected. When the indica tor of the { { { { Memory Trans[...]

  • Seite 964

    Setti ng O riginals 13 2 Setting O riginals You can set your orig inals either in the Docu ment Feeder o r on the expo- sure glass. Some types of original s are unsuitable for the Document Feeder so they must be set on the exposure glass. Which way you place your original depends on its size and whether you are using t he Document Feeder or the exp[...]

  • Seite 965

    Faxing 14 2 Placing a Sin gle Original on the Exposure Gla ss Set ori ginal s tha t cannot be pla ced i n the Docu ment Feeder, such as a book, on the exposure glass one page at a time . A A A A Lift the Expo sure Glass Cover. Place the or iginal face down an d align its upper left corn er with the referen ce mark a t the up per left cor ner of th [...]

  • Seite 966

    Setti ng O riginals 15 2 A A A A Adjust the document guide to match the size of your originals. Align the edges of your originals and stack them in the Documen t Feeder face up. Adjust th e docu- ment guid e to ma tch th e size of the originals again. 1. Limit mark 2. Docu ment gu ide Originals unsuitable for the Docu ment Feeder (ADF) Do no t set [...]

  • Seite 967

    Faxing 16 2 Memory Tr ansmission Memo ry Transm ission is conven ient because: • Fax documents can be scanned much more quickly. Your scanned docum ent is stored in the memor y, and then sent automatica lly, meaning you do not have to wait for your doc ument to send . • While your fax docume nt is being sent, anot her user can operate the machi[...]

  • Seite 968

    Memory Trans mission 17 2 B B B B Set the original. Lim ita tion ❒ You can send the first p ages from the exposure glass, and then the remaining pages from the Document Fee der. After you place the last page on th e expo- sure glass, you have 60 seconds to in sert the r emai ning page s in the Document Feeder. ❒ Note that you cannot place pag- [...]

  • Seite 969

    Faxing 18 2 Sending Originals from the Exposure Glass A A A A Place the first page of your origi nal on the exp osure gl ass face d own. B B B B Dial. C C C C Press th e { { { { Sta rt } } } } key. The machine start s scanning the orig inal. D D D D Place the next or iginal on the exp osure g lass w ithi n 60 se c- onds after the machine has fin- i[...]

  • Seite 970

    Cancelin g a Memory Transmis sion 19 2 Canceling a Me mory Transmissi on Before the St art Key is Pressed A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key. Note ❒ When you set the document in the Document Feeder, yo u can cancel the transmission by just removing it. While the Orig inal is Bei ng Scanned A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Clear/Stop }[...]

  • Seite 971

    Faxing 20 2 C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D D D D Display the file you want to de- lete. Enter the file numbe r with the num- ber keys, or searc h using 0 or 1 . E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select " Yes " G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The file is erased, and [...]

  • Seite 972

    Immediate Tr ansmission 21 2 Immediate Trans mission Immediate Transmission is co nve- nient when: • You wish to send a document im- mediately as it is scanning. • You wish to quickly check w hether you have successfully connected with the o ther part y's fax machin e. • Your mach ine' s memo ry i s get tin g full. The machine dials[...]

  • Seite 973

    Faxing 22 2 Referen ce p.33 “ Own Name/Fax H ead- er/Own Fax Number ” After transm ission the machi ne will r eturn to standb y mo de. Sending Originals from the Exposure Glass A A A A Place the fi rst page face d own on the exposure glass . B B B B Dial. C C C C Press th e { { { { Sta rt } } } } key. The machine start s scanning the orig inal.[...]

  • Seite 974

    Canceling an Imme diate Trans mission 23 2 Canceling an Imme diate Transmis sion Before t he Start key i s Pressed A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { Clear Modes } } } } key. Note ❒ When you have already set the orig inal, y ou c an als o canc el an Immediate Tr ansmission by re- moving the origi nal from the machine . After the St art key is Pressed A [...]

  • Seite 975

    Faxing 24 2 Scan Settings You may w ish to send many different types of fax messages. Som e of these may be difficu lt to repr oduce at the othe r end. Ho wever , yo ur machi ne has three settings that you can adjust to help you transmit your doc ument with the best p ossible im age qual ity. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Resolution: Stand ard , Detail , Fi ne ?[...]

  • Seite 976

    Scan Sett ings 25 2 Original Type If your origi nal contains phot o- gra phs, il lustr ation s or diag rams w ith complex shading p atterns or grays , select the app ropriate Original Ty pe to optimize image clarity. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Text Select Te xt to send an original con- taining a high-con trast black-and- white image. Use this setting even if [...]

  • Seite 977

    Faxing 26 2 Dialing There are four m ain ways to dial a numb er: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Entering Numbers Directly See p.26 “ Entering Num bers Di- rectly ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Using Quick Dials: See p.27 “ Using Quick Dials ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Using Speed Dials: See p.28 “ Using Speed Dials ” ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Usin g Grou ps See p.29 “ Using Groups [...]

  • Seite 978

    Dialing 27 2 Note ❒ If a mem ory file is awai ting tran smi s- sion and the "Exceeded th e Max.Canno t Add" messa ge is dis- played when dialing with the num- ber keys, you cann ot dial any more num bers. That is b ecause the fa x number s have been dialed with the nu mbe r ke ys fo r s ome of th e f il es awaiting transmission. When th[...]

  • Seite 979

    Faxing 28 2 A A A A Make sure that the machine is in standby m ode. B B B B Set your original and select any scan settings you require. C C C C Press the Quick Dial key in which the desti nation' s number is pro - grammed. If the destination's name has been stored, the name i s shown on the displa y. If it is not , the fax numbe r is show[...]

  • Seite 980

    Dialing 29 2 C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { Speed D ial } } } } key. D D D D Enter the two d igit code (00 to 49) for the destination with the n um- ber keys . Note ❒ When a name is stor ed for the destination , the nam e is dis- played, and when no name is stored , the fax num ber is dis- play ed. ❒ If you wish to dial another des- tinatio n, pre[...]

  • Seite 981

    Faxing 30 2 When Specifying a Group wi th a Qui ck Dial Make su re that the Memory Tra ns- mission indicator is lit, if not, press the { { { { Memor y T rans. } } } } key to li ght it. Note ❒ You must register Groups to Quic k Dials bef orehand. See p.4 9 “ Groups ” A A A A Make sure that the machine is in standby m ode. B B B B Set your orig[...]

  • Seite 982

    Rec ept ion Mo des 31 2 Recepti on Modes The machine can treat incoming fax messages and telephone calls in three ways. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Manual Receive Use this mode if your line is s hared by a f ax mac hin e and a te lephon e but you wish to answer all calls yourself and decide whether they are fax do cuments or telephone calls . You mu st manual [...]

  • Seite 983

    Faxing 32 2 - - - - Distin ctive Ri ng Two num bers (telephone number and fax num ber) can be assigned to one line by making a contract with your telephone comp any for Distinc- tive Ring. Each number will have a different ringing pattern. This is use- ful for distingui shing a fax from a tele pho ne ca ll. Please contact your telephone c ompa- ny [...]

  • Seite 984

    33 3. Registering Own Name/Fax Header/Own Fax Number Make sure t hat all necessary settings are made before connecting yo ur ma- chine to the te leph one li ne. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Own Name Th i s s ho ul d be yo ur na me o r co m- pany name, in 20 characters or l ess. During communication, if the oth- er party's fax machine supports Own Name, thi[...]

  • Seite 985

    Register ing 34 3 Registering The fol lowing p rocedur e describes how to m ake i nitial sett ings. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is displayed. C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Setup " is d[...]

  • Seite 986

    Own Name/Fax Heade r/Own Fax Number 35 3 L L L L Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The programmed Own Name is disp lay ed. M M M M Enter your Fax Header. If your Fa x Header is the same as your Own Name, go to ste p N . N N N N Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Your Fax He ader is p rogram med. O O O O Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. [...]

  • Seite 987

    Register ing 36 3 D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Setup " is disp layed . E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 6. Fax Info r- mation " is displayed. G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select the item that you want to edit.[...]

  • Seite 988

    Own Name/Fax Heade r/Own Fax Number 37 3 F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 6. Fax Info r- mation " is displayed. G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select the item that yo u want to delete. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key. [...]

  • Seite 989

    Register ing 38 3 Quick Di al To save time, you can program a fax number that you use often into a Quick Dial key. Then, w henever you are sending a message to that loca- tion, just press that Quick Dial key to dial . Register ing The fol lowing p rocedur e describes how to r egi ster fax nu mber s in Qu ick Dial ke ys. The re ar e 16 Q uick D ials[...]

  • Seite 990

    Quick Dial 39 3 E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Display the number of the Quick Dial ke y you wa nt to regi ster. Press a Quick Dial key, or search using 0 or 1 . Note ❒ If a Quick Dial has already been registered, the c ontents are dis- played. Press 0 or 1 to sel ect a Quic k Dial that is n ot pro - grammed, an d then press [...]

  • Seite 991

    Register ing 40 3 L L L L Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you want to stor e another Quick Dial, go t o step E . M M M M Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn to standby display. Edit ing The fol lowing p rocedur e describes how to edit fax numbers registered in Quick Dial keys. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } }[...]

  • Seite 992

    Quick Dial 41 3 J J J J Press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key, an d then reenter the destination name. Note ❒ Under rare circu mstances , gar- bled characters may appear during name registration if yo u use the { { { { Pause/Redia l } } } } key to displa y the fax number of par- ties lo cated in other co untrie s. If this happens , simply dele[...]

  • Seite 993

    Register ing 42 3 E E E E Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 2. Del. Quick Dial " is d isplayed. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Displ ay the Quic k Dial key th at you want to delete. Press a Quick Dial key or search by pressing 0 or 1 . The number of the Quick Dial key and the fax number o r name are disp lay ed. H H H[...]

  • Seite 994

    Quick Dial 43 3 Label pap er 1. Quic k Dial key nu mber 2. Destinati on name Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 43 Thu rsday , July 19, 2001 1:39 P M[...]

  • Seite 995

    Register ing 44 3 Speed Dial Register ing If you regi ster numbers in Speed Di- als, y ou can spe cify the fax num ber simply b y pressing the { { { { Speed Dial } } } } key, and e nter ing a two- digit S peed Dia l n um be r. The fol lowing proced ure d escrib es how t o register fax number s in Speed Dia ls . You can reg ister t he follo wing ite[...]

  • Seite 996

    Speed Dial 45 3 G G G G Display the number of the Spe ed Dial you want to register (00 to 49). Enter the Speed Di al numb er with the number key s, or search using 0 or 1 . Note ❒ If you make a m istake, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key and tr y again. ❒ If a Sp eed Dial number has al- read y been stor ed, the con tents are displayed. P[...]

  • Seite 997

    Register ing 46 3 Edit ing The fol lowing p rocedur e describes how to edit regist ered Speed Dial numb ers . A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is displayed. C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Confirm th at " 1. Progra m / Delete " is di sp[...]

  • Seite 998

    Speed Dial 47 3 M M M M Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to se lect "On " or "Off". Note ❒ Label in sertion all ows the desti- nation name that i s pro- grammed in Quick Dial or Speed Di al to be p rinted on the fax w hen it is rece ived at the other end. S ee Chapter 1 “ Label Insertion ” in the Advanced Fea- tures manu al. N N [...]

  • Seite 999

    Register ing 48 3 E E E E Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Del. Spe ed Dial " is d isplayed. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Display the Speed Dial number you want to delete (00 to 49). Enter the Speed Di al numb er with the number keys or search using 0 or 1 . The Speed Dial number and the fax number or name are d[...]

  • Seite 1000

    Groups 49 3 Grou ps If you regularly broa dcast document s to the same set of dest inations, you can combine these numbers into a group. Then just select the group and each number will be dialed in se- quence aut omati cally. There are two ways of progr amming Grou ps: ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Registering gr oups in Quick Dial keys If you regist er a grou p[...]

  • Seite 1001

    Register ing 50 3 ❒ It is recom men ded tha t you p rint the Group Dial list and keep it when you register or change desti- natio ns. See C hapter 5, "Print ing Repo rts/ List s" in the Ad van ced Features manual. ❒ If you register the same destination in different Groups, it is only counted as one item. ❒ How to count number s. A A[...]

  • Seite 1002

    Groups 51 3 H H H H Specify the destination using one of the following three methods: Enter the f ax number with the number keys. Press a Quick Dial key. Press th e { { { { Speed D ial } } } } key, and then en ter a Speed Dial nu mber. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The dest inati on is progra mmed. J J J J Pre ss t he 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1[...]

  • Seite 1003

    Register ing 52 3 Edit ing You can edit th e group name or a dd destinat ions for programm ed groups. To edit a de stination : • For de stin atio ns progr amme d in Quick Dial or Speed Dial, edit the conten ts of the programmed Q uick Dial or Speed Dial. • For destinati ons programmed wit h the numbe r keys, de lete the de sti- nati on you want[...]

  • Seite 1004

    Groups 53 3 L L L L Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The name i s changed. M M M M Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to se lect " Yes" if the group w as programmed in a Quick Dial, or select "No" if it was not . N N N N Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you selected "No", go to step P . Note ❒ If you want to edit a p[...]

  • Seite 1005

    Register ing 54 3 G G G G Display the number of the group to which you wa nt to add a num- ber (1 to 5). En ter th e gr ou p nu mb er w ith the number keys, or search using 0 or 1 . H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. I I I I Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select "Yes". J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key Note ❒ If you have[...]

  • Seite 1006

    Groups 55 3 R R R R Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. S S S S Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to se lect " Yes" if the group w as programmed in a Quick Dial, or select "No" if it was not . T T T T Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you selected "No", go to step V . Note ❒ If you want to edit a p ro- grammed Quick Dia[...]

  • Seite 1007

    Register ing 56 3 E E E E Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 5. Prog. Grou p Dial " is disp laye d. F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Display the group number for the destination yo u want to delete (1 to 5) . En ter th e gr ou p nu mb er w ith the number keys, or search using 0 or 1 . H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } }[...]

  • Seite 1008

    Groups 57 3 T T T T Pres s th e { { { { OK } } } } key to return to standby m ode. If y ou wa nt to de let e ano the r des ti - natio n f rom the group , go to s tep F . U U U U Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn to standby mode. To delete an ent ire group A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 [...]

  • Seite 1009

    Register ing 58 3 - - - - To chan ge and d elete Quick Dials prog ram med as group s: To store an entire group u nder a dif- ferent Quick Dial key, or to delete the group from the Quic k Dial key al to- gether, perform the followin g proce- dure: A Press the { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B Press 0 or 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is di[...]

  • Seite 1010

    Enteri ng Character s 59 3 Ente rin g Cha ract ers This section describes how to enter characters. Availabl e Characters • Letters : ABCDEFGHIJK LMNOPQRSTUVWXYZa bcdefghij klmnopqr stuvwxyz • Symbol s: – _ (space) . , ( ) / @ & $ ! ' # * % + : ; < = > ? ^ [ ] ` { | } ∼ • Numbe rs : 0123456789 Keys 1. Quick Dial 01 to Quick [...]

  • Seite 1011

    Register ing 60 3 How to Enter Charact ers The fol lowing p rocedur e describes how to enter charact ers. Note ❒ When you enter a character, it is show n at th e posi tion of the curs or. If there is a character at the cursor position, the entered character is shown before the character. A A A A Enter letters, symbols or num- ber s. Characters ar[...]

  • Seite 1012

    61 4. Troubleshooting Adjust ing Volum e You ca n chan ge t he vol ume of the fol- lowing sou nds the mach ine makes. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ On Hook Sounds when you press the { { { { On Hook Dial } } } } key. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Transmission Sounds when th e machine se nd a message. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Reception Sounds when the machine re ceives a message. ❖ ?[...]

  • Seite 1013

    Troublesh ooting 62 4 H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to adjust the vol- ume. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The volume is adjusted. If you want to adjust anot her item, repeat steps G to I . J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn to standby display. Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 62 Thu rsday , July 19,[...]

  • Seite 1014

    Erro r Mess ages 63 4 Erro r Mess age s If there is an erro r, one of the following messages may app ear on the display. It might just flash up briefly, so if you are wat ching for errors, stay by the machine and check the display. Messa ge Problem and Solution Cl ear Mi sfed Orig . Rem ove or igin al fr om AD F Cover Original misfe ed Remove origi[...]

  • Seite 1015

    Troublesh ooting 64 4 When th e { { { { Facsimil e } } } } key is Lit in Re d When the { { { { Facs imil e } } } } key is lit in re d while machine is in Copy mode, press the { { { { Facsimile } } } } key and read the me ssage. If h i s lit, refer to the ta ble bel ow an d take t he appro priat e act ion. Prob lem S oluti on Paper has r un out. Add[...]

  • Seite 1016

    When the Receive File I ndicato r is L it 65 4 When the Rec eive File Ind icator is Lit If t he Rec eive File indicator is li t, a messa ge has been receiv ed but could not be printed for some reason. T he message was stored in memory (Subst itute Recep- tion). Wh en you solve t he problem, the message will be automatically pri nted out. The table [...]

  • Seite 1017

    Troublesh ooting 66 4 Solving P roblems This table lists some common problems and their solutions. Pro blem Req uir ed A ctio n Image background appears dirty when a fax is re ceived at the other end. Adjust the scan density . Referenc e See p.25 “ Image Density (Contr ast) ” Printed or sent image contains spots. The Documen t Feeder (AD F) or [...]

  • Seite 1018

    67 INDEX A ADF → Document F eeder , 2 Adjusting Volume Alar m , 61 Dialing , 61 Key Tone , 61 On Hook , 61 Reception , 61 Transmissi on , 61 Advan ced Featur es , v Auto Receive , 31 Auto Select , 31 B Basi c Featu res (t his m anual ) , v Bypass Tra y , 3 C Cancel key , 4 Changing M odes , 8 Characte rs Available Characters , 59 Entering , 59 Ke[...]

  • Seite 1019

    68 L LCD display , 4 M Machi ne Ty pes , 1 Main Powe r Indica tor , 4 main pow er switch , 2 Manual Receive , 31 Manuals for This M achine , v Memory Trans. key , 5 Memory Transmi ssion , 11 , 16 Canceling , 19 N NOTICE , i Numb er ke ys , 5 Dialing , 26 O OK key , 4 On Hook Dial ke y , 5 On Indicator , 4 Operatio n switch , 3 , 5 Origin al Type , [...]

  • Seite 1020

    69 V Volu me , 61 W Wild Cards , 60 Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 69 Thu rsday , July 19, 2001 1:39 P M[...]

  • Seite 1021

    70 MEMO Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 70 Thu rsday , July 19, 2001 1:39 P M[...]

  • Seite 1022

    71 MEMO Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 71 Thu rsday , July 19, 2001 1:39 P M[...]

  • Seite 1023

    72 UE US A B46 5 MEMO Stel laCEN-ba sic_V4 _FM.bo ok Page 72 Thu rsday , July 19, 2001 1:39 P M[...]

  • Seite 1024

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 92 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.68 0000 mm Opera ting I nstructions Facsimi le Re ference <Advanc ed Fea tures> Operatin g Instru ctions Facsimile Reference <Advanced Features> Read t[...]

  • Seite 1025

    i How to Read this Manual Symb ols In th is manual, the following sym bols are used: R WARNING: This symbol indicates a potentially hazardo us situation that might result in death or serious i njury when you misuse the mac hine without following t he in- struc tions under thi s symb ol. Be su re to re ad t he ins tructi ons , all of whic h ar e de-[...]

  • Seite 1026

    ii Manuals f or This M achine Two Facsimile Reference manuals are provided, the Basic Fe atures manual and the Advanced Featur es manual. Please refer to the manual that suits your needs. Advanced Features (t his manual) The Advanced Feature s manual describes more advanced functions and also ex- plains settings for ke y operators. Basic Fe atures [...]

  • Seite 1027

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. Transmis sion Optio ns Sendin g at a Spec ific Ti me (Sen d Later ) ... ....... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... 1 Fax H eader Prin t ..... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ..... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ... 3 Label Inse rtion ........ ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ....[...]

  • Seite 1028

    iv Prin ted Rep orts. ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ...... ..... ...... .... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... . 25 File Reserve Report (Switch 03, Bit 2) ......................................................... 25 Communication Result Report (Switch 03, Bit 0) .................................... ..... 25 Communication F ailure Repo[...]

  • Seite 1029

    v 6. Key Operator Setti ngs Functi on L ist ........ .... ...... .... ...... ...... .... ...... .... ....... .... ...... .... ...... .... ...... .... .... 49 Usin g Key Oper ator Set ting s..... .... ...... ...... ...... ... ...... ...... ...... ...... .... ...... ... 50 Memory Lo ck........... .... ....... ..... ....... .... ....... ..... ...... .[...]

  • Seite 1030

    vi Stell aCE N-advan ced_ V4_F M.boo k Page vi Tues day, July 17, 2001 1: 01 PM[...]

  • Seite 1031

    1 1. Transmission Options Sending at a Speci fic Time (Send Later) Using the Send Later functi on, you can delay transmission of your fax message until a specified t ime. This allows you to ta ke advanta ge of off- peak teleph one line charges without having to be by the machine at the time of transmission. Note ❒ You can not specify a time more [...]

  • Seite 1032

    Transmissi on Opti ons 2 1 K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The speci fied time i s set. L L L L Specify the destination. If you want to sp ecify another des- tination, press the { { { { OK } } } } key an d repeat st ep L . M M M M Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. Note ❒ You can cancel a message trans- mission set for Send Later.[...]

  • Seite 1033

    Fax Header Pr int 3 1 Fax Header Print Normally, the Fax H eader pr o- grammed i n your mach ine is print ed at the to p of each of the pa ges you transmit whe n they are rec eived at the ot her end . The top of the image will be ove rprin ted if the re is no mar- gin at t he top of th e transmit ted page. Important ❒ In the USA, this must contai[...]

  • Seite 1034

    Transmissi on Opti ons 4 1 Label Inse rtio n With thi s func tion, y ou can hav e the receive r's name p rogramme d in Quick Dial or Speed Dial printed on the mess age wh en it is rec eived at the other end. The nam e will be printed at the top o f the page and w ill be pre- cede d by "To". If you program the Label Insert ion func ti[...]

  • Seite 1035

    Calling to Req uest a Messa ge (Polling Rece ption) 5 1 Call ing to Request a Messag e (Polling Recepti on) Use this func tion if you want to poll a message from anot her termina l. You can also poll documents from many terminal s. There are tw o types of Polling Recep - tion : ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Secured Polling Reception If the Polling ID is prog ram[...]

  • Seite 1036

    Transmissi on Opti ons 6 1 E E E E Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select "On". F F F F Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. G G G G Select the type of Polling Rece p- tion. Secured Polling Reception A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select ” Def ault ” . Stored ID Override Polling Reception A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select ?[...]

  • Seite 1037

    Calling to Req uest a Messa ge (Polling Rece ption) 7 1 File Reserve Report (Polling RX) This report is printed after Poll ing Re- ception has been set up. You ca n che ck th e da te and time , Fax Header, File N o., Transmis sion con- dition and the Other party's name with thi s report . Note ❒ You can tu rn this fun ction on or of f with t[...]

  • Seite 1038

    Transmissi on Opti ons 8 1 Stel laCEN- advanced _V4_FM .book Page 8 Tuesda y, Jul y 17, 2 001 1: 01 PM[...]

  • Seite 1039

    9 2. Job Information Canceling T ransmission or Re ception Transmission files are originals that have been stored in mem ory and are awaiting transmission. The functions that produce transmission files are Memory Transmission and Polling Receptio n. If you notice an error in the destina- tion specif ied or th e document con- tent after sca nni ng a[...]

  • Seite 1040

    Job Informat ion 10 2 Printing a Li st of Files in Memo ry (Print File List ) Print this list if you wish to find out which fi les are st ored in memory and what their file numb ers are. Knowing the file num ber can be useful (for ex- ample when er asing files). Note ❒ The contents of an original stored in mem ory can also b e prin ted. S ee p.11[...]

  • Seite 1041

    Printing a Sto red Messag e (Print TX File) 11 2 Printi ng a Stor ed Mess age (P rint TX File) If yo u w ish to ch ec k th e c on t en ts of a fax that is store d in memory an d has not been sent yet, use this p rocedu re to prin t it out. A A A A Make sure that the machine is in Facsimile m ode and the standby display is shown. B B B B Pre ss th e[...]

  • Seite 1042

    Job Informat ion 12 2 Printing a M emory-lock ed Message This is a security function that pre- vents unaut horized individu als from reading printed m essages. If Memory Lock is s witch ed on, all recei ved mes - sag es ar e sto red in mem ory and ar e not auto matical ly printed. To print the me ssages, you have to enter the Memor y Lock I D code [...]

  • Seite 1043

    Printi ng the Journa l 13 2 Printing the Journal When au tomati c co mmunicati on report pr inting is t urned o n, th e Jour nal is printed automatica lly after every 50 communications (receptions + transmis- sions). You can also print a copy of the Journal at any time by following the pro- cedure b elow. Note ❒ The sender 's name column o f[...]

  • Seite 1044

    Job Informat ion 14 2 Report For mats 1. The Mode Col umn Codes and al phabet on this column in- form the type of communication. These codes are exp lained on the bottom of th e report. 2. The Result Column OK : Successf ul comm unicat ion E: An error occurred D: Power Fai lure 3. The Footnote on the J ournal Tran smis sio n count er : Tota l numbe[...]

  • Seite 1045

    15 3. Other Transmission Features Handy Dialing Functions Chain Dial This function allows yo u to compose a telephone number from various parts, some of which may be regis- tered in Quick Dials or Speed Dials and some of which may be entered using the number keys. You c an pro gram commonl y u sed area or c ountry co des into Sp eed Di- als or Quic[...]

  • Seite 1046

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 16 3 Tele phone Directory This funct ion le ts yo u find a regi s- tere d Speed Dial q uickly by jus t en- tering a single letter, for example, the first letter of the name registered for that numbe r. Limitatio n ❒ Speed Di al codes cannot be searched for by symbol or numbe r. ❒ Name s encl os ed with in brac kets[...]

  • Seite 1047

    On Hook Dial 17 3 On Hook Dial You can send a fax message withou t lifting the re ceiver, while st ill listen- ing to the dial tone. If the other party has a telephone fax machine, you can t alk by lifting the receiver after your machi ne has con- nec ted to thei rs. Referenc e See Chap ter 4 “ Adjusting Vo lume ” in the Basic Feature s manual.[...]

  • Seite 1048

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 18 3 Manual Dial The externa l telephone is r equired. You can send a fax message using a n extern al telephone. Note ❒ The result of transmissi on with manual d ial is not mentio ned in the Transmission Result Report (Immediate Transmission). A A A A Place your or iginal, an d then se- lect any scan settin gs you re[...]

  • Seite 1049

    Transmiss ion Features 19 3 Transmiss ion Features SEP Code If you want to recei ve a mess age stored i n the mem ory of anot her par- ty's fax machi ne, use this fu nction. The machine w ill receive the message with the SEP and PWD code tha t matc hes the S EP and PW D code yo u enter i n the follow ing procedur e. Prep arat ion You need to a[...]

  • Seite 1050

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 20 3 H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Polling RX " is displayed. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. J J J J Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select "On". K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. L L L L Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to select ” Defa ult ” . M M M M Pre ss th e { [...]

  • Seite 1051

    Transmiss ion Features 21 3 D D D D Confirm that " 1. SUB " is dis- played. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Enter the SUB code with the num- ber keys . G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. When a password (SID) is necessary A A A A Press t he { { { { User Function } } } } key as- signed wi th the Dial O ption fu[...]

  • Seite 1052

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 22 3 More Transmission Functions If M emory R uns Out While Storing an Origin al A A A A If you run out of memory w hile storing an original (free space reache s 0%), “Memory is Full.S tori ng Sto pped .” is dis- played. B B B B Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. When transmitting the s tored pages A A A A Press 0[...]

  • Seite 1053

    More Tran smission Functio ns 23 3 Broadcasting Sequen ce If you d ial severa l dest inations f or the same messa ge (Broa dcasti ng), the messages are sent in the order in which they we re diale d. If the fax message could not be transmit ted to a destination, the machine redials that dest ination after t he last destina tion spec ified for Broa d[...]

  • Seite 1054

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 24 3 Dual Access The machine can scan other messages into memory even while sending a fax message from memory, receiving a message into mem ory , or automat- ical ly pr inting a rep ort. S ince th e ma- chine starts sending the second message immedi ately after the cur- rent transmission terminat es, the line will be u[...]

  • Seite 1055

    Printed Repo rts 25 3 Printed Reports You can o btain repo rts from your ma- chine either by having you r machine print them out automatically, or by print ing them o ut your self. Note ❒ You can switch on o r off t he print- ing of the var ious repo rts with the User Parameters. S ee p.58 “ User Parameters ” (switc h 03, bi ts 7 – 0). ❒ [...]

  • Seite 1056

    Other Transmi ssion Feat ures 26 3 Transmissi on Result Report (Immediat e Transmission) (Switc h 03, B it 5) If you t urn on th e printing of this re- port, a rep ort wi ll be print ed af ter ev- ery Immed iate Transmission so you have a record of whether the tran s- miss ion wa s succ essful or not. If the machi ne is set up n ot to pri nt this r[...]

  • Seite 1057

    27 4. Reception Features General Imme diate Recepti on Each pa ge of a r eceiv ed f ax mes sage is prin ted as soon as it is re ceived . This method is used for standard fax mes- sages. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Display d uring rec eption The sender 's name or f ax number appears on the upper li ne. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Reception r esolution This machine sup[...]

  • Seite 1058

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 28 4 Printing Documents that hav e been Received i nto Memory (Substitute Reception) If any of th e conditions li sted below are met, the machine automatically swit ches to Memory Rece ption m ode and stores messages in memory i n- stead o f prin ting them. This rece ption mode, in which a received fax mes- sage is stored in [...]

  • Seite 1059

    Genera l 29 4 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Free The machin e switc hes to Subs titute Reception regardl ess of whether or not th e sender has p rogrammed their nam e or fax number. Receiving Mess ages in Telephone Mode I n t h i s m o d e y o u h a v e t o a n s w e r t h e call yourse lf an d decid e whet her it is a fax or a telephone call. The proc edure for[...]

  • Seite 1060

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 30 4 Printing Options Center Mark W h e n t h i s f u n c t i o n i s t u r n e d o n , marks are p rinted halfway dow n the left side an d at th e top cen ter of eac h page received. T his makes it easy for you to positio n a hole puncher cor - rectly whe n you file rec eived messag- es. Limitatio n ❒ The center mark s may[...]

  • Seite 1061

    Prin ting O ption s 31 4 Reception Time When th is fu nct ion is turne d on, you can have the date and time when a message was re ceived printed at the botto m of the receiv ed image . Turn it on or off with the User Para meters (Switc h 02 Bit 2). See p.5 8 “ User Pa- rameters ” . Limitatio n ❒ When a received m essage is print- ed on tw o o[...]

  • Seite 1062

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 32 4 When There is No Paper of the Correct Size If there is no paper in your machine that matches the size of a received message, the machine wi ll choose a pa per size based upon the pap er you have avai lable. For example, if your machine has A4 L and 8 1 / 2 ” × 11 ” L inst alled and you re - ceive a A5 K size message[...]

  • Seite 1063

    Prin ting O ption s 33 4 Limitatio n ❒ The paper size used to print a r eceived message may be different from the size of the sent origin al. Referenc e p.31 “ Page Separation and Length Reduction ” Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Page 33 Tuesday , July 17, 20 01 1:0 1 PM[...]

  • Seite 1064

    Rec ept ion Feat ure s 34 4 Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Page 34 Tuesday , July 17, 20 01 1:0 1 PM[...]

  • Seite 1065

    35 5. Facsimile User Tools User F unction K eys You ca n program eac h of the User Fun ction keys ( { { { { F1 } } } } to { { { { F3 } } } } ) with a function that you use fr equently. When you wish t o use that funct ion, instead o f having to search through s everal menus to fi nd it, just pr ess the appropriat e User Func- tion key. Important ?[...]

  • Seite 1066

    Facsimil e User Tools 36 5 • The " b " notation indicates that the User Functi on key lights when that func- tion is s elected ” On ” . To assign a function to a User Function key, perform the following proce dure. Making a User Function Key Assignment A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 [...]

  • Seite 1067

    User Functi on Keys 37 5 I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you want to regi ster another User Funct ion key, repeat th e above steps from step F . J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. The machin e returns to standby mod e. Using a User Function Key To use a User Function key ( { { { { F1 } } } } to { { { { F3 } } } } ),[...]

  • Seite 1068

    Facsimil e User Tools 38 5 I I I I Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to display " None ". J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you want to delete another User Function key, repeat the above steps from step G . K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. The machin e returns to standby mod e. Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Pa[...]

  • Seite 1069

    Printi ng Reports/ Lists 39 5 Printi ng Repo rts/Li sts This functi on allows you to prin t the foll owin g repor ts an d lis ts manu ally . Select a re port or list as need ed. • Journal See p.13 “ Prin ting the Journa l ” . • TX Fil e Li st See p. 11 “ Pr intin g a Sto red Me s- sage (Print TX File) ” . • Quick Dial List See Chapter[...]

  • Seite 1070

    Facsimil e User Tools 40 5 Printing the Quick Dial List A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Dial List " is displayed. B B B B Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Confirm that " 1. Quick Dial List " is displaye d. C C C C Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ If you make a mistake, pr ess the { { { { Cancel } } } } k[...]

  • Seite 1071

    Printi ng Reports/ Lists 41 5 Printing the Quick Dial Label A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Quick Dial Label " is d ispla yed. B B B B Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Note ❒ If you make a mistake, pr ess the { { { { Cancel } } } } key and t ry agai n. Printing the User Function List A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until [...]

  • Seite 1072

    Facsimil e User Tools 42 5 Adjust ing the Di spla y Contr ast Use this function to adjust the bright- ness of the display. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is displayed. C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until &quo[...]

  • Seite 1073

    Setti ng th e Date and Time 43 5 Setting the Date and Time Use t his fun ction to set you r ma - chine's internal cl ock to the current time and da te. If the current date and time are wrong, use this procedure to corre ct them. Note ❒ If you make a mistake w hen enter- ing numbers, press the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key and try again. ❒[...]

  • Seite 1074

    Facsimil e User Tools 44 5 Q Q Q Q Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. After " Function Accep ted " flashes brief ly in th e disp lay, the next set- ting is displayed. R R R R Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn to standby display. Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Page 44 Tuesday , July 17, 20 01 1:0 1 PM[...]

  • Seite 1075

    Sett ing the Auto Ring Time 45 5 Setting t he Auto Ring Time In A uto Se lect mo de, t he mac hine rings a number of times to give you the c hance to pic k up th e han dset b e- fore taking the call au tomatically. You can change the number of rings with the Auto Ri ng Time. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 [...]

  • Seite 1076

    Facsimil e User Tools 46 5 Setting t he Fax Reset Timer This machine automatically returns to the standby m ode if you do not use the mac hin e for a ce rtain peri od o f time . You can sele ct this peri od. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is displayed. C C[...]

  • Seite 1077

    On Hook Timeout 47 5 On Hook Ti meout This mach ine automatically can cels the O n Hook Dial m ode if y ou do not dial a number from the numeric key- pad for a certain p eriod of t ime after pressi ng th e { { { { On Ho ok Dial } } } } key. Yo u can selec t this pe riod. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or[...]

  • Seite 1078

    Facsimil e User Tools 48 5 Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Page 48 Tuesday , July 17, 20 01 1:0 1 PM[...]

  • Seite 1079

    49 6. Key Operator Settings Function List Here is a list of the functions tha t are available for setting. Pleas e refer to the ref- erence page numbe rs for more informat ion. Copy this table and use it as a quick referenc e. Displ ay (Specs.) Description Referenc e 1. M emo ry Loc k A l l o w s y o u t o h a v e m e s s a g e s f r o m S p e c - [...]

  • Seite 1080

    Key Operator Set tings 50 6 Using Ke y Opera tor Set tings Thi s ch apter expl ains about fun ctio ns the ke y op erat or hand les . Memory Lock This is a se curity f unction to prevent unauth orized indiv idual s fr om re ad- ing pr inted f ax mes sages. When Memory Loc k is switched on, all re- ceived messages are stored in memo- ry and are not a[...]

  • Seite 1081

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 51 6 Registering a Specified Sender for Memory Lock You can r egister Speci fied Sender s for thi s functio n. A A A A Press 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to display " 2. Program Sender ". B B B B Press th e { { { { OK } } } } key. C C C C Enter “ Own Name ” or “ Own Fax Number ” for the Specified Sende r. Enter[...]

  • Seite 1082

    Key Operator Set tings 52 6 Forwarding Use this function to print fax specified from Spec ified Send ers on your ow n machine and then forward the m es- sages to other fax machines. This is useful, for e xample, if yo u are visiti ng another of fice an d would l ike copies of your messages from the head o ffice forwarded to you so you can read them[...]

  • Seite 1083

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 53 6 D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Key Op. Tools " is displayed. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 2. Forward- ing " is displayed. G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. Confirm that ” 1. On/Off ” is dis- played. H H H H Pre[...]

  • Seite 1084

    Key Operator Set tings 54 6 J J J J Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to display t he num- ber of the forward ing station you want to r egister . If a forwarding station is already registered, the fax number for th at station i s displayed. K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. L L L L Enter the othe r party's fax numb er with t he numb er keys.[...]

  • Seite 1085

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 55 6 D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Key Op. Tools " is displayed. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 2. Forward- ing ” is displayed. G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 2. Prog. Sta- [...]

  • Seite 1086

    Key Operator Set tings 56 6 H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Delete Sta- tion " is displayed. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. J J J J Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to di spl ay th e fax number of the Forwarding Sta- tion you want to delete. K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The Forwardi ng Station is deleted.[...]

  • Seite 1087

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 57 6 O O O O Use 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 to display the Speci- fied Sender you w ant to delet e. P P P P Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. The Speci fied Sender is deleted. If you want to delete another Spec- ified Sender, repeat the above steps from step N . Q Q Q Q Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn[...]

  • Seite 1088

    Key Operator Set tings 58 6 User P aramet ers The User Parameters allow you to customize various settings to match your needs. To cha nge the f unction setti ngs, set the user p arameter s witches. Prep arat ion Access to some User Parameter Settings requires installation of optional equipment or that other settings be made beforehand. ❖ ❖ ❖ [...]

  • Seite 1089

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 59 6 02 0 Default setting for printing the Forwar ding Mark. FORWAR DING MARK On Off 1 Defa ult s ettin g for th e Cen- ter Mark . CENTER MAR K On Off 2 Default setting for printi ng the Reception Time. RECEPT ION TI ME On Off 3 Print Sender In formation (TSI P rint) On Off 4 Default setting for the Checke red Mark. CH[...]

  • Seite 1090

    Key Operator Set tings 60 6 05 0 Store incoming fa xes when machine is out of supplies. SUBSTI TUTE RECEP- TION On Off 1 Default setting for Sub sti- tute Reception . CONDIT IONS OF MEM- ORY RECE PTIO N Rej ect (I f no name or fax number is re- ceiv ed) Accept (Free) 4 Restricts fax machine u s- age to sp ecific us ers. RESTRI CTED ACCESS On Off 06[...]

  • Seite 1091

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 61 6 Changing the User Parameters We recommend that you print the User Parameter list and keep it when you register or change a user parame- ter. See p.62 “ Pr inting the User Pa- rameter List ” . Do not change any bit switches other than th ose s hown o n the prev ious pages. A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ol[...]

  • Seite 1092

    Key Operator Set tings 62 6 H H H H Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. For a list of the sw itches and set- tings, see p.58 “ User Pa rameter s ” . Use the User Parame ters table to look up the number of the s witch that you want to change, and then press the 0 or 1 ke y to dis play the num ber of th e swit ch. The bits are number ed 7~0. To c[...]

  • Seite 1093

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 63 6 K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key to re- turn to the standby displa y. Personal Codes This func tion allows you to kee p track of machine usage. When Per- sonal Codes are programmed, users have to enter their Pe rsonal Co de be- fore they send a fax. This function is used for the Re strict ed Acc[...]

  • Seite 1094

    Key Operator Set tings 64 6 Deleting A A A A Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } } key. B B B B Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Fax Fea- tures " is displayed. C C C C Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. D D D D Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Key Op. Tools " is displayed. E E E E Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. N[...]

  • Seite 1095

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 65 6 F F F F Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 4. Personal Code " is displayed. G G G G Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. H H H H Pre ss 0 0 0 0 or 1 1 1 1 until " 3. Print List " is displa yed. I I I I Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. J J J J Pre ss th e { { { { Start } } } } key. The lis t is[...]

  • Seite 1096

    Key Operator Set tings 66 6 ID Code Use th is procedure to register th e fol- lowing kind s of ID Codes: Important ❒ You can con firm ID Code s in the Param eter Setti ngs list. We recom- mend you prin t a new list e ach time you register or change I D Codes. ❒ You can edit reg istered ID Codes by performing the steps for regis- tering ID Codes[...]

  • Seite 1097

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 67 6 J J J J Enter the Memory L ock ID (4-dig- its) with the number keys. If yo u ma ke a mist ake, pr ess the { { { { Clear/Stop } } } } key and try again. K K K K Pre ss th e { { { { OK } } } } key. If you want to enter anot her item, repeat the above steps from step I . L L L L Pre ss th e { { { { User To ols } } } [...]

  • Seite 1098

    Key Operator Set tings 68 6 PSTN Access Number Use this setting to save having to en- ter a pause a fter the PSTN acces s number when dialing. W hen you pro- gram an access number, a pause is au- tomatically added as soon as that numbe r is press ed. Fo r exam ple, if you re gis ter " 0" as th e PS TN Acc ess Number, a pause will be inser[...]

  • Seite 1099

    Using Key Oper ator Settin gs 69 6 Memory File Transfer If th e machi ne cann ot prin t out a re- ceived message, you c an send all mes- sages currently stor ed in memory to another fax machi ne and have them printed o ut there (for example, w hen toner is empty, pa per has run out, or the print ing function is ou t of order). All messages in memor[...]

  • Seite 1100

    Key Operator Set tings 70 6 RDS (Remote Diagn ostic Syste m) If your machine has a problem, a ser- vice representative c an perform vari- ous diag nosti c ta sks o ver the telephone line from the service sta- tion to try to find out wha t is wrong with your machi ne. The service repre- sentative can also use RDS to change some of your machine'[...]

  • Seite 1101

    71 7. Troubleshooting Reading Repor ts Error Report An error report i s print ed when a message could not be successfully sent or received. Possible causes include a probl em with your machine or noise on the telep hone l ine . I f an er ror oc curs dur- ing transmission, re-send the original . If an error occurs during reception, ask the send er t[...]

  • Seite 1102

    Troublesh ooting 72 7 Stel laCEN-a dvanced _V4_FM .book Page 72 Tuesday , July 17, 20 01 1:0 1 PM[...]

  • Seite 1103

    73 8. Appendix Connecting to a Telephone L ine and a Telephone To connect th e machine to a teleph one line, use a snap-in modular type connec- tor. Important ❒ Make s ure the connector i s the co rrect t ype befor e you sta rt. ❒ By law in the U nited States, yo u must program your phone num ber identifi- cation (your OWN FAX N UMBER) into you[...]

  • Seite 1104

    Appendix 74 8 Connecting the O ptional Handset and an External Telephone You can conne ct the handset and an external teleph one to the ma chine. You can u se them for t elephone calls. Note ❒ Some telephone may not be con- nected or may suffer reduced func- tionalit y. Limitatio n ❒ When you use the handset or a n optional external teleph one [...]

  • Seite 1105

    Specificat ions 75 8 Speci fications Base Machi ne ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Power Co nsumptio n ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Proto col: G3 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Resolution: • Standard : 8 × 3.85/mm • Detail: 8 × 7.7 /mm • Fine: 8 × 15.4/mm ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Transmission Ti me: 3 seconds at 28,800bps, Standard resolution ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Data Compression Method: MH, MR ,[...]

  • Seite 1106

    Appendix 76 8 Available Options ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Expansio n Memory (32MB) Increase memor y capacity . ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper Tray Unit (Option for Model B only) Holds 500 sheets of paper. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Document Feeder (ADF) (Option for Type1) Originals will be fe d auto matica lly. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Handset (Handset Ty pe 1018) This perm its voic e c[...]

  • Seite 1107

    Specificat ions 77 8 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Document Feeder (ADF) Limitatio n ❒ Even if an or iginal is correct ly placed on the exposure gla ss or in the Doc u- ment Feede r, a ma rgin of 3m m to 5 mm (0.1 ” to 0.2 ” )around each ed ge of the original m ay not be sent. ❒ There may be a difference i n the size of the image when it is printed at th[...]

  • Seite 1108

    Appendix 78 8 Maximum Values The followi ng list contains the maximum value for each item. Item Standard Memory 1MB The number of pages that you can store in memory (Using A4 size Standard <ITU-T #1Chart, Resolution: Stand ard, Original Type: Text > ) 8 0 ( 3 2 0 w i t h Op t i o n a l M e m o r y ) Total number of Memory T ransmission files [...]

  • Seite 1109

    Advanced Tr ansmissio n Features 79 8 Advanced Trans missio n Features Fun ctions selecta ble with the { { { { Tr ans. Opti on } } } } key are as follows. Function name Description Reference Send Later Sets the machine to automati- cally start transmissi on or polling rece ption at an ap- pointed time. p.1 “ S ending at a Specif ic Time (Send Lat[...]

  • Seite 1110

    Appendix 80 8 Job Information Fun ctions selecta ble with the { { { { Job Informati on } } } } key are as follows. Functi on name Descri ption Ref erence Cancelin g Tran smission or Reception This function ca ncels a file (res ervation) for Memory Tr ansmission or Polling R ecepti on. p.9 “ Cancelin g Transm ission or Rec ep- tion ” Printing th[...]

  • Seite 1111

    User Tools 81 8 User T ools Function name Description Reference Register/Delete Quick Dial When you register a destina- tion in a Quick Dial, you can specify th e destin ation by only pressing the Qu ick Dial key. Chapter3 “ Quick Di al ” in th e Basic Features manual . Register/Delete Speed Dial Wh en you register a destina- tion in a Speed Di[...]

  • Seite 1112

    Appendix 82 8 Setting the Aut o Ring Time You can alter the n umber of rings by changi ng the Auto Ring Time. p.45 “ Setting th e Auto Ring Time ” Fax Information Registers your Ow n Name, Fax Header and Own Fax Number. Chapter3 “ Own Name /Fax Header / Ow n Fax Number ” in the Basic Features manu al. Fax Reset T imer You can select a perio[...]

  • Seite 1113

    Key Operat or Tool s 83 8 Key Opera tor Tools Function nam e Descripti on Ref erence Memory Lock All rec eived message s are stored in me mory an d are not automa tically prin ted. p.50 “ Memor y Lock ” Forwardi ng Transfers rec eived mes- sages to a registered re- ceiver (forwardi ng destin ation). p.52 “ Forwar ding ” Changing User Parame[...]

  • Seite 1114

    84 INDEX A Adju stin g Vo lume → Monitor Vo lume , 81 Advanced Transmis sion Featur es , 79 Ass igning User Funct ion Keys , 36 , 81 Auto Fax Reception P ower- up , 29 Automatic Redial , 23 Auto Ring Ti me , 45 , 82 B Batch T ransmissi on , 23 Broadcasting Seq uence , 23 C Canceling Tr ansmission or Rece ption , 9 , 80 Center Mar k , 30 Chain Di [...]

  • Seite 1115

    85 M Manual Dial , 18 Maximum Valu es , 78 Memory File Tran sfer , 69 , 83 Memory Lock , 50 , 83 Memory -locke d Messa ge , 12 , 80 Memory Lock ID , 66 Memory Recepti on , 27 Monit or Volume , 81 More Tr ansmission F unctions , 22 O On Hook Dial , 17 On Hook Timeout , 47 , 82 Options , 76 Origin als , 76 Other Tran smissio n Features , 15 Outside L[...]

  • Seite 1116

    86 UE US A B46 5 S Secured Polling Reception , 5 Send Later , 1 , 79 SEP Code , 19 SID , 20 Specifica tions , 75 Specif ied Sen der , 55 , 56 Specif ied Sen der list , 57 Speed D ial , 81 Speed D ial List , 40 Stored ID Ov erride Polli ng Reception , 5 Stored Mes sage , 11 SUB Cod e , 20 Substitute Receptio n , 28 Switches an d Bits , 58 T Teleph o[...]

  • Seite 1117

    Paper t ype: OK Pr ince Eco G10 0(55kg), Paper Thic kness=80 µ m // Pages in book= 92 // Pri nt scale =81% Gap (when print ed at 81% sc ale) = Pages in book × Pape r thi ckness / 2 = 3.68 0000 mm Introduc tion This m anual co ntains de tailed instr uctions on the operati on and ma intenan ce of t his mac hine. To get maximum versati lity fr om th[...]

  • Seite 1118

    PRINTER Controller Type 1013 Operating I nstructions Printer Reference 2 (option) Read this manual carefully before you use this product and keep it handy for future reference. For safety, p lease follow th e instructions i n this manua l.[...]

  • Seite 1119

    Introduction This man ual conta ins deta iled i nstructio ns on t he operati on and maintena nce of thi s machi ne. To g et maximu m versa tility from this machi ne all op erators sho uld careful ly read and fol low the ins tructions in this man ual. Please k eep this m anual in a han dy place near the m achine. Please read th e Safety Informa tion[...]

  • Seite 1120

    i Manuals for This Machine Manuals for Th is Machin e There are ten manuals that separately describe the operational procedures for the operation and maintenance of the machine. To enhance saf e and efficient operation of the machine, all users sh ould read and follow the instructi ons contained in the following manuals. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Copy Refe r[...]

  • Seite 1121

    ii How to Read This Manual Symbols In this manual, the following sy mbols are used: R WARNING: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed, could result in death or serious inj ury. R CAUTION: This sym bol indicates a potentia lly hazardo us situat ion which, if instruction s are not followed[...]

  • Seite 1122

    iii TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job PCL 6/5e - Acce ssing the Printer P roperties ................. ......... .............. ... 1 Windows 95/98/Me - Accessing the Pr inter Properties .......... ........ ....... ........ . 1 Windows 2000 - Accessing the Printer Properties .... ....... ........ ..........[...]

  • Seite 1123

    iv 4. Using the Control Panel Adjusting Printer Fe atures ............. .............. .......... .............. .............. ..... 24 Printer Features Menu . ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... ........ ........ ..... .... 24 Printer Features P arameters ............... .............. ......... .............. .........[...]

  • Seite 1124

    1 1. Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job PCL 6/5e - Accessing the Printer Properties Windows 95/98/ Me - Accessing t he Printer Proper ties Changing the default printer settings A Click [ Star t ] on the taskbar, point to [ Settings ] , an d then click [ Printers ] . The [ Pr inters ] window appears . B Click to select the icon [...]

  • Seite 1125

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 2 1 B Select the printer you w ant to use in the [ Name ] list bo x, and then clic k [ Prop- erties ] . The Printer Properties appear. C Make any setting s you require and click [ Apply ] . D Click [ OK ] to start printing. Windows 2000 - Accessing the Printer Prop ertie s Changing the default[...]

  • Seite 1126

    PCL 6/5e - Accessing the Printer Properties 3 1 B Click to select the icon of the printer whose default settings you want to change. C On the [ Fi le ] menu, click [ Printing Pr eferenc es... ] . The Printing Preferen ces Properties ap pear. D Make any setting s you require and click [ Apply ] . Note ❒ Settings you make here are used as the de fa[...]

  • Seite 1127

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 4 1 Windows NT 4.0 - Acces sing the Pri nter Propert ies Changing the default printer settings - Printer Properties Limita tion ❒ Changing the setting of the printer requir es Full Control acc ess permission. Members of Administrators, Server Op erators, Print Operators, and Pow er Users gro[...]

  • Seite 1128

    PCL 6/5e - Accessing the Printer Properties 5 1 Making printer settings from an a pplication To make the printer settings for a specific application, open the Printer Proper- ties dialog box from that app lication. The following example describes how to make settings for the WordPad application that comes with W indows NT 4.0. Note ❒ The actual p[...]

  • Seite 1129

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 6 1 PostScript - Setting Up for Printing Windows 95/98/ Me - Accessing t he Printer Proper ties Changing the default printer settings To make the Printer default settings, first open th e Printer Properties dialog box from the [ Prin ter s ] window. Note ❒ With som e applications, th e print[...]

  • Seite 1130

    PostScript - Setting Up for Printing 7 1 B Select the printer you w ant to use in the [ Name ] list bo x, and then clic k [ Prop- erties ] . The Printer Properties appear. C Make any setting s you require and click [ Apply ] . D Click [ OK ] to start printing. Windows 2000 - Accessing the Printer Prop ertie s Changing the default printer settings -[...]

  • Seite 1131

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 8 1 B Click to select the icon of the printer whose default settings you want to change. C On the [ Fi le ] menu, click [ Printing Pr eferenc es... ] . The Printing Preferen ces Properties ap pear. D Make any setting s you require and click [ Apply ] . Note ❒ Settings you make here are used [...]

  • Seite 1132

    PostScript - Setting Up for Printing 9 1 Windows NT 4.0 - Acces sing the Pri nter Propert ies Changing the default printer settings - Printer Properties Limita tion ❒ Changing the setting of the printer requir es Full Control acc ess permission. Members of Administrators, Server Op erators, Print Operators, and Pow er Users group s have Full Cont[...]

  • Seite 1133

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 10 1 Making printer settings from an a pplication To make the printer settings for a specific application, open the Printer Proper- ties dialog box from that app lication. The following example describes how to make settings for the WordPad application that comes with W indows NT 4.0. Note ❒[...]

  • Seite 1134

    PostScript - Setting Up for Printing 11 1 Setting up for printing from an applicat ion A Open the file you w ant to print. B On the [ Fi le ] menu, click [ Print ] . The [ Pr int er ] dial og box appears. C Confirm that the prin ter is se lected in the [ Printer : ] box, and make the print- er setting s. D After configuring the settings, click [ Pr[...]

  • Seite 1135

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 12 1 Canceling a Print Job Windows 95/9 8/Me, Wi ndows 2000, Wi ndows NT 4.0 - Ca ncelin g a Print Job A Double-click the printer icon on the Window s taskbar. A window appears, showing a ll the print jobs that are curren tly queuing to be printed. Chec k the current status of the job you w an[...]

  • Seite 1136

    Canceling a Print Job 13 1 Macintosh - Cancel ing a P rint Job A Double-click the printer's icon on the desktop. A window appears, showing a ll the print jobs that are curren tly queuing to be printed. Chec k the current status of the job you w ant to cancel. B Select the name of the job you want to cancel. C Click the pau se icon, and then cl[...]

  • Seite 1137

    Setting Up the Printer Driver and Canceling a Print Job 14 1[...]

  • Seite 1138

    15 2. Uninstalling the Printer Driver and Software Uninstalling the PCL 6/5e Printer Driver This section des cribes how to uninstall the printer driver. The actual procedure may differ depend ing on the operating system. Fo llow one o f th e ap prop riat e pr oced ur es be low . Windows 95/98/ Me - Uninstalli ng the PCL 6/5e Pri nter Driv er A Clos[...]

  • Seite 1139

    Uninstalling the Printer Driver and Software 16 2 Windows NT 4.0 - Uni nstalling th e PCL 6/5e Prin ter Drive r Limita tion ❒ Uninstalling a printer driver re quires Full Con trol access per mission. Mem- bers of the Administr ators, Server Operators, Print Operators, and Power Us- ers groups have Full Control Permission by default. When you inst[...]

  • Seite 1140

    Uninstalling the PostScript Printer Driver 17 2 Uninstalling the PostScript Printer Driver This section de scribes how to un install the PostScri pt printer driver. Th e actu al p roced ur e may diffe r dep end ing on the ope rati ng sys tem . Fo llow one o f th e ap prop riat e pr oced ur es be low . Windows 95/98/ Me - Uninstalli ng the PostScr i[...]

  • Seite 1141

    Uninstalling the Printer Driver and Software 18 2 Windows NT 4.0 - Uni nstalling th e PostScript Printer Drive r Limita tion ❒ Uninstalling a printer driver re quires Full Con trol access per mission. Mem- bers of the Administr ators, Server Operators, Print Operators, and Power Us- ers grou ps have F ull Con trol Permissi on by def ault. When yo[...]

  • Seite 1142

    19 3. Troubleshooting Error & Status Messages o n the Control Panel Messages/Second m essages Description Solution Add Toner Open Front Cover and /Follow Instructions to Repl ace it Toner is running o ut. It is time to supply toner . Clear Misfeed(s) /Follow instructions in Front Cover There is misf eed at the front cover. Remove the misfed pap[...]

  • Seite 1143

    Troubleshooting 20 3 Processing... The printer is processing in- ternally. Wait for a while. Ready The printer is online and ready to print. If you want to set the printer offline, press { Online } . Resetting Job... The print job is being reset. Wait for a while. Toner is Almost Empty Toner is almost running out. Replace the toner early to pr e- v[...]

  • Seite 1144

    Machine Does Not Print 21 3 Machine Does Not Print Pos sibl e Cau se Solut ions Is the power on? Turn on the machine. Is the interface cable p roperly connected? Connect the interface cable properly. If there are any connectors or screws , make sure that they are f astened securely. Are you using t he correct interface cable? Be sure to use the cor[...]

  • Seite 1145

    Troubleshooting 22 3 Other Printing Problems Problem Action An image is printed on the reverse side of the paper. Set the pa per upside down. Multiple pages are fed through the printer at once. Remove all the p aper from the tray and fan them gently. Paper misf eeds occur frequently. Check the paper size settings. Use the recom- mended paper. Avoid[...]

  • Seite 1146

    23 4. Using the Control Panel Though th e factory default settings of th e printer are suitable for most printing jobs, the "Printer Features" gives you access to a number of settings that control basic printer operations. "Prin ter Features" se ttings you make are retai ned even when you turn off the printer. Reference For more[...]

  • Seite 1147

    Using the Control Panel 24 4 Adjusting Printer Features Printer Features Menu There are four men u items in the "Printer Features " menu. • Job Control • Network Setu p • Mainte nance • List Print You can select fu nctions in the following table. Cate gor y Funct ion me nu Job Control ⇒ p.27 Paper Input Tray Priority Tray Loc ki[...]

  • Seite 1148

    Adjusting Printer Features 25 4 *1 Optional Network Interfac e Board is r equired. *2 Optional PostScri pt level2 Compatibl e Kit is required. Access ing the P rinter Fe atures Menu Press { User Tools/ Counter } . Press the 0 or 1 key to display “ 5.Printer Features ” , then press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel dis play. Pr[...]

  • Seite 1149

    Using the Control Panel 26 4 Note ❒ 1 key : Press to go to the next menu. ❒ 0 key : Press to go back to the previous menu ❒ After makin g the pr inter sett ings , be su re to re turn to the pre vious me nu by pressin g { Cancel } . ❒ After making the printer settings, press { User Tools/Counter } to return to the initial display. ❒ The re[...]

  • Seite 1150

    Printer Features Parameters 27 4 Printer Features Parameters Job Control Menu There are four menu items in the “ Job Control ” men u. • Paper Inpu t • Print Quality • Sys tem • PCL Menu Job Control Parameters ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Paper Input Menu Description Tray Priority When no tray or paper s ize is se lected for a print job, the tray se-[...]

  • Seite 1151

    Using the Control Panel 28 4 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Print Quality Bypas s Paper Size You can sp ecify the paper s ize, st andar d or cu stom, fo r the by pass tray. When the bypa ss pap er size is not spe cified , the pap er siz e you set on the control panel is used. If you use PCL 6 or PS2 printer driver to print cus tom paper size, the paper size you s[...]

  • Seite 1152

    Printer Features Parameters 29 4 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ System Toner Saving You can select whether to enable Toner Saving. • Off • On Note ❒ Default: Off ❒ If “ Toner Saving ” is “ On ” , “ EdgeSmoothing ” is ignored even if it is “ On ” . ❒ The setting in the printer drive r takes priority of the setting on control panel. Menu D[...]

  • Seite 1153

    Using the Control Panel 30 4 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ PCL Menu Auto Continue You can set whethe r to enable Auto Continue. When it is set to “ On ” , the printing continues even if the following error messages appear on the displ ay. “ Print Overrun. Job Incomplete. ” , “ Memory Overflow. Job I n- complete. ” , “ Memory Full. Job I ncomplete. [...]

  • Seite 1154

    Printer Features Parameters 31 4 Font Number You can set the ID of the default font you want to use. • 0 to 54 (for Int erna l) • 1 to 50 (for Down load sourc e) Note ❒ Default: Interna l ❒ Default: 0 Point Size You can set the point size you want to use for the default font. 4 to 999.75 by 0.25 Note ❒ Default: 12.00 ❒ This setting is e[...]

  • Seite 1155

    Using the Control Panel 32 4 Changing the Paper Input Menu The followin g procedure describes changing the “ Tray Pri ority ” as an example in the “ Pape r Input ” m enu. A Press { User Tools/Counter } . B Press the 0 or 1 k ey until the following message appears on the panel d is- play. C Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the[...]

  • Seite 1156

    Printer Features Parameters 33 4 F Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. G Press the 0 or 1 key to select the tray type you want to use. H Press { OK } . “ Programmed ” is displayed for two seconds. I The following screen appears on the p anel display. J Press { User Tools/Counter } to return to the initial display.[...]

  • Seite 1157

    Using the Control Panel 34 4 Network Setup Menu There are thr ee menu items in the “ Network Setup ” menu. • IP Ad dres s • Subne t Ma sk • Gateway Address Note ❒ This “ Ne twork Setup ” menu appears only when installin g the optional Net- work Interface Board. Network Setup Parameters Menu Description IP Address You can set the IP [...]

  • Seite 1158

    Printer Features Parameters 35 4 Maintenanc e Menu There are thr ee menu items in the “ Mai ntenanc e ” menu. • Restart Printer • Menu Re set • Hex Dump Maintenan ce Parame ters Restar ting a Printe r The following procedure describes select ing the “ R estart Printer ” as an example in the “ Mainte nance ” me nu. A Press { User T[...]

  • Seite 1159

    Using the Control Panel 36 4 B Press the 0 or 1 k ey until the following message appears on the panel d is- play. C Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. D Press the 0 or 1 k ey until the following message appears on the panel d is- play. E Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. F Press { OK [...]

  • Seite 1160

    Printer Features Parameters 37 4 List Prin t Menu There are four menu items in the “ List Print ” menu. • Configuration Pa ge • Menu Li st • PCL Font List • PS Font List List Print Parame ters Printing a Configuration Page The following proced ure describes pr inting t he “ Configurat ion Page ” as an e x- ample in the “ Li st Pri[...]

  • Seite 1161

    Using the Control Panel 38 4 C Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. D Press the 0 or 1 k ey until the following message appears on the panel d is- play. E Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. F Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. G Press { OK } . The followin[...]

  • Seite 1162

    Printer Features Parameters 39 4 Interpreting the Conf iguration Page Reference ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Printer ID Shows the serial number ass igned to the board by its manuf acturer. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Firmware Vers ion Shows the version number of the prin ter firmware. ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Pages Print ed Shows the total nu mber of pages printed by the pr inter t[...]

  • Seite 1163

    Using the Control Panel 40 4 Adjusting System Settings Accessing the S ystem Sett ings A Press { User Tools/ Counter } . B Press the 0 or 1 key to display “ 2.System Settings ” . C Press { OK } . The following sc reen appears on the panel display. Select t he desired m enu you w ant to chan ge. D Change th e settings by following the instructio[...]

  • Seite 1164

    Adjusting System Settings 41 4 System Settings Parameters This sect ion cont ains the information about the param eters used for th e printer. Reference For more information about the other pa rameters in the System Setti ngs menu, see th e “ System Settings ” manual. Menu Description 1.Function Priority You can specify the mode (Copier or Facs[...]

  • Seite 1165

    Using the Control Panel 42 4[...]

  • Seite 1166

    43 5. Appendix Specifications This secti on contains the electrical and hardware specifica tions for the printer, including the information about the options. *1 For PCL5e, only 6 00dpi is sel ectable fr om the print er driver. *2 Post Scrip t level2 Comp atib le *3 Microsoft Windows 95 oper ating system *4 Microsoft Windows 98 oper ating system *5[...]

  • Seite 1167

    Appendix 44 5 Options Networ k Interfac e Board T ype 1018 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Topology: Ethernet (10BaseT /100BaseTX) ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Protocols: TCP/IP , IPX/SPX , AppleTalk ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Interface Connect or: RJ45 ❖ ❖ ❖ ❖ Required C able: Int erf ace c ab le wi th f erri te c ore Interface cable is no t provided with th is option. Memory Un[...]

  • Seite 1168

    45 INDEX A Auto Off Time r , 41 C Can cel ke y , 26 Con fig. Page , 37 Config uration Pa ge , 37 E error , 19 F Fun ctio n Pri or ity , 41 H Hex Dump , 35 J Job Control , 25 , 27 L List Print , 25 , 37 M Macintosh , 18 Main tenance , 25 , 35 Measurement Unit , 41 menu , accessi ng , 25 Menu List , 37 Menu Rese t , 35 messa ges , 19 N Netwo rk Setup[...]

  • Seite 1169

    46 UE USA B441 W Window s 2000 PCL 5e, uninstallin g , 15 PCL 6, uninst alling , 15 PostScript , uninstalling , 17 prin ter proper ties, P CL , 2 print er proper ties, Po stScrip t , 7 Window s 95/98/Me PCL 5e, uninstallin g , 15 PCL 6, uninst alling , 15 PostScript , uninstalling , 17 prin ter proper ties, P CL , 1 print er proper ties, Po stScrip[...]

  • Seite 1170

    Note to users in the United States of America Notice: This equi pment has been tes ted and found to c omply with the li mits for a C lass B d igital de vice, purs u- ant to Part 15 of the FCC R ules. T hese lim its ar e desig ned to pro vide reas onabl e protecti on again st harmful in terferen ce in a resid ential installa tion. This e quipment g [...]

  • Seite 1171

    PRINT ER Con troller Type 10 13 Operating Instruc tions Pr inter Refere nce 2 (option) UE USA B441-8627[...]